Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz
Before you drive off, please familiarise yourself with your vehicle and read this manual,
especially the safety and warning notices.
This will help you to obtain the maximum
pleasure from your vehicle and avoid endangering yourself and others.
The equipment or model designation of your
vehicle may differ according to:
Rmodel
Rorder
Rcountry
variant
Ravailability
The illustrations in this manual show a lefthand-drive vehicle. On right-hand-drive vehicles, the arrangement and location of vehicle
parts and controls differ accordingly.
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its
vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right
to introduce changes in the following areas:
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical
features
You cannot, therefore, base any claims on the
illustrations or text content in this manual.
The following are integral components of the
vehicle:
ROwner's
Manual
Booklet
REquipment-dependent supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. When you sell the vehicle, always pass
the documents on to the new owner.
RService
i You can get to know the important fea-
tures of your vehicle in the interactive Owner's Manual on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
2045844982Z102 É2045844982Z102!ËÍ
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
At a glance ........................................... 29
Introduction ......................................... 25
Safety ................................................... 43
Opening and closing ........................... 77
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .... 95
Lights and windscreen wipers ......... 107
Climate control ................................. 121
Driving and parking .......................... 135
On-board computer and displays .... 205
Stowing and features ....................... 283
Maintenance and care ...................... 299
Breakdown assistance ..................... 313
Wheels and tyres .............................. 335
Technical data ................................... 349
3
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
12-button multifunction steering
wheel
Operating the on-board computer . 211
Overview .......................................... 39
12 V socket
see Sockets
4-button multifunction steering
wheel
Overview .......................................... 38
4-button multifunction steering
wheel
Operating the on-board computer . 207
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 238
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 234
Function/notes ................................ 65
Important safety notes .................... 65
Warning lamp ................................. 275
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode .................................... 127
Activating/deactivating cooling
with air dehumidification ................. 124
Active Blind Spot Assist
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 259
Function/notes ............................. 194
Switching on/off (on-board computer, 12-button multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 222
Towing a trailer .............................. 197
Active Driving Assistance package . 194
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 258
Function/information .................... 197
Switching on/off (on-board computer, 12-button multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 222
Towing a trailer .............................. 199
Active light function ......................... 111
Active Service System PLUS
see ASSYST PLUS service interval
display
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 71
Adaptive brake lamps ......................... 67
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Function/notes ............................. 112
Adaptive Main-beam Assist
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 251
Adaptive Main-Beam Assist
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 225
Additional speedometer ................... 223
Additives (engine oil) ........................ 356
Adjusting the headlamp range ......... 110
Airbags
Activation ......................................... 45
Front airbag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 48
Important safety guidelines ............. 46
Kneebag ........................................... 48
Pelvis airbag .................................... 49
Sidebag ............................................ 48
Windowbag ...................................... 49
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Air filter
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 255
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 253
Air pressure
see Tyre pressure
Air vents
Glove compartment ....................... 133
Important safety notes .................. 132
Rear ............................................... 133
Setting ........................................... 132
Setting the centre air vents ........... 133
Setting the side air vents ............... 133
Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Alertness Assistant
see ATTENTION ASSIST
AMGMenu (on-board computer) ....... 229
Anti-glare film .................................... 297
Index
Anti-lock Braking System
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Anti-theft system
Immobiliser ...................................... 73
Aquaplaning ....................................... 161
Ashtray ............................................... 290
ASSYST PLUS
see ASSYST PLUS service interval
display
ASSYST PLUS service interval display
Displaying service messages ......... 305
Hiding service messages ............... 305
Notes ............................................. 305
Service messages .......................... 305
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 73
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 73
Function ........................................... 73
Interior motion sensor ..................... 74
Switching off the alarm .................... 73
Tow-away protection ........................ 73
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating ................. 222
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 256
Function/notes ............................. 188
Audio DVD (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .......................... 218
Audio menu (on-board computer,
12-button multifunction steering
wheel) ................................................. 217
AUTO lights
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 250
see Lights
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) .................................... 142
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function) .......................... 141
Automatic headlamp mode .............. 109
Automatic transmission
Accelerator pedal position ............. 147
Automatic drive program ............... 148
Changing gear ............................... 146
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Driving tips ....................................
Emergency running mode ..............
Kickdown .......................................
Manual drive program ....................
Problem (fault) ...............................
Program selector button ................
Pulling away ...................................
Releasing the parking lock manually ...............................................
Selector lever ................................
Shift ranges ...................................
Starting the engine ........................
Steering wheel gearshift paddles ...
Trailer towing .................................
Transmission position display ........
Transmission positions ..................
Automatic transmission emergency running mode .........................
Automatic transmissions
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Auxiliary heating
Activating/deactivating .................
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) ..............................
Important safety notes ..................
Problem (display message) ............
Remote control ..............................
Setting (on-board computer, 12button multifunction steering
wheel) ............................................
Setting the departure time .............
Auxiliary ventilation
Activating/deactivating .................
Activating/deactivating (on the
centre console) ..............................
Problem (display message) ............
Remote control ..............................
Axle load, permissible (trailer towing) ......................................................
265
147
152
147
150
152
147
140
152
146
149
139
148
147
146
146
152
267
128
128
128
132
129
227
130
128
128
132
129
363
5
6
Index
B
Bag hook ............................................ 287
Ball coupling
Folding in ....................................... 202
Folding out ..................................... 201
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 66
Basic settings
see Settings
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
PLUS) .................................................... 66
Battery (key)
Checking .......................................... 81
Important safety notes .................... 80
Replacing ......................................... 81
Battery (vehicle)
Charging ........................................ 328
Connecting .................................... 327
Disconnecting ................................ 327
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 255
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 252
Important safety notes .................. 325
Jump starting ................................. 329
Location ......................................... 326
Removing/fitting ........................... 327
Belt
see Seat belt
Belt force limiters (activation) ........... 45
Belt tensioner
Activation ......................................... 45
Function ........................................... 54
Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating ................. 222
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 259
Notes/function .............................. 190
Trailer towing ................................. 192
see Active Blind Spot Assist
Bonnet
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection) ............................................... 300
Closing ........................................... 302
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 268
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 266
Opening ......................................... 301
Boot
Emergency release .......................... 87
Important safety guidelines ............. 85
Locking separately ........................... 87
Opening (automatically from
inside) .............................................. 87
Opening (automatically from outside) ................................................. 86
Boot lid
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 268
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 266
Opening/closing .............................. 85
Opening dimensions ...................... 360
Boot load (maximum)
see Technical data
Brake Assist System
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 241
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 236
Notes ............................................. 356
Brake lamp
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 249
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 245
Brake lamps
Adaptive ........................................... 67
Changing bulbs .............................. 118
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 65
BAS .................................................. 66
BAS PLUS ........................................ 66
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 356
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 238
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 234
Driving tips .................................... 159
High-performance brake system .... 161
Important safety notes .................. 159
Index
Parking brake ................................ 159
Warning lamp ................................. 275
Breakdown
see Flat tyre
see Towing away/tow-starting
Bulbs
see Changing bulbs
C
Calling up a fault
see Display messages
Capacities
see Technical data
Car
see Vehicle
Care
Automatic car wash ....................... 306
Display ........................................... 310
Exterior lighting ............................. 309
High-pressure cleaner .................... 307
Matt paintwork .............................. 308
Notes ............................................. 306
Paint .............................................. 307
Plastic trim .................................... 310
Reversing camera .......................... 309
Seat belt ........................................ 311
Seat cover ..................................... 311
Sensors ......................................... 309
Tail pipes ....................................... 309
Trim pieces .................................... 311
Wheels ........................................... 307
Windows ........................................ 308
Wiper blades .................................. 308
Wooden trim .................................. 311
Car key
see Key
Car wash (care) ................................. 306
CD player/CD changer (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) .......... 218
Cell phone
see Mobile phone
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 226
Locking/unlocking (key) .................. 78
Centre console ..................................... 40
Changing bulbs
Brake lamps ................................... 118
Cornering light function ................. 117
Dipped-beam headlamps ............... 116
Important safety notes .................. 114
Main-beam headlamps ................... 116
Overview of bulb types .................. 115
Parking lamps (front) ..................... 117
Reversing lamps ............................ 118
Standing lamps .............................. 117
Child-proof locks
Child seat lock ................................. 56
Children
In the vehicle ................................... 55
Restraint systems ............................ 55
Child seat
Automatic recognition ..................... 57
Child seat lock ................................. 56
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 243
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 237
ISOFIX .............................................. 58
On the front-passenger seat ............ 57
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 61
Recommendations ........................... 63
Suitable positions ............................ 61
Cigarette lighter ................................ 291
Cleaning
Trailer tow hitch ............................. 309
Climate control
Activating/deactivating rear window heating ................................... 126
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 128
Controlling automatically ............... 124
Convenience opening/closing (air
recirculation) ................................. 127
Cooling with air dehumidification . . 124
Demisting the windows .................. 126
Demisting the windscreen ............. 126
Important safety notes .................. 122
Indicator lamp ................................ 124
Notes on using THERMATIC automatic climate control ..................... 123
Overview of systems ...................... 122
Problems with cooling with air
dehumidification ............................ 124
7
8
Index
Problem with the rear window
heating .......................................... 127
Setting the air distribution ............. 125
Setting the airflow ......................... 125
Setting the air vents ...................... 132
Setting the temperature ................ 125
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ............................................ 127
Switching on/off ........................... 124
Switching the ZONE function on/
off .................................................. 125
THERMATIC automatic climate
control (2-zone) ............................. 123
Cockpit
Overview .......................................... 30
see Instrument cluster
COMAND Online
see separate operating instructions
Combination switch .......................... 110
Constant headlamp mode
see Daytime driving lamps
Consumption statistics
On-board computer (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 215
On-board computer (4-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 210
Convenience closing feature .............. 89
Convenience opening/closing (airrecirculation mode) ........................... 127
Convenience opening feature ............ 88
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level ......................... 303
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 254
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 251
Notes ............................................. 356
Temperature display (12-button
multifunction steering wheel;
AMG) ............................................. 229
Temperature gauge (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 210
Temperature gauge (4-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 206
Warning lamp ................................. 280
Cooling
see Climate control
Cornering lamps
Changing bulbs ..............................
Cornering light function
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Function/notes .............................
Crash-responsive emergency lighting .......................................................
Cruise control
Cruise control lever .......................
Deactivating ...................................
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Driving system ...............................
Important safety notes ..................
LIM indicator lamp .........................
Selecting ........................................
Setting a speed ..............................
Storing and maintaining current
speed .............................................
Cup holder
Centre console ..............................
Important safety notes ..................
Rear compartment .........................
117
248
244
111
114
162
164
261
256
162
162
162
163
164
163
289
289
290
D
Dashboard
see Cockpit
Data
see Technical data
Daytime driving lamps
Switching on/off (on-board computer, 12-button multifunction
steering wheel) ..............................
Daytime driving lights
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Switching on/off (on-board computer, 4-button multifunction
steering wheel) ..............................
Switching on/off (switch) ..............
224
250
247
210
109
Index
Delayed switch-off
Exterior lighting (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Interior lighting (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Diesel ..................................................
Diesel particle filter ..........................
Digital speedometer .........................
Dipped beam
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Dipped-beam headlamps
Changing bulbs ..............................
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Setting for driving abroad (symmetrical) ........................................
Setting for driving on the right/
left .................................................
Switching on/off ...........................
Display (cleaning instructions) ........
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
ASSYST PLUS service interval .......
Calling up .......................................
Driving systems .............................
Engine ............................................
General notes ................................
Hiding ............................................
Key ................................................
KEYLESS-GO ..................................
Lights .............................................
Safety systems ..............................
Tyres ..............................................
Vehicle ...........................................
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
ASSYST PLUS service interval .......
Calling up .......................................
Driving systems .............................
Engine ............................................
General notes ................................
Hiding ............................................
Key ................................................
KEYLESS-GO ..................................
Lights .............................................
Safety systems ..............................
225
225
154
159
215
244
116
248
108
224
109
310
305
233
256
254
232
232
271
271
247
238
263
267
305
232
256
251
232
232
270
270
244
234
Tyres .............................................. 262
Vehicle ........................................... 265
Distance display (on-board computer, 12-button multifunction
steering wheel) .................................. 221
Distance recorder
12-button multifunction steering
wheel ............................................. 215
see Trip meter
Distance warning signal (warning
lamp) .................................................. 282
DISTRONIC PLUS
Deactivating ................................... 171
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 260
Displays in the multifunction display ................................................ 171
Driving tips .................................... 172
Function/notes ............................. 164
Important safety notes .................. 164
Selecting ........................................ 166
Setting the specified minimum
distance ......................................... 170
Warning lamp ................................. 282
Door
Automatic door locking feature
(on-board computer, 12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 226
Automatic locking (switch) ............... 84
Central locking/unlocking (key) ...... 78
Control panel ................................... 42
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 268
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 266
Emergency locking ........................... 85
Emergency unlocking ....................... 85
Important safety notes .................... 83
Opening (from the inside) ................ 84
Drinks holder
see Cup holders
Drive program
Automatic ...................................... 148
Display ........................................... 146
Manual ........................................... 150
Drive program selector ..................... 148
Driver's door
see Door
9
10
Index
Driver's seat
see Seats
Drive system
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 194
Driving abroad
Service24h .................................... 306
Symmetrical dipped beam ............. 108
Driving on flooded roads .................. 161
Driving safety system
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
PLUS) ............................................... 66
Electronic Brake-force Distribution .................................................. 71
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 67
Important safety guidelines ............. 65
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 65
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 71
Adaptive brake lamps ...................... 67
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 66
ETS (Electronic Traction System) ..... 68
Overview .......................................... 65
PRE-SAFE® Brake ............................. 71
Driving system
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 197
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 256
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 256
Driving systems
Active Driving Assistance package ................................................. 194
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 188
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 190
Cruise control ................................ 162
Distronic Plus ................................ 164
Dynamic handling package with
sports mode .................................. 176
HOLD function ............................... 177
Lane Keeping Assist ...................... 192
Lane package ................................ 190
Parking Guidance ........................... 183
Parktronic ...................................... 179
RACE START (AMG vehicles) .......... 178
Reversing camera .......................... 186
Speed Limit Assist .........................
Speedtronic ...................................
Driving tips
Aquaplaning ...................................
Automatic transmission .................
Brakes ...........................................
DISTRONIC PLUS ...........................
Downhill gradient ...........................
Driving abroad ...............................
Driving in winter .............................
Driving on flooded roads ................
Driving on wet roads ......................
General ..........................................
Icy road surfaces ...........................
Limited braking efficiency on salted roads .......................................
New brake pads/linings ................
Running-in tips ...............................
Snow chains ..................................
Symmetrical dipped beam .............
Towing a trailer ..............................
Tyre grip ........................................
Wet road surface ...........................
Dynamic handling package with
sports mode .......................................
189
173
161
147
159
172
159
108
161
161
161
159
162
160
160
136
338
108
199
161
160
176
E
EASY-ENTRY feature ............................ 99
Activating/deactivating (12-button multifunction steering wheel) . . 228
Function/notes ............................. 102
EASY-EXIT feature
Activating/deactivating (12-button multifunction steering wheel) . . 228
Function/notes ............................. 102
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
Function/notes ................................ 71
EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution)
Display message (12 button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 240
EBD (Electronic Brake-force Distribution)
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 235
Index
ECO start/stop function
Deactivating/activating ................. 142
General information ....................... 140
Electrical fuses
see Fuses
Electronic Brake force Distribution
see EBD (Electronic Brake force
Distribution)
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Electronic Traction System
see ETS (Electronic Traction System)
Emergency key
Unlocking the driver's door .............. 85
Emergency key element
Function/notes ................................ 80
Locking vehicle ................................ 85
Emergency release
Driver's door .................................... 85
Emergency spare wheel
Notes/data .................................... 346
Storage location ............................ 316
Emergency unlocking
Boot ................................................. 87
Vehicle ............................................. 85
Engine
ECO start/stop function ................ 140
Emergency starting ........................ 333
Engine number ............................... 353
Running irregularly ......................... 143
Starting problems .......................... 143
Starting the engine with the key .... 139
Starting with KEYLESS GO ............. 139
Stopping ........................................ 158
Warning lamp (engine diagnostics) ............................................... 280
Engine electronics
Notes ............................................. 351
Problem (fault) ............................... 143
Engine oil
Additives ........................................ 356
Checking the oil level ..................... 302
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 255
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 253
Filling capacity ............................... 355
Notes about oil grades ................... 355
Notes on oil level/consumption .... 302
Temperature (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 229
Topping up ..................................... 303
Viscosity ........................................ 356
Environmental protection
Note ................................................. 25
Returning an end-of-life vehicle ....... 25
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
AMG menu (on-board computer) . . . 229
Deactivating/activating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 69
Deactivating/activating (except
AMG vehicles) ................................ 221
Deactivating/activating (notes;
except AMG vehicles) ...................... 68
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 238
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 234
ETS .................................................. 68
Function/notes ................................ 67
Important safety guidelines ............. 67
Trailer stabilisation .......................... 70
Warning lamp ................................. 277
ETS (Electronic Traction System) ....... 68
Exhaust tail pipe (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 309
Exterior lighting
see Lights
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ....................................... 103
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 104
Folding in/out (automatically) ....... 104
Folding in/out (electrically) ........... 103
Folding in (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ....................... 228
Out of position (troubleshooting) ... 104
Parking position ............................. 104
Resetting ....................................... 104
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 105
11
12
Index
F
Fatigue Assist
see ATTENTION ASSIST
Fault message
see Display messages
Filler cap
see Fuel filler flap
Fire extinguisher ............................... 315
First-aid kit ......................................... 314
Flat tyre
Changing a wheel/fitting the
spare wheel ................................... 321
MOExtended run-flat system ......... 324
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 316
Raising the vehicle ......................... 322
TIREFIT kit ...................................... 317
Floormat ............................................. 297
Foglamps
Extended range .............................. 112
Switching on/off ........................... 109
Frequencies
Garage door opener ....................... 297
Mobile phone ................................. 351
Two-way radio ................................ 351
Front foglamp
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 249
Front foglamps
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 246
Switching on/off ........................... 109
Front windscreen
see Windscreen
Fuel
Displaying the range (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 215
Displaying the range (4-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 210
Important safety notes .................. 354
Notes about consumption ............. 354
Problem (malfunction) ................... 157
Refuelling ....................................... 152
Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 354
Tank content display (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) .......... 35
Tank content display (4-button
multifunction steering wheel) .......... 32
Fuel consumption
Current (12-button multifunction
steering wheel) ..............................
Fuel filler flap
Opening/closing ............................
Fuel filter
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Fuel reserve
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
see Fuel
Fuel tank
Capacity ........................................
Problem (malfunction) ...................
Fuse allocation chart (vehicle tool
kit) ......................................................
Fuses
Allocation chart .............................
Before changing .............................
Fuse box in the boot ......................
Fuse box in the engine compartment ..............................................
Important safety notes ..................
215
155
255
253
255
253
354
157
315
334
334
334
334
333
G
Garage door opener
Clearing the memory .....................
Frequencies ...................................
Notes .............................................
Opening/closing the garage door ..
Programming (button in the rearview mirror) ...................................
Gear indicator (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..................
Gearshift program
SETUP (on-board computer) ..........
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts .........
Glove compartment ..........................
296
297
294
295
294
229
229
350
285
Index
H
Handbrake
see Parking brake
Hazard warning lamps ...................... 111
Headlamp
Cleaning system (function) ............ 110
Headlamps
Misting up ...................................... 113
Topping up the cleaning system .... 304
see Automatic headlamp mode
Head restraints
Adjusting ......................................... 98
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 99
Adjusting (manually) ........................ 98
see NECK-PRO head restraints
Heating
see Climate control
High-pressure cleaners .................... 307
Hill start assist .................................. 140
HOLD function
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 257
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 256
Function/notes ............................. 177
I
Ignition lock
see Key positions
Immobiliser .......................................... 73
Indicator and warning lamps
Coolant .......................................... 280
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 282
Engine diagnostics ......................... 280
Fuel tank ........................................ 280
Overview (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ......................... 37
Overview (4-button multifunction
steering wheel) ................................ 34
SPORT handling mode ................... 278
Indicator lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Indicators
see Turn signals
Instrument cluster (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Indicator and warning lamps ............ 37
Overview .......................................... 35
Settings ......................................... 223
Instrument cluster (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Indicator and warning lamps ............ 34
Overview .......................................... 32
Instrument cluster lighting
Multifunction steering wheel with
12 buttons ....................................... 35
Multifunction steering wheel with
4 buttons ......................................... 32
Instrument lighting
see Instrument cluster lighting
Intelligent Light System
Activating/deactivating (12-button multifunction steering wheel) . . 224
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 250
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for driving on the right/left . 224
Interior lighting
Automatic control system .............. 114
Delayed switch-off (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 225
Emergency lighting ........................ 114
Manual control ............................... 114
Overview ........................................ 114
Reading lamp ................................. 114
see Interior lighting
Interior motion sensor ........................ 74
ISOFIX child seat securing system .... 58
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 315
Using ............................................. 322
Jump starting (engine) ...................... 329
K
Key
Changing the battery ....................... 81
Checking the battery ....................... 81
Convenience closing feature ............ 89
13
14
Index
Convenience opening feature .......... 88
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 270
Door central locking/unlocking ....... 78
Emergency key element ................... 80
Loss ................................................. 82
Modifying the programming ............. 79
Positions (ignition lock) ................. 137
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 82
Starting the engine ........................ 139
KEYLESS-GO
Convenience closing ........................ 89
Display message (12-button multifunction display) .......................... 271
Display message (4-button multifunction display) ............................ 270
Locking ............................................ 79
Start/Stop button .......................... 137
Starting the engine ........................ 139
Unlocking ......................................... 79
Key positions
Key ................................................ 137
KEYLESS GO .................................. 137
Keys
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 271
Kickdown
Driving tips .................................... 147
Manual drive program .................... 150
Kneebag ............................................... 48
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Lane-change assistant
see Blind Spot Assist
Lane detection (automatic)
see Lane Keeping Assist
Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating .................
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Function/information ....................
Lane package .....................................
Lap time (RACETIMER) ......................
Lashing eyelets .................................
222
258
192
190
229
287
Lighting
see Lights
Lights
Activating/deactivating the exterior lighting delayed switch-off
(12-button multifunction steering
wheel) ............................................
Activating/deactivating the Intelligent Light System ........................
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off
(12-button multifunction steering
wheel) ............................................
Active light function .......................
Automatic headlamp mode ............
Cornering light function .................
Dipped-beam headlamps ...............
Driving abroad ...............................
Foglamps .......................................
Foglamps (extended range) ...........
Hazard warning lamps ...................
Headlamp flasher ...........................
Headlamp range ............................
Light switch ...................................
Main-beam headlamps ...................
Motorway mode .............................
Parking lamps ................................
Rear foglamp .................................
Switching Adaptive Highbeam
Assist on/off .................................
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (4-button multifunction steering wheel) .......................
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (switch) .....................
Switching the surround lighting
on/off (12-button multifunction
steering wheel) ..............................
Turn signals ...................................
see Changing bulbs
see Interior lighting
225
224
225
111
109
111
109
108
109
112
111
111
110
108
110
112
108
109
225
224
210
109
225
110
Index
Light sensor
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 250
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 247
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control ................................ 162
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 166
Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 174
Limiting the speed
see SPEEDTRONIC
Loading guidelines ............................ 284
Locking
see Central locking
Locking (doors)
Automatic ........................................ 84
Emergency locking ........................... 85
From inside (central locking button) .................................................. 84
Locking centrally
see Central locking
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 226
Luggage net ....................................... 285
Lumbar support
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support .................................................. 99
Luxury multifunction steering
wheel
see 12-button multifunction
steering wheel
M
M+S tyres ...........................................
Main beam
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Main-beam headlamps
Changing bulbs ..............................
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Switching Adaptive Highbeam
Assist on/off .................................
Switching on/off ...........................
Maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS service interval
display
337
246
116
249
112
110
Manual transmission
Engaging reverse gear ................... 145
Gear lever ...................................... 144
Pulling away ................................... 139
Shifting to neutral .......................... 145
Shift recommendation ................... 145
Starting the engine ........................ 138
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) . . 308
Memory card (audio) ......................... 218
Memory function ............................... 105
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
see Qualified specialist workshop
Message memory
12-button multifunction steering
wheel ............................................. 233
4-button multifunction steering
wheel ............................................. 232
Messages
see Display messages
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
see Rear-view mirror
see Vanity mirror
Mobile phone
Frequencies ................................... 351
Installation ..................................... 351
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 219
Notes/placing in the bracket ......... 292
Transmission output (maximum) .... 351
Modifying the programming (key) ..... 79
MOExtended run-flat system ........... 324
Motorway mode ................................ 112
MP3
Operating ....................................... 218
see Separate operating instructions
Multifunction display
4-button multifunction steering
wheel ............................................. 207
Permanent display (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 223
Multi-function display
12-button multifunction steering
wheel ............................................. 212
Multifunction steering wheel (12button)
see 12-button multifunction
steering wheel
15
16
Index
Multifunction steering wheel (4
buttons)
see 4-button multifunction steering wheel
N
Navigation
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 216
On-board computer (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 216
see separate operating instructions
NECK-PRO head restraints
Operation ......................................... 50
Resetting after being triggered ........ 51
Notes on running in a new vehicle . . 136
O
Occupant safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 55
Important safety notes .................... 44
Odometer
4-button multifunction steering
wheel ............................................. 209
see Total distance recorder
see Trip meter
Oil
see Engine oil
On-board computer
RACETIMER ................................... 229
On-board computer (12-button
multifunction steering wheel)
AMG menu ..................................... 229
Assist menu ................................... 220
Audio menu ................................... 217
Convenience submenu .................. 228
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 171
Important safety notes .................. 206
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 223
Lights submenu ............................. 224
Menu overview .............................. 214
Navigation menu ............................ 216
Operating ....................................... 211
Operating the video DVD ............... 218
Range ............................................ 215
Service menu ................................. 222
Standard display submenu ............ 215
Telephone menu ............................ 219
Trip menu ...................................... 215
On-board computer (12-button
multifunction steering wheel)
Displaying service messages ......... 305
Display messages .......................... 232
Heating submenu ........................... 227
Message memory .......................... 233
Vehicle submenu ........................... 225
On-board computer (12-button
multifunction steering wheel)Settings menu ......................................... 223
On-board computer (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) submenu
Factory setting ............................... 228
On-board computer (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Important safety notes .................. 206
Menu overview .............................. 209
Switching daytime driving lights
on/off ............................................ 210
On-board computer (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Displaying service messages ......... 305
Display messages .......................... 232
Individual vehicle settings .............. 207
Message memory .......................... 232
Operating ....................................... 207
Range ............................................ 210
Standard display ............................ 209
Trip computer ................................ 210
Opening and closing the side trim
panels ................................................. 117
Operating system
see On-board computer
Outside temperature
Display (12-button multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 211
Display (4-button multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 207
Overhead control panel ...................... 41
P
Paint code .......................................... 352
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) . . . 307
Index
Panorama sliding sunroof
Important safety information ........... 90
Opening/closing .............................. 91
Opening/closing the roller sunblind ................................................. 92
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 92
Rain closing feature ......................... 91
Resetting ......................................... 92
Park Assist
Parking Guidance ........................... 183
Parking
Important safety notes .................. 158
Parking brake ................................ 159
Position of exterior mirror, frontpassenger side ............................... 104
Reversing camera .......................... 186
see Parking
see PARKTRONIC
Parking aid
see Exterior mirrors
see PARKTRONIC
Parking brake
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 240
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 235
Notes/function .............................. 159
see Parking brake
Parking Guidance
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 259
Important safety notes .................. 183
Trailer towing ................................. 186
Parking lamp
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 250
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 246
Parking lamps
Changing bulbs .............................. 117
Switching on/off ........................... 108
Parking lamps (changing bulbs) ...... 117
PARKTRONIC
Deactivating/activating ................. 182
Driving system ............................... 179
Function/notes ............................. 179
Problem (fault) ............................... 183
Sensor range ................................. 180
Trailer towing ................................. 182
Warning display ............................. 181
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning
lamp ...................................................... 57
Petrol .................................................. 153
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) . 310
Power windows
see Side windows
PRE-SAFE® (preventative occupant
protection)
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 241
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 236
PRE-SAFE® (preventive occupant
safety system)
Operation ......................................... 50
PRE-SAFE® Brake (vehicles with
DISTRONIC PLUS)
Function/notes ................................ 71
PRE-SAFE® Brake (vehicles with
DISTRONIC PLUS)
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 242
Switching on/off ........................... 221
Warning lamp ................................. 282
Preventive occupant safety system
see PRE-SAFE® (preventive occupant safety system)
Program selector button .................. 147
Pulling away
Automatic transmission ................. 140
Manual transmission ...................... 139
Q
Qualified specialist workshop ........... 26
R
RACE START (AMG vehicles) .............
RACETIMER (on-board computer) ....
Radar sensor system
Activating/deactivating .................
Country overview ...........................
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
178
229
226
363
257
17
18
Index
Radio
Selecting a station (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 217
see separate operating instructions
Rain closing feature (panorama
sliding sunroof) ................................... 91
Range (fuel)
Displaying (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ....................... 215
Displaying (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ....................... 210
Reading lamp ..................................... 114
Rear compartment
Setting the air vents ...................... 133
Rear-compartment seat belt status indicator ........................................ 54
Rear foglamp
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 249
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 246
Switching on/off ........................... 109
Rear seat (folding the backrest forwards/back) ...................................... 286
Rear-view mirror
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) ........ 104
Dipping (manual) ........................... 103
Rear window heating
Problem (fault) ............................... 127
Switching on/off ........................... 126
Refuelling
Fuel gauge ....................................... 32
Important safety notes .................. 152
Refuelling process ......................... 155
see Fuel
Releasing the parking lock manually (automatic transmission) ........ 152
Remote control
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 129
Changing the batteries (auxiliary
heating) ......................................... 130
Garage door opener ....................... 294
Replacing the battery (auxiliary
heating remote control) .................... 130
Reserve (fuel tank)
see Fuel
Reserve fuel
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 255
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 253
Warning lamp ................................. 280
Restraint system
see SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System)
Rev counter
12-button multifunction steering
wheel ............................................. 210
4-button multifunction steering
wheel ............................................. 206
Reverse gear
Engaging (automatic transmission) ............................................... 146
Engaging (manual transmission) .... 145
Reversing camera
Cleaning instructions ..................... 309
Function/notes ............................. 186
Reversing lamp
Changing bulbs .............................. 118
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 250
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 246
Roller blind
see Roller sunblind
Roller sunblind
Opening/closing .............................. 92
Panorama sliding sunroof ................ 92
Roof carrier ........................................ 288
Roof load (maximum)
see Technical data
Route
see Route guidance (navigation)
Route guidance (navigation) ............ 216
S
Safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 55
Child restraint systems .................... 55
Safety systems
see Driving safety systems
Index
Seat
Seat backrest display message
(12-button multifunction steering
wheel) ............................................ 268
Seat backrest display message (4button multifunction steering
wheel) ............................................ 266
Seat belt
Activating/deactivating seat-belt
adjustment (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ....................... 228
Adjusting the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt ......................... 53
Belt force limiter .............................. 54
Belt tensioner .................................. 54
Cleaning ......................................... 311
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 242
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 236
Fastening ......................................... 53
Important safety guidelines ............. 51
Rear seat belt status indicator ......... 54
Releasing ......................................... 53
Warning lamp (function) ................... 54
Seat belts
Warning lamp ................................. 273
Seats
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 98
Adjusting (manually and electrically) ................................................ 98
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support .................................................. 99
Adjusting the head restraint ............ 98
Cleaning the cover ......................... 311
Correct driver's seat position ........... 96
Folding the backrests forward/
back ................................................. 99
Important safety notes .................... 97
Seat heating problem .................... 100
Seat ventilation problem ................ 101
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 105
Switching seat heating on/off ....... 100
Switching the seat ventilation on/
off .................................................. 100
Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 309
Service
see ASSYST PLUS service interval
display
Service menu (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .................. 222
Service products
Brake fluid ..................................... 356
Coolant (engine) ............................ 356
Engine oil ....................................... 355
Fuel ................................................ 354
Important safety notes .................. 353
Settings
Factory (12-button multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 228
On-board computer (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 223
Setting the air distribution ............... 125
Setting the airflow ............................ 125
SETUP (on-board computer) ............. 229
Shifting to neutral (manual transmission) ............................................. 145
Sidebag ................................................ 48
Side marker lamp
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 250
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 246
Side windows
Convenience closing ........................ 89
Convenience opening ...................... 88
Important safety notes .................... 88
Opening/closing .............................. 88
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 90
resetting .......................................... 90
Sliding sunroof
see Panorama sliding sunroof
Snow chains ...................................... 338
Socket
Centre console .............................. 292
Points to observe before use ......... 291
Rear compartment ......................... 292
Spare wheel
Storage location ............................ 316
see Emergency spare wheel
Specialist workshop ............................ 26
Speed, controlling
see Cruise control
19
20
Index
Speed Limit Assist
Activating/deactivating the warning function .................................... 220
Displaying ...................................... 220
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 257
Display message in the multifunction display .................................... 189
Important safety notes .................. 189
Speedometer
Activating/deactivating the additional speedometer ........................ 223
Digital ............................................ 215
In the instrument cluster (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .... 35
In the instrument cluster (4-button multifunction steering wheel) .... 32
Segments ...................................... 211
Selecting the unit of measurement .............................................. 223
see Instrument cluster
SPEEDTRONIC
Deactivating variable ..................... 175
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 261
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 256
Function/notes ............................. 173
Important safety notes .................. 173
LIM indicator lamp ......................... 174
Permanent ..................................... 176
Selecting ........................................ 174
Storing the current speed .............. 175
Variable ......................................... 174
SPORT handling mode
Activating/deactivating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 69
Warning lamp ................................. 278
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 243
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 237
Introduction ..................................... 45
Warning lamp ................................. 279
Warning lamp (function) ................... 45
Starting (engine) ................................ 138
Station
see Radio
Steering
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 269
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 267
Steering wheel
Adjusting (electrically) ................... 102
Adjusting (manually) ...................... 101
Buttons (12-button multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 211
Buttons (4-button multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 207
Gearshift paddles ........................... 148
Important safety notes .................. 101
Storing settings (memory function) ............................................... 105
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .... 148
Stopwatch (RACETIMER) ................... 229
Stowage compartments
Armrest (under) ............................. 285
Centre console .............................. 285
Cup holder ..................................... 289
Glove compartment ....................... 285
Important safety information ......... 284
Luggage net ................................... 285
Stowage well beneath the boot
floor .................................................... 288
Summer opening
see Convenience opening feature
Summer tyres .................................... 337
Sun visor ............................................ 290
Supplement Restraint System
see SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System)
Surround lighting (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 225
Switching off the alarm (ATA) ............ 73
Index
T
Tail lamp
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 249
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 245
Tank
see Fuel tank
Tank content
Displaying the range (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 215
Displaying the range (4-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 210
Fuel gauge (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ......................... 35
Fuel gauge (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ......................... 32
Technical data
C 220 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY ........... 359
C 250 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY ........... 360
C 63 AMG ...................................... 359
Notes ............................................. 350
Trailer loads ................................... 362
Tyres/wheels ................................. 345
Technical Data
C 180 BlueEFFICIENCY .................. 357
C 250 BlueEFFICIENCY .................. 358
C 350 BlueEFFICIENCY .................. 358
Telephone
Accepting a call ............................. 219
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 269
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 219
Number from the phone book ........ 219
Redialling ....................................... 220
Rejecting/ending a call ................. 219
Telephone compartment ................ 285
Temperature
Coolant (12-button multifunction
steering wheel; AMG) ..................... 229
Coolant (12-button multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 210
Coolant (4-button multifunction
steering wheel) .............................. 206
Engine oil (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ....................... 229
Outside temperature (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 211
Outside temperature (4-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 207
Setting (climate control) ................ 125
TEMPOMAT
Function/notes ............................. 162
Through-loading feature ................... 286
Timing (RACETIMER) ......................... 229
TIREFIT kit .......................................... 317
Top Tether ............................................ 59
Total distance recorder
Displaying (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ....................... 215
Displaying (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ....................... 209
Tow-away protection .......................... 73
Towing
Important safety notes .................. 330
With the rear axle raised ................ 332
Towing a trailer
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 197
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 199
Axle load, permissible .................... 363
Bulb failure indicator for LED
lamps ............................................. 203
Lights display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) . . 248
Lights display message (4-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 244
Trailer tow hitch display message
(4-button multifunction steering
wheel) ............................................ 266
Towing away
Fitting the towing eye .................... 331
Removing the towing eye ............... 332
With both axles on the ground ....... 332
Tow-starting
Emergency engine starting ............ 333
Fitting the towing eye .................... 331
Important safety notes .................. 330
Removing the towing eye ............... 332
Trailer coupling
see Towing a trailer
Trailer towing
7-pin connector ............................. 204
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 192
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch ......... 309
21
22
Index
Coupling up a trailer ...................... 202
Decoupling a trailer ....................... 202
Driving tips .................................... 199
ESP® ................................................ 70
Folding in the ball coupling ............ 202
Folding out the ball coupling .......... 201
Important safety notes .................. 199
Mounting dimensions .................... 361
Parking Guidance ........................... 186
Parktronic ...................................... 182
Power supply ................................. 203
Shift range ..................................... 147
Trailer loads ................................... 362
Transmission
see Automatic transmission
see Manual transmission
Transporting the vehicle .................. 332
Trim pieces (cleaning instructions) . 311
Trip computer
On-board computer (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 215
On-board computer (4-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 210
Trip meter
Displaying/resetting (4-button
multifunction steering wheel) ........ 209
Displaying (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ....................... 215
Resetting (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ....................... 216
Trip odometer
see Trip meter
Turn signal
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 248
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 245
Turn signals
Switching on/off ........................... 110
Two-way radio
Frequencies ................................... 351
Installation ..................................... 351
Transmission output (maximum) .... 351
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
Tyre pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) .....
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Not reached (TIREFIT) ....................
Pressure loss warning ....................
Reached (TIREFIT) ..........................
Recommended ...............................
Tyre pressure monitor
Function/notes .............................
Restarting ......................................
Warning lamp .................................
Tyres
Checking ........................................
Direction of rotation ......................
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) ..............
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................
Grip ................................................
Important safety notes ..................
Replacing .......................................
Service life .....................................
Storing ...........................................
Tyre size (data) ..............................
Tyre tread ......................................
see Flat tyre
342
263
262
319
340
320
339
342
343
282
336
344
263
262
161
336
344
337
344
345
337
U
Unladen weight
see Technical data
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 85
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 84
V
Vanity mirror (in sun visor) .............. 290
Vehicle
Correct use ...................................... 27
Data acquisition ............................... 27
Electronics ..................................... 351
Equipment ....................................... 25
Implied warranty .............................. 27
Individual settings .......................... 223
Index
Leaving parked up ......................... 159
Locking (in an emergency) ............... 85
Locking (key) ................................... 78
Lowering ........................................ 324
Pulling away ................................... 139
Raising ........................................... 322
Registration ..................................... 26
Towing away .................................. 330
Tow-starting ................................... 330
Transporting .................................. 332
Unlocking (in an emergency) ........... 85
Unlocking (key) ................................ 78
Vehicle battery
see Battery (vehicle)
Vehicle data
see Technical data
Vehicle dimensions
see Technical data
Vehicle emergency locking ................ 85
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 352
Vehicle tool kit .................................. 315
Vehicle weights
see Technical data
Vents
see Air vents
Video (DVD) ........................................ 218
Video DVD (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .......................... 218
VIN ...................................................... 352
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................ 275
Brakes ........................................... 275
Distance warning signal ................. 282
ESP® .............................................. 277
ESP® OFF ....................................... 277
LIM (cruise control) ........................ 162
LIM (DISTRONIC PLUS) .................. 166
LIM (variable SPEEDTRONIC) ......... 174
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF ................ 57
Reserve fuel ................................... 280
Seat belt ........................................ 273
SRS ................................................ 279
Tyre pressure monitor ................... 282
Warning triangle ................................ 314
Washer fluid
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 267
see Windscreen washer system
Weight
see Technical data
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 324
Wheel chock ...................................... 321
Wheels
Changing/replacing ....................... 344
Changing a wheel .......................... 321
Checking ........................................ 336
Cleaning ......................................... 307
Fitting a wheel ............................... 323
Important safety notes .................. 336
Removing a wheel .......................... 323
Storing ........................................... 344
Tightening torque ........................... 324
Wheel size/tyre size ...................... 345
Windowbag
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 244
Display message (4-button multifunction steering wheel) ................ 237
Operation ......................................... 49
Windows
Cleaning ......................................... 308
see Side windows
Windscreen
Demisting ...................................... 126
Windscreen washer fluid
Display message (12-button multifunction steering wheel) .............. 269
Windscreen washer system ............. 304
Windscreen wipers
Problem (malfunction) ................... 120
Replacing the wiper blades ............ 119
Switching on/off ........................... 118
Winter operation
Important safety notes .................. 337
Slippery road surfaces ................... 162
Snow chains .................................. 338
23
24
Index
Winter tyres
Limiting the speed (on-board computer) .............................................
M+S tyres ......................................
Wiper blades
Cleaning .........................................
Important safety notes ..................
Replacing .......................................
Wooden trim (cleaning instructions) ..................................................
225
337
308
119
119
311
Introduction
Protection of the environment
Notes
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of integrated
environmental protection.
The objectives are for the natural resources
which form the basis of our existence on this
planet to be used sparingly and in a manner
which takes the requirements of both nature
and humanity into account.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. You should
bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions:
Ryour
Ravoid short trips as these increase fuel con-
sumption.
sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight.
Rkeep an eye on the vehicle's fuel consumption.
Rremove roof racks once you no longer need
them.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Ralways have maintenance work carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Personal driving style:
Rmake
Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when
starting the engine.
Rdo not warm up the engine with the vehicle
stationary.
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
frequent, sudden acceleration.
Rchange gear in good time and use each gear
only up to Ô of its maximum engine speed.
Ravoid
Rswitch
off the engine in stationary traffic.
Returning end-of-life vehicles
Mercedes-Benz will take back your
Mercedes-Benz to dispose of it in an environmentally responsible manner, in accordance
with the European Union (EU) End of Life
Vehicles Directive.
The End of Life Vehicles Directive applies to
vehicles with a gross vehicle weight of up to
3.5 t, in accordance with national regulations.
For several years, Mercedes-Benz has been
meeting all the legal requirements for a
design which allows for recycling and reuse.
There is a network of return points and disassembly plants which can recycle your vehicle in an environmentally responsible manner. The options for recycling vehicles and
parts are constantly being developed and
improved. This means that your MercedesBenz will also continue to meet even the
increased recycling quotas in the future in
good time. You can obtain further information
from your national Mercedes-Benz homepage
or your national hotline number.
Vehicle equipment
This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment of
your vehicle available at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Country-specific
differences are possible. Please note that
your vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions. The equipment in your vehicle may therefore differ from
that shown in the descriptions and illustrations. All the systems found in your vehicle
Z
25
26
Introduction
are listed in the original purchase agreement
of your vehicle. Should you have any questions concerning equipment and operation,
please consult a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Operating safety
Safety notes
G WARNING
All work on the vehicle and, in particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. The specialist workshop
must have the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose.
G WARNING
Some safety systems only function when the
engine is running. You should therefore never
switch off the engine when driving. Otherwise,
the safety systems of your vehicle may not
function correctly and as a result will no longer protect you and other persons as intended. In addition, there is a risk that you may
lose control of your vehicle and thus cause an
accident.
G WARNING
Work carried out incorrectly, or alterations
made to the vehicle, e.g. re-routing of cables
under coverings, could cause the safety systems of your vehicle to stop working properly.
The safety systems would thus no longer protect you and other persons as intended. In
addition, there is a risk that you may lose control of your vehicle and thus cause an accident.
All work and alterations to the vehicle, e.g.
installations or modifications, should therefore be carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G WARNING
If work on electronic equipment and its software is carried out incorrectly, this equipment
could stop working. The electronic systems
are networked via interfaces. Tampering with
these electronic systems could cause malfunctions in systems which have not been
modified. Malfunctions such as these can
seriously jeopardise the vehicle's operating
safety and therefore your own safety.
You should therefore have all work and modifications to electronic components carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Qualified specialist workshop
A qualified specialist workshop has the necessary specialist knowledge, tools and qualifications to correctly carry out the work
required on your vehicle. This is especially the
case for work relevant to safety.
Observe the information in the Service Booklet.
Always have the following work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop:
Rwork
relevant to safety
and maintenance work
Rrepair work
Ralterations, installation work and modifications
Rwork on electronic components
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Rservice
Vehicle registration
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres
to carry out technical inspections on certain
vehicles to improve their quality or safety.
If you did not purchase your vehicle from an
authorised specialist dealer and your vehicle
has never been inspected at a MercedesBenz Service Centre, it is possible that your
vehicle is not registered in your name with
Introduction
Mercedes-Benz. Mercedes-Benz can only
inform you about vehicle checks if it has your
registration data.
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership.
Data stored in the vehicle
Fault data
Correct use
Components critical for vehicle operation are
equipped with fault data memories as standard. There are also data storage devices
which record the technical reactions of vehicle components to certain driving situations
(e.g. airbag deployment or ESP® intervention).
This data is used exclusively to:
G WARNING
Rassist
Various warning stickers are affixed to your
vehicle. Their purpose is to draw your attention, and the attention of others, to various
dangers. Therefore, do not remove any warning stickers unless the sticker clearly states
that you may do so.
If you remove the warning stickers, you or
others could be injured by failing to recognise
certain dangers.
Observe the following information when using
your vehicle:
Rthe
safety notes in this manual
"Technical data" section in this manual
Rnational road traffic regulations
Rnational road traffic licensing regulations
Rthe
Implied warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual
about the proper operation of your vehicle
as well as about possible vehicle damage.
Damage to your vehicle that arises from
culpable contraventions against these
instructions are not covered either by
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty or by the
New or Used-Vehicle Warranty of
Daimler AG.
in the rectification of faults and
defects
Rhelp Mercedes-Benz optimise and develop
vehicle functions
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced by MercedesBenz, this technical information can be read
out from the fault memory. This is performed
by authorised employees of the MercedesBenz service network using special diagnostic computers.
After a fault has been rectified, the information is deleted from the memory. Other memory data is constantly overwritten.
Other devices that store data
Depending on the equipment level, your vehicle may feature communications and/or
entertainment systems (e.g. navigation devices, telephone systems). These allow you to
save and edit data required for the operation
of the respective device.
Further information on operation (e.g. on
deleting data) can be found in the separate
operating instructions.
Z
27
28
29
30
32
35
38
40
41
42
At a glance
Cockpit .................................................
Instrument cluster (4-button steering wheel) ............................................
Instrument cluster (12-button
steering wheel) ...................................
Multifunction steering wheel .............
Centre console ....................................
Overhead control panel ......................
Door control panel ..............................
30
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
:
Page
Automatic transmission:
steering wheel gearshift
paddles
148
;
Cruise control lever
162
=
Instrument cluster (4-button steering wheel)
Instrument cluster (12-button steering wheel)
207
211
?
Horn
A
PARKTRONIC warning display
B
Overhead control panel
41
C
Climate control systems
122
D
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
137
137
E
Adjusts the steering wheel
manually
101
F
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
101
G
Combination switch
110
H
Parking brake
159
179
Function
Page
I
On-board diagnostics connection
J
Opens the bonnet
301
K
Releases the parking brake
159
L
Light switch
108
M
Headlamp range adjustment
110
31
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Overhead control panel
;
PARKTRONIC warning display
179
=
Cruise control lever
162
?
Instrument cluster (4-button steering wheel)
Instrument cluster (12-button steering wheel)
A
Horn
B
Automatic transmission:
steering wheel gearshift
paddles
C
D
41
207
211
148
Headlamp range adjustment
110
Light switch
108
Function
Page
E
Releases the parking brake
159
F
Opens the bonnet
301
G
On-board diagnostics connection
H
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
137
137
I
Adjusts the steering wheel
manually
101
J
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
101
K
Combination switch
110
L
Parking brake
159
M
Climate control systems
122
32
Instrument cluster (4-button steering wheel)
At a glance
Instrument cluster (4-button steering wheel)
Displays and controls
i Instrument cluster: kilometres
Function
Function
Page
:
Fuel gauge
;
Coolant temperature
=
Speedometer
?
Rev counter
206
A
ECO start/stop function
Automatic transmission:
Transmission position and
drive program
Manual transmission:
Gearshift recommendation
Outside temperature
HOLD function
Stored limit speed
140
Multifunction display
207
B
C
206
146
145
207
177
173
D
Time
Automatic transmission:
Outside temperature (vehicles for the United Kingdom: speed in km/h)
HOLD function
Stored limit speed
Brightness control knob for
the instrument cluster lighting: turn clockwise or anticlockwise
Page
207
177
173
33
At a glance
Instrument cluster (4-button steering wheel)
i Instrument cluster: miles
Function
Function
Page
:
Fuel gauge
;
Coolant temperature
=
Speedometer
?
Rev counter
206
A
ECO start/stop function
Automatic transmission:
Transmission position and
drive program
Manual transmission:
Gearshift recommendation
Outside temperature
HOLD function
Stored limit speed
140
B
Multifunction display
207
C
Time
Automatic transmission:
Outside temperature (vehicles for the United Kingdom: speed in km/h)
HOLD function
Stored limit speed
207
177
173
206
D
145
207
177
173
Page
Brightness control knob for
the instrument cluster lighting: turn clockwise or anticlockwise
34
Instrument cluster (4-button steering wheel)
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
Page
Function
Page
:
Reserve fuel
280
D
Engine diagnostics
280
;
Coolant
280
E
ESP®
277
=
ABS
275
F
Rear foglamp
109
?
Brakes
275
G
Main-beam headlamps
110
A
Seat belt
273
H
Dipped-beam headlamps
109
B
Turn signal
110
I
Front foglamps
109
C
SRS
279
J
Diesel engine: preglow
139
Instrument cluster (12-button steering wheel)
35
Instrument cluster (12-button steering wheel)
At a glance
Displays and controls
i Instrument cluster: kilometres
Function
Page
:
Fuel gauge
;
Coolant temperature
210
=
Speedometer with segments
211
?
Multifunction display
212
A
Rev counter
210
B
Brightness control knob for
the instrument cluster lighting: turn clockwise or anticlockwise
Instrument cluster (12-button steering wheel)
At a glance
36
i Instrument cluster: miles
Function
Function
Page
:
Fuel gauge
;
Coolant temperature
210
=
Speedometer with segments
211
?
Multifunction display
212
A
Rev counter
B
Brightness control knob for
the instrument cluster lighting: turn clockwise or anticlockwise
Page
210
Instrument cluster (12-button steering wheel)
37
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
:
Page
Function
Page
E
Tyre pressure monitor
282
F
Seat belt
273
G
% Diesel engine: preglow
÷ ESP® in AMG vehicles
139
H
Coolant
280
275
I
Rear foglamp
109
Turn signal
110
J
Main-beam headlamps
110
B
ABS
275
K
Dipped-beam headlamps
109
C
SRS
279
L
Front foglamps
109
D
Engine diagnostics
280
M
Reserve fuel
280
÷ ESP®
M SPORT handling
mode in AMG vehicles
277
:
ESP®
277
;
Distance warning signal
282
=
ESP® OFF
277
?
Brakes
A
278
278
38
Multifunction steering wheel
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
4-button multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Audio system; see the separate operating instructions
=
W
Increases the volume
?
X
Decreases the volume
A
C
Scrolls through lists
Changes values
Confirms display messages
Page
207
Function
B
V
Press briefly:
Selects a menu
Press and hold:
Selects the standard display
Page
Multifunction steering wheel
39
At a glance
12-button multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Audio system/COMAND
Online; see the separate
operating instructions
=
?
Switches on LINGUATRONIC; see the separate
operating instructions
?
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits telephone book/
redial memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
WX
Adjusts the volume
8
Mute
Page
212
Function
A
B
219
=;
Selects a menu
9:
Selects the submenu or
scrolls through lists
a
Confirms selections and
hides display messages
%
Back or deactivates LINGUATRONIC
Page
214
214
40
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console
Function
:
Page
Audio system/COMAND
Online; see separate operating instructions
Function
Page
E
& Auxiliary heating
128
F
Stowage compartment
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
284
290
291
291
;
c Seat heating
100
=
s Seat ventilation
100
?
c PARKTRONIC
179
G
A
¤ ECO start/stop button
Gear lever
Selector lever
144
146
140
H
£ Hazard warning
lamps
Stowage compartment
Cup holder
284
289
111
I
Stowage compartment
284
J
Audio/COMAND controller
K
Selects the drive program
B
C
D
4 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp
M Dynamic driving
package with sports mode
å AMG vehicles: ESP®
57
176
69
147
Overhead control panel
41
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
:
;
=
?
A
u Switches the rear
interior lighting on/off
Page
114
| Switches the automatic interior lighting control on/off
114
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
114
ë Deactivates towaway protection
73
3 Opens/closes the
panorama sliding sunroof
with roller sunblinds
91
Function
Page
B
Rear-view mirror
C
ê Deactivates the interior motion sensor
74
p Switches the lefthand reading lamp on/off
114
c Switches the front
interior lighting on/off
114
D
E
103
42
Door control panel
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
Page
:
Opens the door
84
;
%& Unlocks/locks
the vehicle
84
=
Adjusts the seat electrically
98
?
r45=
Stores settings for the seat,
exterior mirrors and steering wheel
105
7Zö\
Adjusts and folds the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
103
A
B
C
W Opens/closes the
side windows
88
o Opens the boot lid
87
Useful information ..............................
Occupant safety ..................................
Children in the vehicle ........................
Driving safety systems .......................
Anti-theft systems ..............................
44
44
55
65
73
Safety
43
44
Occupant safety
Useful information
Safety
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
Occupant safety
Important safety notes
Seat belts, together with the Supplemental
Restraint System – SRS (Y page 45), are
complementary, co-ordinated restraint systems. They reduce the risk of injury in specific, pre-defined types of accident situations
and thereby increase occupant safety. However, seat belts and airbags generally do not
protect against objects penetrating the vehicle from the outside.
To ensure that the restraint systems can
deliver their full potential protection, make
sure that:
Rthe
seat and head restraint are adjusted
properly (Y page 96).
Rthe seat belt has been fastened properly
(Y page 53).
Rthe airbags can inflate unrestricted if
deployed (Y page 46).
Rthe steering wheel is adjusted properly
(Y page 96).
Rthe restraint systems have not been modified.
i An airbag increases the protection of
vehicle occupants wearing a seat belt. As
such, they are only an additional restraint
system which complements, but does not
replace, the seat belt. All vehicle occupants
must wear their seat belt correctly at all
times, even if the vehicle is equipped with
airbags. The airbags are not deployed in all
types of accidents. For example, if the protective capacity of correctly fastened seat
belts is not increased by deploying the airbags, the airbags will not deploy. Airbag
deployment only provides increased protection if the seat belt is worn correctly
because:
Rthe seat belt helps to keep the vehicle
occupant in the best position in relation
to the airbag.
Rin a head-on collision, for example, the
seat belt prevents the vehicle occupant
from being propelled towards the point
of impact. It can thus reduce the risk of
injury.
In accidents in which an airbag is deployed,
it provides increased protection only if the
seat belt is worn correctly.
G WARNING
If service work is not carried out correctly, the
operating safety of your vehicle may be affected. This could cause you to lose control of
your vehicle and cause an accident. Moreover, the safety systems may no longer be
able to protect you or others as they are
designed to do.
Always have service work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop. The workshop
must have the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
G WARNING
Modifications to or work performed incorrectly on the following parts can result in the
restraint systems not functioning as intended:
If SRS is malfunctioning, individual systems
may be activated unintentionally or may not
be triggered in the event of an accident with
a high rate of vehicle deceleration.
A malfunction has occurred if:
Rthe
restraint system, consisting of seat
belts and their anchorage points, belt tensioners, belt force limiters and airbags
Rthe wiring
Rnetworked electronic systems
Airbags and belt tensioners could fail to
deploy or be triggered in an accident despite
the deceleration force being sufficient to trigger the systems, or could be triggered unintentionally. For this reason, never make any
modifications to the restraint systems.
Therefore, you must not tamper with electronic components or their software.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Introduction
SRS consists of:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp
Rairbags
Rairbag
control unit (with crash sensors)
tensioners
Rbelt force limiters
SRS reduces the risk of occupants coming
into contact with the vehicle's interior in the
event of an accident. It can also reduce the
effect of the forces to which occupants are
subjected during an accident.
Rbelt
SRS warning lamp
SRS functions are checked regularly when
you switch on the ignition and when the
engine is running. Therefore, malfunctions
can be detected in good time.
The 6 SRS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out no later than a few seconds
after the engine is started.
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp does not light
up when the ignition is switched on.
Rthe engine is running and the 6 SRS
warning lamp does not go out after a few
seconds.
Rthe engine is running and the 6 SRS
warning lamp lights up again.
In this case, have SRS checked immediately
at a qualified specialist workshop. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a MercedesBenz Service Centre for this purpose.
In particular, work relevant to safety or on
safety-related systems must be carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Triggering of belt tensioners, belt force
limiters and airbags
During the first stage of a collision, the airbag
control unit evaluates important physical
data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as:
Rduration
Rdirection
Rmagnitude
Based on the evaluation of this data, the airbag control unit pre-emptively triggers the
belt tensioners in the first stage.
i The front belt tensioners can only be trig-
gered if the seat belt tongues on the front
seats are correctly engaged in the seat belt
buckles.
If there is an even higher rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration in a longitudinal direction, the front airbags are also deployed.
Your vehicle has adaptive, two-stage front airbags. The airbag control unit evaluates vehicle deceleration or acceleration in the event
Z
45
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
46
Occupant safety
of a collision. In the first deployment stage,
the front airbag is filled with enough propellant gas to reduce the risk of injuries. The
front airbag is fully deployed if a second
deployment threshold is exceeded within a
few milliseconds.
The belt tensioner and airbag triggering
thresholds are variable and are adapted to the
rate of deceleration or acceleration of the
vehicle. This process is pre-emptive in nature.
The triggering process must take place in
good time at the start of the collision.
i Airbags are not deployed in all types of
accidents. Also, not all airbags are
deployed together in an accident. The different airbag systems work independently
of each other.
How the airbag system works is determined by the severity of the collision detected, especially the vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, and the apparent type of accident:
Rhead-on
collision
impact
Rrear impact
Rside
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration and the direction of the force are essentially determined by:
Rthe
distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a
decisive role in the deployment of an airbag,
nor do they provide an indication of airbag
deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly,
e.g. the bonnet or the wing, without an airbag
being deployed. This is the case if only parts
which are relatively easily deformed are affec-
ted and the rate of deceleration is not high.
Conversely, airbags may be deployed even
though the vehicle suffers only minor deformation. This is the case if, for example, very
rigid vehicle parts such as longitudinal body
members are hit, and sufficient deceleration
occurs as a result.
Airbags
Important safety notes
Airbag deployment slows down and restricts
the movement of the vehicle occupant.
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that is
released generally does not constitute a
health hazard. The 6 SRS warning lamp
lights up.
The airbag installation locations are identified
by the AIRBAG symbol.
G WARNING
Airbags provide additional protection; they
are not, however, a substitute for seat belts.
Observe the following notes to reduce the risk
of serious or even fatal injury caused by airbag
deployment:
Rall
vehicle occupants – in particular, pregnant women – must wear their seat belt
correctly at all times and lean back against
the backrest, which should be positioned
as close to the vertical as possible. The
head restraint must support the back of the
head at about eye level.
Ralways secure children less than 1.50 m tall
and under 12 years of age in suitable child
restraint systems.
Rall vehicle occupants must select a seat
position that is as far away from the airbag
as possible. The driver's seat position must
allow the vehicle to be driven safely. The
driver's chest should be as far away from
Occupant safety
Rdo
not lean on the doors from inside the
vehicle.
Rmake sure that there are no people, animals or objects between the vehicle occupants and the area where the airbags are
deployed.
Rdo not place any objects between the seat
backrest and the door.
Rdo not hang any hard objects, for example,
coat hangers, on the grab handles or coat
hooks.
Rdo not attach accessories, e.g. cup holders,
to the doors.
It is not possible to rule out a risk of injury
being caused by an airbag, due to the high
speed at which the airbag must be deployed.
G WARNING
Airbag functionality can only be assured if the
following parts are not covered and no badges
or stickers are attached to them:
Rpadded
steering wheel boss
cover below the steering column
Rfront-passenger airbag cover
Router side of front seat bolsters
Rside trim next to the rear seat backrest
Rroof frame cover between the front A-pillar
and the C-pillar in the rear compartment
Rkneebag
G WARNING
A small amount of powder is released when
an airbag is deployed. The powder could
cause short-term breathing difficulties in people with asthma or other respiratory problems.
In order to prevent breathing difficulties, you
should leave the vehicle as soon as it is safe
to do so. You can also open the window to
allow fresh air to enter the interior. The powder does not constitute a health hazard and
does not indicate that there is a fire in the
vehicle.
Z
Safety
the centre of the driver's airbag cover as
possible.
Rmove the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible. This is especially important if
you have secured a child in a child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
Rvehicle occupants – in particular, children
– must not lean their heads into the area of
the window in which the sidebag/windowbag is deployed.
Rrearward-facing child restraint systems
must not be fitted to the front-passenger
seat unless the front-passenger airbag has
been disabled. On the front-passenger
seat, the front-passenger airbag is disabled
if a child restraint system with a transponder for automatic child seat recognition
is fitted to the front-passenger seat in a
vehicle equipped with automatic child seat
recognition. The 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp must be continuously
lit.
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle
does not have automatic child seat recognition, or your rearward-facing child
restraint system does not have automatic
child seat recognition, children must be
secured in a child restraint system on a
suitable seat in the rear. If you secure a
forward-facing child restraint system to the
front-passenger seat, you must move the
front-passenger seat as far back as possible.
Rmake sure there are no heavy or sharpedged objects in the pockets of clothing.
Rdo not lean forwards, e.g. over the cover of
the driver's/front-passenger airbag, particularly when the vehicle is in motion.
Rdo not put your feet on the dashboard.
Ronly hold the steering wheel on the outside.
This allows the airbag to be fully deployed.
You could be injured if the airbag is
deployed and you are holding the inside of
the steering wheel.
47
48
Occupant safety
Safety
G WARNING
The airbag parts are hot after the airbag has
been deployed. Do not touch them as you
could burn yourself.
Have the airbags replaced at a qualified specialist workshop. Otherwise, occupants are
not protected by the airbags in the event of
another accident.
Front airbags
The front airbags increase protection for the
driver's and front-passenger's head and
chest.
out automatic child seat recognition has been
fitted or that a child restraint system with
automatic child seat recognition is incorrectly
fitted.
! Do not place heavy objects on the front-
passenger seat. The system may then
detect that the seat is occupied and if there
is an accident, the restraint systems on the
front-passenger side could be deployed.
Have restraint systems that have been triggered replaced.
Driver's kneebag
i The driver's kneebag is only available in
certain countries.
The driver's kneebag increases protection of
the driver against:
Rknee
injuries
injuries
Rlower leg injuries
Rthigh
Driver's airbag : deploys in front of the
steering wheel; front-passenger airbag ;
deploys in front of and above the glove compartment.
They are deployed:
Rat
the start of an accident with a high rate
of vehicle acceleration or deceleration in a
longitudinal direction
Rif the system determines that airbag
deployment can offer additional protection
to that provided by the seat belt
Rif the seat belt is fastened
Rindependently of other airbags in the vehicle
Front-passenger airbag ; is only activated if
the system determines that the frontpassenger seat is occupied. The 4
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp on
the centre console is not lit (Y page 57).
This means that a child restraint system with-
Driver's kneebag : is always deployed along
with the driver's airbag and inflates underneath the steering column.
Sidebags
G WARNING
If you wish to use seat covers, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that, for safety reasons, you
only use seat covers that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The seat covers must have a special tear seam
for sidebags/pelvisbags. Otherwise, the sidebag/pelvisbag cannot deploy correctly and
would fail to provide the intended protection
in the event of an accident. Appropriate seat
covers can be obtained, for example, from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
When deployed, the sidebags offer additional
protection for the thorax of the vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle on which the
impact occurs. However, they do not protect
the:
Rhead
Rneck
The seat covers must have a special tear seam
for sidebags/pelvisbags. Otherwise, the sidebag/pelvisbag cannot deploy correctly and
would fail to provide the intended protection
in the event of an accident. Appropriate seat
covers can be obtained, for example, from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Pelvisbag deployment enhances the level of
protection of the vehicle occupants on the
side of the vehicle on which the impact
occurs.
Rarms
Front sidebags : and rear sidebags ;
deploy next to the outer seat cushions.
The sidebags are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently of seat belt use
Rindependently of the front airbags
Rindependently of the belt tensioners
Rat
Pelvisbags
i Pelvisbags are only available in certain
countries.
G WARNING
If you wish to use seat covers, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that, for safety reasons, you
only use seat covers that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
Pelvisbags : deploy next to and below the
outer seat cushions. They are deployed:
Ron the side on which an impact occurs
Rat the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently of seat belt use
Rindependently of the front airbags
Rindependently of the belt tensioners
Windowbags
The windowbags enhance the level of protection for the head, but not chest or arms, of the
vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle
on which the impact occurs.
The windowbags are integrated into the side
of the roof frame and deploy in the area
extending from the front door (A-pillar) to the
rear sidewall (C-pillar).
Z
49
Safety
Occupant safety
50
Occupant safety
PRE-SAFE® takes the following measures
depending on the hazardous situation detected:
Rthe
front seat belts are pre-tensioned.
with the memory function: it
adjusts the front-passenger seat if it is in
an unfavourable position.
Rif the vehicle skids, the panorama sliding
sunroof and the side windows are closed so
that only a small gap remains.
If the hazardous situation passes without
resulting in an accident, PRE-SAFE® slackens
the belt pretensioning. All settings made by
PRE-SAFE® can then be reversed.
If the seat belts are not released:
Safety
Rvehicles
Windowbags : are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rregardless of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
Rindependently of seat belt use
Rindependently of the front airbags
Rat
PRE-SAFE®
protection)
(preventative occupant
PRE-SAFE® takes pre-emptive measures to
protect occupants in certain hazardous situations.
PRE-SAFE® intervenes:
Rin emergency braking situations, e.g. if BAS
is activated or for vehicles with DISTRONIC
PLUS, BAS PLUS intervenes powerfully
Rif the radar sensor system detects an imminent danger of collision in certain situations (on vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS)
Rin critical driving situations, e.g. when physical limits are exceed and the vehicle understeers or oversteers severely
X
Move the backrest or seat back slightly, but
only when the vehicle is stationary.
The belt pretensioning is reduced and the
locking mechanism is released.
G WARNING
When adjusting the seat, make sure that
nobody can become trapped.
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or behind the seats when moving
the seat back. There is a risk that the seats
and/or the objects could be damaged.
More information about seat-belt adjustment, a convenience function integrated into
PRE-SAFE®, can be found in the "Seat-belt
adjustment" section (Y page 53).
NECK-PRO head restraints
The NECK-PRO head restraints increase protection to the driver's and front passenger's
head and neck. To this end, the NECK-PRO
head restraints on the driver's and frontpassenger seats are moved forwards and
upwards in the event of a rear-end collision of
a certain severity. This provides better head
support.
Occupant safety
51
Only use head restraint covers which have
been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz
for your vehicle model.
The use of non-approved head restraint covers may prevent NECK-PRO head restraints
from triggering properly. Consequently, the
NECK-PRO head restraints cannot provide the
intended level of protection.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
regarding availability.
If the NECK-PRO head restraints have been
triggered in an accident, reset the NECK-PRO
head restraints on the driver’s and frontpassenger seat (Y page 51). Otherwise, the
additional protection will not be available in
the event of another rear-end collision. You
can recognise when NECK-PRO head
restraints have been triggered by the fact that
they have moved forwards and can no longer
be adjusted.
Resetting triggered NECK-PRO head
restraints
Following a rear-end collision, MercedesBenz recommends that you have NECK-PRO
head restraints checked at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
i Resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints
requires a lot of strength. If you have difficulty resetting the NECK-PRO head
restraints, have this work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Safety
G WARNING
Tilt the top of the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion forwards in the direction of
arrow :.
X Push the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion
down in the direction of arrow ; as far as
it will go.
X Firmly push the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion back in the direction of arrow =
until the cushion engages.
X Repeat this procedure for the second
NECK-PRO head restraint.
X
Seat belts
Important safety notes
Seat belts are the most effective means of
restraining the movement of vehicle occupants in the event of an accident. This
reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming
into contact with parts of the vehicle interior.
G WARNING
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or
which has not been engaged in the seat belt
buckle correctly, cannot perform its intended
protective function. Under certain circumstances, this could cause severe or even fatal
injuries in the event of an accident.
Make sure that all occupants – in particular,
pregnant women – wear their seat belt correctly at all times.
RThe
seat belt must fit snugly on your body
and must not be twisted. Therefore, avoid
wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter coat.
Z
Safety
52
Occupant safety
The shoulder belt section must be routed
across the centre of your shoulder – on no
account across your neck or under your
arm – and pulled tight against your upper
body. The lap belt must always pass across
your lap as low down as possible, i.e. over
your hip joints – not across your abdomen.
If necessary, push down the belt strap
slightly and then retighten it in the roll-up
direction.
RDo not route the belt strap across sharp
edges or fragile objects, especially if these
are located on or in your clothing, e.g. spectacles, pens, keys, etc. The seat belt strap
could be damaged and tear in an accident,
and you or other vehicle occupants could
be injured.
ROnly one person should use each seat belt
at any one time. Children must never travel
sitting on the lap of other occupants. It
would not be possible to restrain the child
in the event of a sudden change in direction, braking or an accident. This could
result in severe or even fatal injuries to the
child and other occupants.
RPersons less than 1.50 m tall cannot wear
the seat belts correctly. For this reason,
secure persons less than 1.50 m tall in specially designed, suitable restraint systems.
RChildren less than 1.50 m tall or under 12
years of age cannot wear the seat belts
properly. Therefore, they should always be
secured in a suitable child restraint system
on a suitable vehicle seat. You can find
more information under "Children in the
vehicle" in the "Safety" section of the Owner's Manual. Follow the manufacturer's
installation instructions when fitting a child
restraint system.
RDo not secure any objects with a seat belt
if the seat belt is also being used by one of
the vehicle's occupants.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection unless the backrest is almost
vertical. Under certain circumstances, this
could cause severe or even fatal injuries in the
event of an accident.
Before starting a journey, make sure that the
seat is properly adjusted and that the backrest is almost vertical.
G WARNING
A dirty or damaged seat belt or a seat belt that
has been subjected to a load in an accident
or which has been modified no longer offers
the intended level of protection. Under certain
circumstances, this could cause severe or
even fatal injuries in the event of an accident.
For this reason, check regularly that the seat
belts are not damaged or dirty.
Always have damaged seat belts or seat belts
that have been subjected to a load in an accident replaced at a qualified specialist workshop. Consult a qualified specialist workshop
which has the necessary specialist knowledge
and tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use seat belts which have
been approved by Mercedes-Benz for your
vehicle.
Occupant safety
Seat belt adjustment
The seat-belt adjustment function adjusts the
driver's and front-passenger seat belt to the
upper body of the occupants.
The belt strap is tightened slightly when:
Ryou
Adjust the seat and move the backrest to
an almost vertical position (Y page 96).
X Pull the seat belt smoothly through belt
sash guide :.
X Without twisting it, guide the shoulder section of the seat belt across the middle of
your shoulder and the lap section across
your hips.
X Engage belt tongue ; in buckle =.
Seat-belt adjustment: if necessary, the
driver's and front-passenger seat belts
automatically adjust to the upper body
(Y page 53).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
X
The rear seat belts are equipped with a child
seat lock (Y page 56). If you pull out the seat
belt fully and then allow the inertia reel to
retract it, the child-seat lock is activated. To
deactivate the child seat lock, unfasten the
seat belt and guide the belt tongue to the belt
sash guide.
For more information about releasing the seat
belt with release button ?, see "Releasing
seat belts" (Y page 53).
engage the belt tongue in the belt
buckle and you then turn the key to position
2 in the ignition lock.
Rthe key is in position 2 in the ignition lock
and you then engage the belt tongue in the
buckle.
The seat-belt adjustment will apply a certain
tightening force if any slack is detected
between the occupant and the seat belt. Do
not hold on to the seat belt tightly while it is
adjusting. On vehicles with a luxury multifunction steering wheel (12 buttons), you can
switch the seat-belt adjustment on and off
using the on-board computer (Y page 228).
The seat-belt adjustment is an integral part of
the PRE-SAFE® convenience function. More
information about PRE-SAFE® can be found
in the "PRE-SAFE® (preventative occupant
protection)" section (Y page 50).
Releasing seat belts
X
Press release button ? (Y page 53) and
guide belt tongue ; back towards belt
sash guide :.
i If you have guided the seat belt back, it is
turned 180 °. This is necessary in order to
guarantee that the seat belt is not twisted
and that it is routed correctly when the belt
is fastened.
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled
up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue
will be trapped in the door or in the seat
mechanism. This could damage the door,
the door trim panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfil their
protective function and must be replaced.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Z
Safety
Fastening seat belts
53
Safety
54
Occupant safety
Belt warning for driver and front
passenger
You can also cancel the rear seat belt status
indicator immediately (Y page 232).
The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster is a reminder for all occupants
to fasten their seat belts. It may light up continuously or flash. In addition, there may be a
warning tone.
The 7 seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the warning tone ceases when the driver and
the front passenger have fastened their seat
belt.
For certain countries only: regardless of
whether the driver or the front passenger
have fastened their seat belts, the 7 seat
belt warning lamp lights up for six seconds
after the engine is started. It then goes out if
the driver and the front passenger have fastened their seat belts.
i The status indicator for the rear-compart-
i For more information on the 7 seat
belt warning lamp, see "Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster, seat
belt" (Y page 273).
Rear seat belt status indicator
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator tells you if the rear passengers have
their seat belts fastened.
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator indicates the rear seat on which the belt
is fastened. The ü symbol in the display
indicates a fastened seat belt. If a seat belt is
not fastened or if a seat is not occupied, the
ý symbol is displayed.
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator appears in the multifunction display for
around 30 seconds if:
Ryou
drive off and reach a speed of approximately 10 km/h.
Rthe rear passengers fasten or unfasten
their seat belts while the vehicle is in
motion.
Rsomeone gets in or out of the vehicle and
the vehicle drives off again.
ment seat belts is only available for certain
countries.
Belt tensioners, belt force limiters
The seat belts are fitted with belt tensioners.
The belt tensioners tighten the seat belts in
an accident, pulling them close against the
body.
Belt tensioners do not correct incorrect seat
positions or incorrectly fastened seat belts.
Belt tensioners do not pull vehicle occupants
back towards the backrest.
If the seat belt is also fitted with a belt force
limiter and this is triggered, the force exerted
by the seat belt on the vehicle occupant is
reduced.
The belt force limiters on the front seats are
synchronised with the front airbags. They
take on a part of the deceleration force,
resulting in the force exerted on the occupant
being distributed over a greater area.
The belt tensioners can only be activated
when:
Rthe
ignition is switched on.
restraint systems are operational; see
"SRS warning lamp" (Y page 45).
Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on
each of the three-point seat belts in the
front.
The belt tensioners on the seats in the rear
compartment are triggered independently of
the lock status of the seat belts.
The belt tensioners are triggered depending
on the type and severity of an accident:
Rthe
Rif, in the event of a head-on or rear-end col-
lision, the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a longitudinal direction during the initial stages of the impact
Rif, in the event of a side impact, on the side
opposite the impact the vehicle deceler-
ates or accelerates rapidly in a lateral direction
When the belt tensioners are triggered, you
will hear a bang and a small amount of powder
may also be released. Only in rare cases will
the bang affect your hearing. The powder that
is released generally does not constitute a
health hazard. The 6 SRS warning lamp
lights up.
G WARNING
If the seat belt tensioners have been triggered, they provide no additional protection
in the event of another accident. Therefore,
have belt tensioners which have been triggered replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Comply with safety regulations when disposing of belt tensioners. Any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre can provide details of these
regulations.
! If the front-passenger seat is not occu-
pied, do not engage the seat belt tongue in
the buckle on the front-passenger seat.
Otherwise, the belt tensioner could be triggered in the event of an accident.
Children in the vehicle
Child restraint systems
Important safety notes
G WARNING
To reduce the risk of serious or even fatal
injury to the child in the event of a sudden
change in direction, braking or an accident:
Rchildren
less than 1.50 m tall and under
twelve years of age must always be secured
in special child restraint systems on a suitable vehicle seat. This is necessary
because the seat belts are not designed for
children.
Rdo not secure children less than 1.50 m tall
or under twelve years of age on the frontpassenger seat. Exception: the vehicle is
equipped with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat and the
child is secured in a child restraint system
with transponders for automatic child seat
recognition.
Rif you secure a forward-facing child
restraint system to the front-passenger
seat, you must move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible.
Rchildren must never travel sitting on the lap
of another occupant. Due to the forces
which occur in the event of a sudden
change of direction, heavy braking or an
accident, it would not be possible to
restrain the child. The child could be thrown
against parts of the vehicle interior and be
seriously or even fatally injured.
G WARNING
The child restraint system cannot perform its
protective function if it is not correctly fitted
to a suitable vehicle seat. The child cannot be
restrained in the event of an accident, heavy
braking or sudden changes of direction. The
child could be seriously or even fatally injured.
For this reason, when fitting a child restraint
system, observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the correct use of the
child restraint system.
Child restraint systems should be fitted to the
rear seats. Children are generally better protected there.
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the seat cushion. Therefore, never place objects, e.g. a cushion,
under the child restraint system.
Only use child restraint systems with the original cover designed for them. Only replace
damaged covers with genuine Mercedes-Benz
covers.
We recommend the use of child restraint systems which have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, secure
the child using a child restraint system which
Z
55
Safety
Children in the vehicle
Safety
56
Children in the vehicle
is appropriate to the size, age and weight of
the child and recommended for MercedesBenz vehicles. You should preferably fit the
restraint system to a suitable rear seat. Make
sure that the child is secured in a child
restraint system throughout the trip.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use the child restraint systems listed at
(Y page 63).
You can obtain further information about the
correct child restraint system from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
products to clean child restraint systems.
You can obtain information about this at
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
G WARNING
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. They could injure themselves on parts of the vehicle. They could also
be seriously or even fatally injured by prolonged exposure to extreme heat or cold.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. Parts of the child restraint system could heat up and the child could burn
herself/himself on them.
If a child opens a door, the child or other persons could be injured as a result. They could
get out and injure themselves or be injured by
a passing vehicle.
Also observe the notes on HOLD. Relevant
information can be found in the index.
G WARNING
Unsecured or incorrectly positioned loads
increase the risk of injury for children and all
other occupants in the event of:
Ran
accident
braking manoeuvre
Ra sudden change of direction
Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the vehicle interior unless they are secured. You will
Ra
find further information under "Loading guidelines" in the index.
Child seat lock
The seat belts on the rear seats are fitted with
a child seat lock. When enabled, the childseat lock function ensures that the belt does
not slacken once the child seat is secured.
Installing a child restraint system:
Always comply with the manufacturer's
installation instructions.
X Pull the seat belt smoothly from the inertia
reel.
X Engage the seat belt tongue in the belt
buckle.
X
Activating the child seat lock:
Pull the seat belt out fully and let the inertia
reel retract it again.
While the seat belt is retracting, you should
hear a ratcheting sound. The child-seat lock
function is enabled.
X Push down on the child restraint system to
take up any slack.
X
Removing a child restraint system/deactivating the child seat lock:
Always comply with the manufacturer's
installation instructions.
X Press the seat belt release button and
guide the belt tongue to the belt outlet.
The child-seat lock function is deactivated.
X
Children in the vehicle
Child seat on the front-passenger seat
57
The front-passenger airbag is not disabled:
Warning notice on the front-passenger sun visor
Warning symbol for a rearward-facing child
restraint system
vehicles without automatic child seat
recognition on the front-passenger seat
Rin vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat, if no
special child restraint system with transponders for automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat has been
fitted
Ron vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat, if the
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
4 is not lit.
To make you aware of this danger, a corresponding warning sticker has been affixed on
the dashboard and on both sides of the sun
visor on the front-passenger side.
Information about recommended child
restraint systems is available at any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Automatic child seat recognition on the
front-passenger seat
G WARNING
If the front-passenger airbag is not disabled:
Ra
child secured in a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat could be seriously and even fatally injured by the frontpassenger airbag deploying. This is especially a risk if the child is in the immediate
vicinity of the front-passenger airbag when
it deploys.
Rnever secure a child on the front-passenger
seat in a rearward-facing child restraint system. Only secure a rearward-facing child
restraint system on a suitable rear seat.
Ralways move the front-passenger seat to
the rearmost position if you secure a child
in a forward-facing child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat.
1
If your vehicle does not have automatic child
seat recognition1 on the front-passenger
seat, this is indicated by a special sticker. The
sticker is affixed to the side of the dashboard
on the front-passenger side. The sticker is
visible when you open the front-passenger
door.
Vehicles without automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat: if you turn the key to position
2 in the ignition lock, the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp lights up briefly but has no function.
It does not indicate that there is automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat.
Z
Safety
Ron
58
Children in the vehicle
system cannot perform its intended protective function in the event of an accident, and
could lead to injuries.
i If the front-passenger airbag is disabled
Safety
by the automatic child seat recognition, the
following remain enabled on the frontpassenger side:
Rthe
sidebag
pelvisbag
Rthe windowbag
Rthe belt tensioner
Rthe
The front-passenger seat sensor system for
child restraint systems detects whether a
special Mercedes-Benz child seat with a
transponder for automatic child seat recognition has been fitted. In such cases,
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp
4: lights up. The front-passenger airbag
is disabled.
G WARNING
If the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light up when the child
restraint system is fitted, the front-passenger
airbag has not been disabled. If the frontpassenger airbag deploys, the child could be
seriously or even fatally injured.
Proceed as follows:
Rdo not use a rearward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
a rearward-facing child restraint system
on a suitable rear seat.
Rfit
or
Ronly
use a forward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat and
move the front-passenger seat to the rearmost position.
Rhave the automatic child seat recognition
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
To ensure that the automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat functions/communicates correctly, never place
objects, e.g. a cushion, under the child
restraint system. The entire base of the child
restraint system must always rest on the seat
cushion. An incorrectly fitted child restraint
G WARNING
Do not place electronic devices on the frontpassenger seat, e.g.:
Rlaptops,
when switched on
phones
Rcards with transponders, e.g. ski passes or
access cards
Signals from electronic equipment can cause
interference in the automatic child seat recognition sensor system. This can lead to a
system malfunction. This may cause the
4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp to light up without there being a child
seat with transponders for automatic child
seat recognition fitted. The front-passenger
airbag will not then deploy during an accident.
It is also possible that the 6 SRS warning
lamp lights up and/or the 4 PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light up
briefly when you turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 2.
Rmobile
ISOFIX child seat securing system for
the rear seats
ISOFIX is a standardised securing system for
specially designed child restraint systems on
the rear seats. Securing rings for two ISOFIX
child restraint systems are fitted on the left
and right of the rear seats.
Children in the vehicle
A child restraint system secured by the ISOFIX
child seat securing system does not provide
sufficient protection for children weighing
more than 22 kg. For this reason, do not
secure children weighing more than 22 kg in
a child restraint system secured by the ISOFIX
child seat securing system. If the child weighs
more than 22 kg, secure the child restraint
system using a three-point seat belt.
aged or subjected to a load in an accident
checked immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The securing rings on the rear seats are covered by an upholstered lining.
G WARNING
The child restraint system cannot perform its
protective function if it is not correctly fitted
to a suitable vehicle seat. The child cannot be
restrained in the event of an accident, heavy
braking or sudden changes of direction. The
child could be seriously or even fatally injured.
For this reason, when fitting a child restraint
system, observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the correct use of the
child restraint system.
For reasons of safety, only use child restraint
systems with the ISOFIX child seat securing
system on the rear seats.
We recommend that you use the ISOFIX child
restraint systems that have been recommended for Mercedes-Benz.
An incorrectly fitted child restraint system
could come loose and seriously or even fatally
injure the child or other vehicle occupants.
When fitting the child restraint system, always
make sure that it is engaged correctly in the
securing rings on both sides.
Fold upholstery cover ; and the Velcro
fastener down.
X Install the ISOFIX child restraint systems on
both securing rings :. Comply with the
manufacturer's instructions when installing the ISOFIX child restraint system.
X
Top Tether
Top Tether provides an additional connection
between the child restraint system secured
with ISOFIX and the rear seat. It helps reduce
the risk of injury even further.
The Top Tether anchorage points are located
in the rear compartment behind the head
restraints.
G WARNING
Please note that if child restraint systems, or
their retaining systems, are damaged or subjected to a load in an accident, they may not
be able to provide their protective function.
This could result in serious or even fatal injuries to the secured child in the event of an
accident, heavy braking or a sudden change
in direction.
For this reason, have child restraint systems
and their anchorages which have been damZ
Safety
G WARNING
59
Children in the vehicle
Safety
60
Press down the rear of cover ; in the
direction of the arrow.
Cover ; is raised slightly at the front.
X Fold up cover ; of Top Tether anchorage
=.
X
Route Top Tether belts A on the left and
right past head restraint :.
X Hook Top Tether hook ? into Top Tether
anchorage =.
X Make sure that Top Tether belt A is not
twisted.
X Fit the ISOFIX child restraint system with
Top Tether. Comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
Make sure that Top Tether belt A is tight.
X
Children in the vehicle
61
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The 4 PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp on the centre console is lit.
A special Mercedes-Benz child seat with a transponder for automatic child seat recognition has been fitted to the front-passenger
seat. The front-passenger airbag has therefore been disabled as
desired.
G Risk of injury
There is no child seat fitted to the front-passenger seat. Automatic
child seat recognition is malfunctioning.
It is also possible that the 6 SRS warning lamp lights up and/
or the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light
up briefly when you switch the ignition on.
X Remove electronic equipment from the front-passenger seat,
e.g.
Rlaptop
Rmobile phone
Rcards with transponders, such as ski passes or access cards
If the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp is still lit:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Suitable positioning of the child restraint systems
Key to the letters used in the table:
X
U
Seat which is unsuitable for children in this weight category.
Suitable for child restraint systems in the Universal category that are approved for use in
this weight category.
UF Suitable for forward-facing child restraint systems that belong to the "Universal" category
and are approved for use in this weight category.
L Suitable for child restraint systems as recommended, see the following table of "Recommended child restraint systems" (Y page 63).
Z
Safety
Problems with child seat recognition
Children in the vehicle
62
Safety
Seat positions
Weight catego- Front-passenger seat
ries
FrontThe frontpassenger air- passenger airbag is not disa- bag is disabled:
bled2
Rear seat
Group 0: up to
10 kg
X
U3, L3
U, L
Group 0+: up
to 13 kg
X
U3, L3
U, L
Group I: 9 to
18 kg
U3, L3
U3, L3
U, L
Group II: 15 to
25 kg
U3, L3
U3, L3
U, L
Group III: 22 to
36 kg
U3, L3
U3, L3
U, L
Left, right
"Universal" category child restraint systems can be recognised by their orange approval label.
Approval label on the child restraint system (example)
Key to the letters used in the table:
X
ISOFIX position that is not suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems in this weight category and/or size category.
IUF Suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX child seat securing systems that belong to the "universal" category which are approved for use in this weight category.
IL Suitable for ISOFIX child restraint systems as recommended; see the following table of
"Recommended child restraint systems" (Y page 63).
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat: a child restraint system of the
"Universal" category with a transponder for automatic child seat recognition must be fitted. The 4
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
3 Adjust the front-passenger seat to the rearmost position and the seat backrest to a position as close to
vertical as possible.
2
Children in the vehicle
63
Suitability of the rear seats for attaching ISOFIX child restraint systems
Size category
Equipment
Rear seat, left and
right
Carry-cot
F
ISO/L1
X
G
ISO/L2
X
0: up to 10 kg
up to approximately 6
months
E
ISO/R1
IL
0+: up to 13 kg
up to approximately
15 months
E
ISO/R1
IL
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL4
I: 9 to 18 kg
between approximately 9 months and
4 years
D
ISO/R2
IL
C
ISO/R3
IL4
B
ISO/F2
IUF
B1
ISO/F2X
IUF
A
ISO/F3
IUF
Safety
Weight categories
Recommended child restraint systems
If you fit a child restraint system without a transponder for automatic child seat recognition
to the front-passenger seat, position the front-passenger seat in its rearmost position.
4
Weight catego- Manufacries
turer
Type
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
Order num- Automatic
ber
child seat
(A 000 ...)
recognition
Group 0: up to
10 kg
up to approximately 6
months
Britax
Römer
BABY
SAFE
PLUS
03 301146
04 301146
970 10 00
Yes
Group 0+: up
to 13 kg
up to approximately 15
months
Britax
Römer
BABY
SAFE
PLUS
03 301146
04 301146
970 10 00
Yes
Adjust the front-passenger seat to the central upper position and the seat backrest to a position as close to
vertical as possible.
Z
Safety
64
Children in the vehicle
Weight catego- Manufacries
turer
Type
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
Order num- Automatic
ber
child seat
(A 000 ...)
recognition
Group I: 9 to
18 kg
between
approximately
9 months and
4 years
DUO
PLUS
03 301133
04 301133
970 11 00
Yes
970 16 00
No
KIDFIX
04 301198
970 18 00
Yes
970 19 00
No
Britax
Römer
Category II/III: Britax
15 to 36 kg
Römer
between
approximately
4 and 12 years
Suggested ISOFIX child restraint systems from the Universal category.
Weight
categories
Size category
Manufacturer
Type
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
Order
number
Automatic
child seat
recognition
Carry-cot
F
–
–
–
–
–
G
–
–
–
–
–
E
–
–
–
–
–
Britax
Römer
BABY SAFE 04 301146 B6 6 86
ISOFIX
8224
PLUS
No
D
–
–
–
–
–
C
–
–
–
–
–
Group I:
D
9 to 18 kg C
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
B
–
–
–
–
–
Group 0:
up to
10 kg
Group 0+: E
up to
13 kg
Weight
categories
Size category
Manufacturer
Type
B1
Britax
Römer
DUO PLUS 03 301133 A 000 970
04 301133 11 00
Yes
A
–
–
–
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems overview
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
RBAS (Brake Assist System)
RBAS PLUS (Brake Assist System Plus*)
RAdaptive brake lamps
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
REBD (electronic brake force distribution)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE
RPRE-SAFE® Brake
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style, the driving safety systems can neither reduce the risk
of accident nor override the laws of physics.
Driving safety systems are merely aids
designed to assist driving. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for
vehicle speed and for braking in good time.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
prevailing road and weather conditions, as
well as the traffic conditions and maintain a
safe distance from the vehicle in front. Drive
carefully.
i Please note that the driving safety sys-
tems described only work as effectively as
possible when there is adequate contact
between the tyres and the road surface.
Pay particular attention to the information
Approval
number
(E1 ...)
–
Order
number
–
Automatic
child seat
recognition
regarding tyres, recommended minimum
tyre tread depths etc. in the "Wheels and
tyres" section (Y page 336).
In wintry driving conditions, always use
winter tyres (M+S tyres) and if necessary,
snow chains. Only in this way will the driving safety systems described in this section
work as effectively as possible.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 65).
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking.
ABS works from a speed of about 8 km/h
upwards, regardless of road-surface conditions. ABS works on slippery surfaces, even
when you only brake gently.
G WARNING
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. This limits the steerability of the vehicle when braking and the braking distance
may increase.
If ABS is deactivated due to a malfunction,
then BAS and ESP are also deactivated. There
is an increased risk of your vehicle skidding in
certain situations.
Z
65
Safety
Driving safety systems
66
Driving safety systems
Safety
You should always adapt your driving style to
suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
Braking
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel
a pulsing in the brake pedal.
X If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions and functions as a reminder to take extra care while
driving.
G WARNING
Do not depress the brake pedal several times
in quick succession (pumping). Pumping the
brake pedal reduces the braking effect. You
might otherwise not be able to stop the vehicle in time and could cause an accident.
Depress the brake pedal firmly and smoothly.
BAS (Brake Assist)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 65).
BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly,
BAS automatically boosts the braking force,
thus shortening the stopping distance.
X Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
G WARNING
If BAS has malfunctioned, the braking system
remains available with full brake boosting
effect. However, braking force is not automatically increased in emergency braking sit-
uations and the stopping distance may
increase.
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
PLUS)
BAS PLUS is only available on vehicles with
DISTRONIC PLUS.
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 65).
BAS PLUS provides braking assistance in hazardous situations at speeds of over
30 km/h and uses radar sensor technology
to assess the traffic situation.
With the help of the radar sensor system, BAS
PLUS can detect obstacles that are in the
path of your vehicle for an extended period of
time.
At speeds up to approximately 70 km/h, BAS
PLUS may also detect stationary obstacles,
for example, stopped or parked vehicles.
Should you approach an obstacle and BAS
PLUS has detected a risk of collision, BAS
PLUS calculates the braking force necessary
to avoid a rear-end collision. Should you apply
the brakes forcefully, BAS PLUS can automatically increase the braking force to a level
suitable for the traffic conditions.
If BAS PLUS demands particularly high braking force, preventative passenger protection
measures (PRE-SAFE®) are activated simultaneously.
X Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will work normally again if:
Ryou
release the brake pedal.
is no longer any danger of a rear-end
collision.
Rno obstacle is detected in front of your
vehicle.
BAS PLUS is then deactivated.
Rthere
Vehicles with COMAND and navigation system: the radar sensor system is switched off
automatically in the vicinity of radio telescope
facilities (Y page 363).
Vehicles without COMAND and a navigation
system and vehicles for Australia: the radar
sensor system and on-board computer must
be switched off in the vicinity of radio telescope facilities (Y page 226).
For BAS PLUS to assist you when driving, the
radar sensor system must be switched on and
operational; see "Radar sensor system" in the
index.
G WARNING
BAS PLUS cannot always clearly identify
objects and complex traffic situations. BAS
PLUS cannot intervene in these cases.
There is a risk of an accident. Always pay
careful attention to the traffic situation and be
ready to brake.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired if there is:
Rdirt
on the sensors or anything else covering the sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rthe possibility of strong radar reflections,
for example in multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorbike
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
G WARNING
BAS PLUS does not react:
Rto
people or animals
Rto oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
As a result, BAS PLUS may not intervene in
critical situations. There is a risk of an accident. Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensors checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
If BAS PLUS is not available due to a malfunction in the radar sensor system, the brake
system remains available with full brake
boosting effect and BAS.
Adaptive brake lamps
i Adaptive brake lamps are only available in
certain countries.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS
or BAS PLUS, the brake lamps flash rapidly.
In this way, traffic travelling behind you is
warned in an even more noticeable manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning lamps are activated automatically. If the
brakes are applied again, the brake lamps
light up continuously. The hazard warning
lamps switch off automatically if you travel
faster than 10 km/h. You can also switch off
the hazard warning lamps using the hazard
warning switch button (Y page 111).
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Important safety notes
i See the "Important safety notes" section
(Y page 65).
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating
from the direction desired by the driver, one
or more wheels are braked to stabilise the
vehicle. If necessary, the engine output is also
modified to keep the vehicle on the desired
course within physical limits. ESP® assists
the driver when pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP® can also stabilise the vehicle during braking.
Z
67
Safety
Driving safety systems
68
Driving safety systems
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ ESP® warning
lamp flashes in the instrument cluster.
Safety
G WARNING
If the ÷ warning lamp in the instrument
cluster flashes, proceed as follows:
not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
Ronly depress the accelerator pedal as far as
necessary when pulling away.
Radapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
Otherwise, the vehicle could go into a skid.
Rdo
ESP® cannot reduce the risk of an accident if
you drive too fast. ESP® cannot override the
laws of physics.
! Switch the ignition off when:
Deactivating/activating ESP® (except
AMG vehicles)
You cannot activate and deactivate ESP® on
vehicles with a 4-button multifunction steering wheel.
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is started.
i Vehicles with ECO start/stop function:
the ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically when the vehicle
comes to a stop. The engine starts automatically when the driver wants to pull
away again. ESP® remains in its previously
selected status. Example: if ESP® was
deactivated before the engine was
switched off, ESP® remains deactivated
when the engine is switched on again.
Rthe parking brake is being tested using a
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rthe vehicle is being towed with the front/
Rwhen
dynamometer
rear axle raised
Application of the brakes by ESP® may otherwise destroy the brake system.
i Only use wheels with the recommended
tyre sizes. Only then will ESP® function
properly.
ETS (Electronic Traction Support)
Traction control is part of ESP®.
Traction control brakes the drive wheels individually if they spin. This enables you to pull
away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, for
example if the road surface is slippery on one
side.
Traction control remains active if you deactivate ESP®.
G WARNING
Traction control cannot reduce the risk of an
accident if you drive too fast. Traction control
cannot override the laws of physics.
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Rin
G WARNING
Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts
to spin.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
Rthe engine's torque is no longer limited and
the drive wheels can spin. The spinning of
the wheels results in a cutting action, which
provides better grip.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster flashes. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
Driving safety systems
To deactivate:(Y page 221).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
G WARNING
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running.
If the ÷ warning lamp and å warning
lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not available due to a malfunction.
There is an increased risk of your vehicle skidding in certain situations.
You should always adapt your driving style to
suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
When SPORT handling mode is activated:
RESP®
only improves driving stability to a
limited degree.
Rthe engine's torque is restricted to a limited
degree and the drive wheels can spin. The
spinning of the wheels results in a cutting
action, which provides better grip.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly.
If SPORT handling mode is activated and one
or more wheels start to spin, the ÷ ESP®
warning lamp in the instrument cluster
flashes. ESP® only stabilises the vehicle to a
limited degree.
To activate:(Y page 221).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (AMG
vehicles)
Activating/deactivating SPORT handling
mode
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is started.
It may be best to activate SPORT handling
mode in the following situations:
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Otherwise, you should only use SPORT handling mode on designated race circuits.
X
To activate: briefly press button :.
The M SPORT handling mode warning
lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
The SPORT handling mode message
appears in the multifunction display.
X
To deactivate: briefly press button :.
The M SPORT handling mode warning
lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
Rwhen
Rin
G WARNING
Deactivate SPORT handling mode and activate ESP® as soon as the situations described
above no longer apply. Otherwise, SPORT
handling mode will only be able to stabilise
the vehicle to a limited degree if the vehicle
starts to skid or a wheel starts to spin.
Activating/deactivating ESP®
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is started.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Rin
Z
Safety
X
69
Driving safety systems
Safety
70
G WARNING
G WARNING
Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts
to spin.
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running.
If the ÷ warning lamp and å warning
lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not available due to a malfunction.
There is an increased risk of your vehicle skidding in certain situations.
You should always adapt your driving style to
suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
Rthe engine's torque is no longer limited and
the drive wheels are able to spin. The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting
action, which provides better grip.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available and is
also not activated if you brake firmly with
the assistance of ESP®.
RPRE-SAFE® Brake is no longer available and
is also not activated if you brake firmly with
the assistance of ESP®.
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster does not flash. In such
situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
X
To activate: briefly press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out. The ÷ON
message appears in the multifunction display.
ESP® trailer stabilisation
ESP® trailer stabilisation is not available in
AMG vehicles.
If your vehicle with trailer (vehicle/trailer
combination) begins to lurch, you can only
stabilise the vehicle/trailer combination by
depressing the brake firmly.
In this situation, ESP® assists you and can
detect if the vehicle/trailer combination
begins to lurch. ESP® slows the vehicle down
by braking and limiting the engine output until
the vehicle/trailer combination has stabilised.
Trailer stabilisation is active above speeds of
about 65 km/h.
G WARNING
X
To deactivate: press button : until the
å ESP® OFF warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster.
The ÷OFF message appears in the multifunction display.
If road and weather conditions are poor,
trailer stabilisation will not be able to prevent
the trailer from swerving and will thus be
unable to reduce the risk of an accident. Trailers with a high centre of gravity can tip over
before ESP® can detect this.
Trailer stabilisation does not work if ESP® is
deactivated or disabled because of a malfunction.
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 65).
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving
stability while braking.
G WARNING
If EBD has malfunctioned, the braking system
remains available with full brake boosting
effect. However, the rear wheels can still lock,
e.g. under full braking. This could cause you
to lose control of your vehicle and cause an
accident. You should therefore adapt your
driving style to the different handling characteristics.
X
Observe the notes on warning and indicator
lamps (Y page 275) as well as display messages (Y page 235) (4-button multifunction steering wheel) and (Y page 240) (12button multifunction steering wheel).
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety
and offers increased braking comfort. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE
also has the HOLD function (Y page 177) and
hill start assist (Y page 140). For further
information, see Driving tips (Y page 159).
PRE-SAFE® Brake
PRE-SAFE® Brake is only available in vehicles
with DISTRONIC PLUS.
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 65).
PRE-SAFE® Brake can help you to minimise
the risk of a frontal collision with a vehicle
ahead or reduce the effects of such a collision. If PRE-SAFE® Brake has detected a risk
of collision, you will be warned visually and
acoustically as well as by automatic braking.
PRE-SAFE® Brake cannot prevent a collision
without your intervention.
This function will issue a warning at speeds of
around 30 km/h or more if:
Rfor
a period of several seconds, the distance to the vehicle in front is too short for
the speed at which you are travelling. The
· distance warning lamp then lights up
in the instrument cluster.
Ryou are rapidly approaching the vehicle in
front. An intermittent warning tone will
then sound and the · distance warning
lamp will light up in the instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately in order to increase the
distance from the vehicle in front.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
If the driver and passengers have fastened
their seat belts, PRE-SAFE® Brake can also
can also perform the following at speeds of
above approximately 30 km/h:
Rbrake
the vehicle automatically from a
speed of up to approximately 200 km/h
Rtrigger preventative passenger protection
measures (PRE-SAFE®) (Y page 50)
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated driving conditions may cause
unnecessary warnings or the unnecessary
intervention of PRE-SAFE® Brake. To end this,
you can either depress the accelerator pedal
further, activate kickdown or release the
brake pedal.
The braking action of PRE-SAFE® Brake is
ended automatically if:
Ryou
drive slower than approximately
15 km/h.
Ryou manoeuvre to avoid the obstacle.
Z
71
Safety
Driving safety systems
72
Driving safety systems
Safety
Rthere
is no longer any danger of a rear-end
collision.
Rthere is no longer an obstacle detected in
front of your vehicle.
With the help of the radar sensor system,
PRE-SAFE® Brake can detect obstacles that
are in front of your vehicle for an extended
period of time.
At speeds up to approximately 70 km/h,
PRE-SAFE® Brake may also detect stationary
obstacles, for example stopped or parked
vehicles.
If you approach an obstacle and PRE-SAFE®
Brake detects a risk of a collision, the system
will initially alert you both visually and acoustically. If you do not brake or take evasive
action, the system will warn you by automatically braking the vehicle gently. If there is an
increased risk of collision, preventative
passenger protection measures (PRE-SAFE®)
are activated (Y page 50). If the risk of collision remains and you do not brake, take evasive action or accelerate significantly, the
vehicle may perform automatic emergency
braking. Automatic emergency braking is not
performed until immediately prior to an accident that can no longer be avoided.
G WARNING
Even if PRE-SAFE® Brake slows the vehicle
before an imminent rear-end collision, the
system cannot avert a collision without the
intervention of the driver. There is a risk of an
accident. Brake according to the situation or
take evasive action. Delayed intervention by
the driver can lead to an accident.
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake cannot always clearly identify objects and complex traffic conditions.
In these cases, PRE-SAFE® Brake may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning and then
brake the vehicle
Rnot give a warning or intervene
There is a risk of an accident. Always pay particular attention to the traffic situation and be
ready to brake, especially if PRE-SAFE® Brake
warns you. Terminate the intervention in a
non-critical driving situation.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired if there is:
Rdirt
on the sensors or anything else covering the sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rthe possibility of strong radar reflections,
for example in multi-storey car parks
Ra narrow vehicle travelling in front, e.g. a
motorbike
Ra vehicle travelling in front on a different
line
G WARNING
PRE-SAFE® Brake does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
Rto
As a result, PRE-SAFE® Brake may not give
warnings or intervene in critical situations.
There is a risk of an accident. Always pay
careful attention to the traffic situation and be
ready to brake.
In order to maintain the appropriate distance
to the vehicle in front and thus prevent a collision, you must apply the brakes yourself.
X To activate/deactivate: activate or deactivate PRE-SAFE® Brake in the on-board
computer (Y page 221).
The Ä symbol appears in the multifunction display as long as the HOLD function
is not activated (Y page 177).
On vehicles with parking guidance, the
Ä symbol is displayed when P is
engaged or you are driving faster than
35 km/h.
Anti-theft systems
Anti-theft systems
The alarm is not switched off, even if you
close the open door that has triggered it, for
example.
Safety
Vehicles with COMAND and navigation system: the radar sensor system is switched off
automatically in the vicinity of radio telescope
facilities (Y page 363).
Vehicles without COMAND and a navigation
system and vehicles for Australia: the radar
sensor system and on-board computer must
be switched off in the vicinity of radio telescope facilities (Y page 226).
For PRE-SAFE® Brake to assist you when driving, the radar sensor system must be
switched on (Y page 226) and be operational.
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensors checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system is primed after approximately 15 seconds.
X To deactivate: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
X
X
Immobiliser
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
X To activate with the key: remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X To activate with KEYLESS-GO: switch the
ignition off and open the driver's door.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
i The immobiliser is always deactivated
when you start the engine.
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed and you open:
Ra
door
vehicle with the emergency key element
Rthe boot lid
Rthe bonnet
Rthe
73
To stop the alarm using the key: insert
the key into the ignition lock.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X
Press the % or & button on the key.
The alarm is switched off.
X
To stop the alarm using KEYLESS-GO:
grasp the outside door handle. The key
must be outside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X
Press the Start/Stop button on the dashboard. The key must be inside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
Tow-away protection
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if your
vehicle's angle of inclination is altered while
tow-away protection is primed. This occurs if
the vehicle is jacked up on one side, for example.
Z
Anti-theft systems
74
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
X To deactivate: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is deactivated automatically.
Safety
X
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate tow-away
protection manually if your vehicle:
Ris
being transported
being loaded onto a ferry or car transporter, for example
Ris parked on a movable surface, e.g. in a
split-level garage
Deactivating:
Ris
X
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
ment is detected in the vehicle interior while
the vehicle is locked. This occurs if someone
reaches into the vehicle interior, for example.
To activate:
Make sure that:
Rthe side windows are closed.
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof is closed.
Rthere are no objects, e.g. mascots, hanging on the rear-view mirror or on the grab
handles on the roof trim.
This will prevent false alarms.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
X
To switch off:
X
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
The interior motion sensor is deactivated
automatically.
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the interior motion sensor if you lock your vehicle
and:
Rpeople
or animals remain in the vehicle.
side windows remain open.
Rthe panorama sliding sunroof remains
open.
Deactivating:
Rthe
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
Tow-away protection is deactivated.
X
X
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; flashes briefly.
Tow-away protection remains deactivated
until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again.
door is opened and closed again.
Rthe vehicle is locked again.
Ra
Interior motion sensor
If the interior motion sensor is primed, a visual and audible alarm is triggered if move-
Anti-theft systems
X
75
Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
The interior motion sensor is deactivated.
Safety
The interior motion sensor remains deactivated until:
Rthe
vehicle is unlocked again.
door is opened and closed again.
Rthe vehicle is locked again.
Ra
i UK only: Your vehicle is equipped with a
double lock function. The doors cannot be
opened from the inside if the vehicle has
been locked with the key (Y page 84).
Deactivate the interior motion sensor
before locking the vehicle with the key. The
doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside with the key. Observe the "Important safety notes" (Y page 83).
Z
76
77
78
78
83
85
88
90
Opening and closing
Useful information ..............................
Key .......................................................
Doors ....................................................
Boot ......................................................
Side windows ......................................
Sliding sunroof ....................................
78
Key
Useful information
Opening and closing
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
Key
Key functions
Locking and unlocking centrally
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
Rthe
doors
boot lid
Rthe fuel filler flap
Rthe
G WARNING
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then not
possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle.
Therefore, do not leave any people behind in
the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance if
the vehicle has been locked with the key. As
a result, they may not be able to free themselves in the event of an emergency. As a
result, they could be seriously or even fatally
injured by prolonged exposure to extremely
high or low temperatures, for example. In this
case, rescuing people from outside the vehicle is difficult.
Deactivate the interior motion sensor before
you lock the vehicle with the key. The doors
can then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside with
the key.
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen a door from inside the vehicle at any
time, even if it has been locked
Rstart the vehicle using a key which has been
left in the vehicle
Rrelease the parking brake
They could thereby endanger themselves and
others. Never leave children unsupervised in
the vehicle. Always take the key with you
when leaving the vehicle, even if you are only
leaving it for a short time.
G WARNING
If a key ring is too heavy or too large, the
weight acting on the key could cause it to turn
in the ignition lock or catch on the steering
wheel. This could cause the engine to be
switched off suddenly. You may lose control
of the vehicle and cause an accident. Do not
attach any heavy or large key rings to the key
that is inserted in the ignition.
: & To lock the vehicle
; F To unlock the boot lid
= % To unlock the vehicle
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
When it is dark, the surround lighting also
comes on if it is activated in the on-board
computer (Y page 225).
Key
X
If you do not open the vehicle within approximately 40 seconds of unlocking:
If you pull on the handle of the boot lid, only
the boot of the vehicle is unlocked.
Rthe
vehicle is locked again.
anti-theft system is primed again.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
KEYLESS-GO
You can start, lock or unlock the vehicle using
KEYLESS-GO. To do this, you only need carry
the key with you. When you touch the surface
of the sensors on the vehicle's outside door
handles, KEYLESS-GO establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key.
When the engine is started and whilst you are
driving, KEYLESS-GO also checks whether a
valid key is in the vehicle by periodically
establishing radio contact.
When locking or unlocking with KEYLESS-GO,
the distance between the key and the door
handle you wish to lock or unlock must not
be greater than 1 m.
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the setting of the locking
system in such a way that only the driver's
door and the fuel filler flap are unlocked. This
is useful if you frequently travel on your own.
X To change the setting: press and hold
down the % and & buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until
the battery check lamp (Y page 81)
flashes twice.
i If the setting of the locking system is
changed within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button locks
or unlocks the vehicle.
The key now functions as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: press the
% button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the % button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
X
The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: touch the
inner surface of the door handle on the
driver's door.
X To unlock centrally: touch the inner surface of the front-passenger door handle.
X To lock centrally: touch the outer sensor
surface on one of the door handles.
X
Z
Opening and closing
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface :.
X Convenience closing feature: touch
recessed sensor surface ; for an extended period (Y page 89).
You can also set an audible signal to confirm
that the vehicle has been locked or unlocked.
The audible signal can be activated and deactivated using the on-board computer
(Y page 226).
X To unlock centrally: press the % button.
Rthe
79
Key
80
Restoring the factory settings
Opening and closing
X
Removing the emergency key element
Press the % and & buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until
the battery check lamp flashes twice.
Emergency key element
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or
unlocked with the key, use the emergency
key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door or the boot
lid, the anti-theft alarm system will be triggered (Y page 73).
There are several ways to turn off the alarm:
X To turn the alarm off with the key: press
the % or & button on the key.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X To deactivate the alarm with KEYLESSGO: press the Start/Stop button in the ignition lock. The key must be in the vehicle.
or
X Lock or unlock the vehicle using KEYLESSGO. The key must be outside the vehicle.
If you unlock the vehicle using the emergency
key element, the fuel filler flap will not be
unlocked automatically.
X To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the
key in the ignition lock.
X
Push release catch : in the direction of
the arrow and at the same time, remove
emergency key element ; from the key.
Key battery
Important safety notes
It is advisable to have batteries replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
G WARNING
Batteries are toxic and contain caustic substances. For this reason, keep batteries out of
the reach of children.
If a battery has been swallowed, visit a doctor
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is against the law to dispose of them with the household rubbish. They must be
collected separately and
recycled in an environmentally responsible manner.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre, or to a special col-
Key
Checking the battery
X
Press the & or % button.
The key battery is working properly if battery check lamp : lights up briefly.
If battery check lamp : does not light up
briefly during the test, the key battery is discharged.
X Changing the battery (Y page 81)
i If the key battery is checked within the
signal reception range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button locks or
unlocks the vehicle.
Changing the battery
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 80).
Press emergency key element ; into the
opening in the key in the direction of the
arrow until battery tray cover : opens.
When doing so, do not hold cover : shut.
X Remove battery tray cover :.
X
Repeatedly tap the key against your palm
until battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth
to do so.
X Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free from lint, grease and all other forms of
contamination.
X Insert the front tabs of battery tray
cover : and then press to close it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
X
Z
Opening and closing
lection point for old batteries.
81
82
Key
Problems with the key
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You cannot lock or
unlock the vehicle
using the key.
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Try again to lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control
function of the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle from close range and press the %/& button.
Opening and closing
Problem
If this does not work:
X Check the key battery and replace it if necessary (Y page 81).
X Lock (Y page 85) or unlock (Y page 85) the vehicle using
the emergency key element.
The key is faulty.
X Lock (Y page 85) or unlock (Y page 85) the vehicle using
the emergency key element.
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can no longer lock There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
or unlock the vehicle
X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
using KEYLESS-GO.
the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle from
close range and press the %/& button.
There is a fault with KEYLESS-GO.
X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle from
close range and press the %/& button.
X Have KEYLESS-GO checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
If this does not work:
X Check the key battery and replace it if necessary (Y page 81).
X Lock (Y page 85) or unlock (Y page 85) the vehicle using
the emergency key element.
You have lost a key.
Have the key cancelled at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
X
X
You have lost the emergency key element.
X
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine cannot be
started using the key.
The on-board voltage is too low.
X Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
If this does not work:
X Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary
(Y page 325).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 329).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine cannot be
started using the key.
The steering lock is mechanically blocked.
X Remove the key and reinsert it into the ignition lock. While doing
this, turn the steering wheel in both directions.
The engine cannot be
A door is open. Therefore, the key cannot be detected as easily.
started using KEYLESS- X Close the door and try to start the vehicle again.
GO. The key is in the
vehicle.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
X Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
Doors
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then not
possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle.
Therefore, do not leave any people behind in
the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance if
the vehicle has been locked with the key. As
a result, they may not be able to free themselves in the event of an emergency. As a
result, they could be seriously or even fatally
injured by prolonged exposure to extremely
high or low temperatures, for example. In this
case, rescuing people from outside the vehicle is difficult.
Deactivate the interior motion sensor before
you lock the vehicle with the key. The doors
can then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside with
the key.
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen a door from inside the vehicle at any
time, even if it has been locked
Rstart the vehicle using a key which has been
left in the vehicle
Rrelease the parking brake
They could thereby endanger themselves and
others. Never leave children unsupervised in
the vehicle. Always take the key with you
when leaving the vehicle, even if you are only
leaving it for a short time.
Z
83
Opening and closing
Doors
Doors
84
Opening and closing
Unlocking and opening the doors
from the inside
For all countries except the United Kingdom: you can open a door from inside the
vehicle even if it has been locked.
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then
not possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle. Deactivate the interior motion sensor
(Y page 74) before you lock the vehicle with
the key. The doors can then be opened from
the inside after the vehicle has been locked
from the outside with the key.
X
X
To unlock: press button :.
To lock: press button ;.
Automatic locking feature
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are
turning.
You could therefore be locked out when:
Rthe
vehicle is being pushed.
vehicle is being towed.
Rthe vehicle is being tested on a dynamometer.
Rthe
X
Pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops
up. The door is unlocked and can be
opened.
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle
from the inside.
The central locking/unlocking button does
not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.
i You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally
from the inside if the vehicle has been
locked with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
i It is only possible to lock the vehicle cen-
trally if the front-passenger door is closed.
To deactivate: press and hold button :
for about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X
On vehicles with a luxury multifunction steering wheel, you can also activate and deactivate the automatic locking via the on-board
computer (Y page 226).
Boot
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with
the key, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door, the antitheft alarm system will be triggered
(Y page 73).
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 80).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
down the locking knob by hand, if necessary.
X Close the driver's door.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 80).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Opening and closing
Unlocking the driver's door (emergency key element)
X
Turn the emergency key element clockwise
as far as it will go to position 1.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element anti-clockwise.
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Make sure that the doors and the boot lid
are locked.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise to position 1.
The door is unlocked.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element clockwise.
X
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
Locking the vehicle (emergency key
element)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked with the
key, use the emergency key element.
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door and the
boot lid.
X Press the locking button (Y page 84).
X Check whether the locking knob on the
front-passenger door is still visible. Press
85
Boot
Important safety notes
Do not leave the key in the boot. You could
otherwise lock yourself out.
G WARNING
Exhaust fumes could enter the vehicle interior
if the engine is running and the boot lid is
open. This could poison you. Therefore, you
should make sure that the boot lid is always
closed when the engine is running.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
Z
Boot
86
i You will find details of the boot lid opening
dimensions in the Technical data section
(Y page 360).
The boot lid can be:
Ropened
and closed manually from outside
automatically from outside
Ropened automatically from inside
Rlocked separately
Runlocked with the emergency key element
Opening and closing
Ropened
Pull the boot lid down using recess :.
X If necessary, lock the vehicle with
the & button on the key (Y page 78) or
with KEYLESS-GO (Y page 79).
i If a KEYLESS-GO key is detected in the
boot, the boot lid cannot be locked and
then opens again.
X
Opening automatically from outside
Important safety notes
Opening/closing manually
Opening
X
Press the % button on the key.
X
Pull handle :.
Raise the boot lid.
X
Closing
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when closing the boot lid.
G WARNING
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then not
possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle.
Therefore, do not leave any people behind in
the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people in need of special assistance if
the vehicle has been locked with the key. As
a result, they may not be able to free themselves in the event of an emergency. As a
result, they could be seriously or even fatally
injured by prolonged exposure to extremely
high or low temperatures, for example. In this
case, rescuing people from outside the vehicle is difficult.
Deactivate the interior motion sensor before
you lock the vehicle with the key. The doors
can then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside with
the key.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
i You will find details of the boot lid opening
dimensions in the Technical data section
(Y page 360).
Opening
You can open the boot lid automatically using
the key or the handle in the boot lid.
Boot
Press and hold the F button on the key
until the boot lid opens.
or
X
If the boot is unlocked, pull on the boot lid
handle and let it go again immediately.
Opening automatically from inside
You can open the boot lid from the driver's
seat when the vehicle is stationary and
unlocked.
Insert the emergency key element into the
boot lid lock as far as the stop.
X Turn the emergency key element clockwise
from position 1 to position 2.
X Remove the emergency key element.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
Unlocking the boot (emergency key
element)
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
X
To open: pull remote operating switch for
boot lid : until the boot lid opens.
If the boot cannot be unlocked with the key
or KEYLESS-GO, use the emergency key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the boot lid, the anti-theft
alarm system will be triggered (Y page 73).
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 80).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
boot lid lock as far as the stop.
Locking the boot separately
In some countries, you can lock the boot separately. If you then unlock the vehicle centrally, the boot remains locked and cannot be
opened.
X Close the boot lid.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 80).
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise from position 1 as far as it will
go to position 2.
The boot is unlocked.
X Turn the emergency key element back to
position 1 and remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
Z
Opening and closing
X
87
88
Side windows
Side windows
Important safety notes
Opening and closing the side windows
Opening and closing
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
between the side window and the door frame
when a side window is opened. Do not touch
or lean against the side window during the
opening procedure. You could become trapped between the side window and the door
frame as the side window moves down. If
there is a risk of becoming trapped, release
the switch or pull the switch upwards to close
the side window again.
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
as you close a side window. If there is a risk
of becoming trapped, release the switch or
press it again to open the side window again.
G WARNING
Children may injure themselves if they open
or close the side windows.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. Always take the key with you when leaving
the vehicle, even if you are only leaving it for
a short time.
G WARNING
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. The children could:
Rbe seriously or even fatally injured on parts
of the vehicle
seriously or even fatally injured by prolonged exposure to extremely high or
extremely low temperatures
If children open a door, they could:
Rbe
Rseriously or even fatally injure other people
Rget
out of the vehicle and injure themselves, or be seriously or even fatally
injured by a passing vehicle
: Left
; Right
The switches for all side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch for
the front-passenger side window on the frontpassenger door.
The switches on the driver's door take precedence.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open: press the corresponding switch.
X To close: pull the corresponding switch.
i If you press the switch beyond the point
of resistance, an automatic opening/closing process is started in the corresponding
direction. You can stop automatic operation by pressing again.
i You can continue to operate the side windows after switching off the engine or
removing the key. This function remains
active for five minutes or until the driver's
or front-passenger door is opened.
Convenience opening feature
You can ventilate the vehicle before you start
driving. To do this, the key is used to carry out
the following functions simultaneously:
Runlock
Ropen
the vehicle
the side windows
Side windows
roller sunblind
Rswitch on the seat ventilation for the driver's seat
i The convenience opening feature can
With KEYLESS-GO:
Rrelease the sensor surface on the door han-
dle.
Rpull
the door handle immediately and hold
it.
The side windows and the panorama sliding
sunroof open.
only be operated using the key. The key
must be close to the driver's door handle.
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Press and hold the % button until the
side windows and the panorama sunroof
are in the desired position.
X
If the roller sunblind of the panorama sliding
sunroof is closed, the roller sunblind is
opened first.
X Press and hold the % button again until
the panorama sliding sunroof is in the
desired position.
X To interrupt convenience opening:
release the % button.
Using the key
i The key must be close to the driver's door
handle.
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Press and hold the & button until the
side windows and the panorama sliding
sunroof are fully closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are closed.
X
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof:
X
Press and hold the & button again until
the roller sunblind of the panorama sliding
sunroof closes.
X
To interrupt convenience closing:
release the & button.
Convenience closing feature
General notes
When you lock the vehicle, you can simultaneously:
Rclose
the side windows
Rclose the panorama sliding sunroof
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof,
you can then close the roller sunblind.
Using KEYLESS-GO
The KEYLESS-GO key must be outside the
vehicle. All the doors must be closed.
G WARNING
When using the convenience closing feature,
make sure that nobody can become trapped.
Proceed as follows if there is a risk of entrapment:
With the key:
Rrelease
the & button.
Rpress
and hold the % button until the
side windows and the panorama sliding
sunroof open again.
Z
Opening and closing
Ropen the panorama sliding sunroof and the
89
Sliding sunroof
90
Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle until the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are fully closed.
i Make sure you only touch recessed sensor surface :.
X
Opening and closing
X
Make sure that all the side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof are closed.
On vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof:
X
Touch recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle again until the roller sunblind
of the panorama sliding sunroof closes.
X
To interrupt convenience closing:
release recessed sensor surface : on the
door handle.
Resetting the side windows
You must reset each side window if a side
window can no longer be closed fully.
X Close all the doors.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed. (Y page 88).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the side window opens again slightly:
Immediately pull the corresponding switch
on the door control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 88).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X If the corresponding side window remains
closed after the button has been released,
the side window has been reset correctly.
If this is not the case, repeat the steps
above again.
X
Problems with the side windows
Problem: a side window cannot be closed
because it is blocked by objects, e.g.
leaves in the window guide.
X
X
Remove the objects.
Close the side window.
Problem: a side window cannot be closed
and you cannot see the cause.
G WARNING
Closing the side windows with increased force
or without the anti-entrapment feature could
lead to serious or even fatal injury. Make sure
that nobody can become trapped when closing the side windows.
If a side window is obstructed during closing
and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull
the corresponding switch again until the
side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased
force.
If a side window is obstructed again during
closing and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull
the corresponding switch again until the
side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the antientrapment feature.
Sliding sunroof
Important safety notes
In the following section, the term "sliding sunroof" refers to the panorama sliding sunroof.
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when opening and closing the sliding sunroof.
If there is a risk of entrapment, release the
switch immediately. During automatic operation, push the switch briefly in any direction
to stop the sliding sunroof.
Sliding sunroof
Children could injure themselves if they operate the sliding sunroof.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. Always take the key with you when leaving
the vehicle, even if you are only leaving it for
a short time.
Operating the panorama sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
Opening and closing
G WARNING
G WARNING
The glass in the panorama sunroof could
break in an accident. If you are not wearing a
seat belt, there is a risk that you could be
thrown through the opening in the event of the
vehicle overturning. Therefore, always wear a
seat belt to reduce the risk of injuries.
! Only open the panorama sliding sunroof
if it is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur.
Do not allow anything to protrude from the
sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could
be damaged.
i Resonance noises can occur in addition
to the usual airflow noises when the sliding
sunroof is open. They are caused by minor
pressure fluctuations in the vehicle interior.
Change the position of the sliding sunroof
or open a side window slightly to reduce or
eliminate these noises.
91
Overhead control panel
: To raise
; Opening
= To close/lower
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Push or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
i If you press the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, an automatic opening/
closing process is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop automatic
operation by pressing again.
X
Rain closing feature
When the key is in position 0 in the ignition
lock or is removed, the panorama sliding sunroof closes automatically:
Rif it starts to rain
Rat extreme outside temperatures
Rafter six hours
Rif there is a malfunction in the power supply
The panorama sliding sunroof remains raised
at the rear in order to allow ventilation of the
vehicle interior.
i If the panorama sliding sunroof is obstructed when being closed by the rain closing
feature, it opens again slightly. The rain
closing feature is then deactivated.
Z
Sliding sunroof
92
The panorama sliding sunroof does not close
if:
Rit
is raised at the rear.
is blocked.
Rno rain is falling on the area of the windscreen being monitored by the rain sensor
(e.g. because the vehicle is under a bridge
or in a carport).
Opening and closing
Rit
Operating the roller sunblind for the
panorama sliding sunroof
General notes
The roller sunblind shields the vehicle interior
from sunlight. The roller sunblind can only be
opened and closed when the panorama sliding sunroof is closed.
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
as you open or close the roller sunblind.
Opening and closing
closing process is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop automatic
operation by pressing again.
Resetting the panorama sliding sunroof
and the roller sunblind
Reset the panorama sliding sunroof and the
roller sunblind if the panorama sliding sunroof
or the roller sunblind does not move
smoothly.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point
of resistance in the direction of arrow =
until the panorama sliding sunroof is fully
closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional second.
X Pull the 3 switch repeatedly to the point
of resistance in the direction of arrow =
until the roller sunblind is fully closed.
X Keep the 3 switch pulled for an additional second.
X Make sure that the panorama sliding sunroof (Y page 91) and the roller sunblind
(Y page 92) can be fully opened again.
X If this is not the case, repeat the steps
above again.
! If the panorama sliding sunroof and the
roller sunblind cannot be fully opened or
closed after resetting, contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
Overhead control panel
: To open
; To open
= To close
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
i If you press the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, an automatic opening/
X
Problems with the sliding sunroof
In the following section, the term "sliding sunroof" refers to the panorama sliding sunroof.
Problem: the sunroof cannot be closed
and you cannot see the cause.
G WARNING
You could be severely or even fatally injured
when closing the sliding sunroof with
increased closing force or if the anti-entrap-
Sliding sunroof
93
ment feature is deactivated. Make sure that
nobody can become trapped when closing the
sliding sunroof.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during
closing and reopens again slightly:
Immediately after the sliding sunroof
blocks, pull the 3 switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of
resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed with increased
force.
Opening and closing
X
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed again during closing and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the sliding sunroof
blocks, pull the 3 switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of
resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed without the
anti-entrapment feature.
Z
94
95
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Useful information .............................. 96
Correct driver's seat position ............ 96
Seats .................................................... 97
Steering wheel .................................. 101
Mirrors ............................................... 103
Memory functions ............................. 105
96
Correct driver's seat position
Useful information
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
Correct driver's seat position
Ryou
can fasten the seat belt properly.
have moved the backrest to an
almost vertical position.
Ryou have set the seat cushion angle so
that your thighs are gently supported.
Ryou can depress the pedals properly.
X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted properly (Y page 98).
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back
of your head is supported at eye level by
the centre of the head restraint.
Ryou
Observe the safety guidelines on steering
wheel adjustment (Y page 101).
X Check whether steering wheel : is adjusted properly.
Adjust the steering wheel manually
(Y page 101)
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
(Y page 102)
When adjusting the steering wheel, make
sure:
Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent.
can move your legs freely.
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly.
Ryou
Observe the safety guidelines on seat adjustment (Y page 97).
X Check whether you have adjusted seat =
properly.
Manual and electrical seat adjustment
(Y page 98)
Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 98)
When adjusting the seat, make sure:
Ryou
are as far away from the driver's airbag as possible.
Ryou are sitting in a normal upright position.
Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 51).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 53).
The seat belt should:
Rfit
snugly across your body
routed across the middle of your
shoulder
Rbe routed in your pelvic area across the
hip joints
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors (Y page 103)
Rbe
Seats
G WARNING
Seats
Make sure that the back of your head is supported at eye level by the central area of the
head restraint. If your head is not supported
correctly by the head restraint, you could suffer a severe neck injury in the event of an
accident. Never drive if the head restraints are
not engaged and set correctly.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
G WARNING
A seat belt can only offer its intended degree
of protection when the backrest is almost vertical and the occupant is sitting upright. Avoid
seat positions that do not allow the seat belt
to be routed correctly. Adjust the backrest so
that it is as upright as possible. Never travel
with the backrest reclined too far backwards.
You could otherwise be seriously or even
fatally injured in the event of an accident or
sudden braking.
The seats can still be adjusted when there is
no key in the ignition lock. For this reason,
children should never be left unsupervised in
the vehicle. They could adjust the seats and
become trapped.
G WARNING
Only adjust the driver's seat when the vehicle
is stationary. You will otherwise be distracted
from the road and traffic conditions and you
could lose control of the vehicle as a result of
the seat moving. This could cause an accident.
G WARNING
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you or
others could be trapped and thereby injured.
Children in particular could unintentionally
press the buttons to electrically adjust the
seats and become trapped.
Take care that:
Rwhile
moving the seats, your hands do not
get under the lever assembly of the seat
adjustment system.
Rchildren in the vehicle do not slide their
hands under the levers.
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when adjusting the seats.
Observe the notes on airbags.
Secure children as recommended; see the
"Children in the vehicle" section.
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rdo
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see the "Interior care" section.
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
! When you move the seats, make sure that
there are no objects in the footwell or
behind the seats. Otherwise, you could
damage the seats and the objects.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
in such a way that you have a good view of
road and traffic conditions.
X Vehicles with a memory function: save
the seat, steering wheel and exterior mirror
settings (Y page 105).
97
Seats
98
i Vehicles without the through-loading fea-
ture: the head restraints cannot be
removed from the rear compartment seats.
Please contact a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for more information.
Adjusting the seat electrically
i Related topics:
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
RRear
bench seat through-loading feature
Adjusting the seats manually and
electrically
: Head restraint height
; Seat cushion angle
= Seat height
? Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
A Backrest angle
i Vehicles with memory function: if PRE-
SAFE® has been triggered, the frontpassenger seat will be moved to a better
position if it was previously in an unfavourable position.
: Backrest angle
; Seat height
= Seat cushion angle
? Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
i Adjust the seat cushion angle so that your
thighs are lightly supported.
Adjusting the head restraints
Adjusting the head restraints manually
Adjusting the head restraint height
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Lift handle ? and slide the seat forwards
or backwards.
X Release lever ? again.
Make sure that you hear the seat engage in
position.
X
Seat cushion angle
X
Turn handwheel = in the desired direction.
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch : and push
the head restraint down to the desired position.
X
Seats
99
Adjusting the head restraints electrically
To adjust the head restraint height: slide
the switch for head restraint adjustment
(Y page 98) up or down in the direction of
the arrow.
Folding the front-seat backrests
forward/back
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Make sure that the backrest engages fully. If
the backrest is not engaged, the message:
Front right seat backrest not locked
or Front left seat backrest not
locked appears in the multifunction display.
Stop the vehicle as soon as road and traffic
conditions permit and remove any objects
that are blocking the backrest.
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when moving the seat. If there is a risk of
someone becoming trapped, press the seat
adjustment switch on the door.
Folding the backrest forwards
With the EASY-ENTRY feature, the seat moves
forwards if you have folded the backrest forwards and the seat is in the rear half of the
adjustment range. This makes it easier for
passengers to get into and out of the rear
compartment.
The head restraint also lowers on vehicles
with electric seat adjustment.
Vehicles without memory function:
release the head restraint if necessary and
push it down.
X Pull seat release handle : forwards and
fold the backrest forwards until the seat
backrest engages.
X Push the seat as far forwards as it will go.
X Vehicles with memory function: pull seat
release handle : forwards and fold the
backrest forwards as far as it will go.
The seat moves automatically to the foremost position.
X
Folding back the backrest
Vehicles without memory function:
push the seat backrest back horizontally
until the seat reaches the position that was
previously set.
X Fold the seat backrest backwards until you
hear it engage. Do so in a smooth manner.
X After the seat backrest has been folded
back, check the position of the head
restraint and set it to the correct position.
X Vehicles with memory function: swing
back the seat backrest.
The seat moves automatically to the stored
position.
X
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
You can adjust the contour of the front seat
backrests individually to provide optimum
support for your back.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
100
Seats
: To raise the backrest contour
; To soften the backrest contour
= To lower the backrest contour
? To harden the backrest contour
Switching the seat heating on/off
Switching on/off
G WARNING
Repeatedly setting the seat heating to level
3 may result in excessive seat temperatures.
The health of passengers that have limited
temperature sensitivity or a limited ability to
react to excessively high temperatures may
be affected or they may even suffer burn-like
injuries. Therefore, do not use seat heating
level 3 repeatedly.
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
The system automatically switches down
from level 3 to level 2 after approximately
eight minutes.
The system automatically switches down
from level 2 to level 1 after approximately ten
minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
Problems with the seat heating
The seat heating has switched off prematurely or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because
too many electrical consumers are switched
on.
X
Switch off electrical consumers which you
do not need, such as the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Switching the seat ventilation on/off
Switching on/off
The three blue indicator lamps in the buttons
indicate the ventilation level you have selected.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
ventilation may switch off.
Driver's and front-passenger seat
Steering wheel
101
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired ventilation level is set.
X
i You can open the front side windows and
the sliding sunroof using the "Convenience
opening" feature (Y page 88). The seat ventilation of the driver's seat automatically
switches to the highest level.
X
Only adjust the steering wheel when the vehicle is stationary and do not pull away until the
steering wheel adjustment mechanism is
locked in position. You might otherwise drive
without the steering wheel adjustment mechanism being locked in position. As a result,
you could be distracted from road and traffic
conditions by an unintentional movement of
the steering wheel and thereby cause an accident.
However, the steerability of the vehicle is not
affected.
Adjusting the steering wheel manually
To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
Problems with the seat ventilation
The seat ventilation has switched off prematurely or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because
too many electrical consumers are switched
on.
X
Switch off electrical consumers which you
do not need, such as the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Steering wheel
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The electrically adjustable steering wheel can
still be adjusted when there is no key in the
ignition lock. Therefore, do not leave children
unsupervised in the vehicle, as they could
become trapped if the steering wheel is adjusted.
: Release lever
; To adjust the steering wheel height
= To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
Push release lever : down completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
X Push release lever : up completely.
The steering column is locked.
X Check if the steering column is locked.
When doing so, try to push the steering
wheel up or down or try to move it in the
fore-and-aft direction.
X
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
G WARNING
102
Steering wheel
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
Do not keep the memory function position
button pressed down, otherwise the memory
function will start and the steering wheel and
seat will begin to move.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. They could open the driver's door and
thereby unintentionally activate the EASYENTRY feature and become trapped.
Position of the steering wheel when the
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature is active
The steering wheel tilts upwards if you:
: To adjust the steering wheel height
; To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
i Related topics:
REASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature
(Y page 102)
RStoring settings (Y page 105)
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature
Important safety notes
The EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature makes getting
in and out of your vehicle easier.
You can activate and deactivate the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature in the on-board computer (Y page 228).
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when you activate the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature.
If there is a risk of someone becoming trapped, stop the adjustment procedure. To halt
the procedure:
Rpress
the steering column adjustment button.
Rbriefly press one of the memory function
position buttons.
The steering column stops moving immediately.
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door and KEYLESS-GO is
in position 1
Ropen the driver's door and the key is in
position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock
Ropen
i The steering wheel only moves upwards if
it has not already reached the upper end
stop.
If you insert the key into the ignition lock with
the driver's door closed, the steering wheel is
automatically moved to the previously set
position.
Position of the steering wheel for driving
The steering wheel is moved to the previously
set position if:
Rthe
Ryou
driver's door is closed
insert the key into the ignition lock
or
Ryou
press the Start/Stop button once on
vehicles with KEYLESS-GO.
If you close the driver's door with the key
inserted into the ignition lock, the steering
wheel is automatically moved to the previously set position.
The last position of the steering wheel is
stored after each manual setting or when you
store the setting with the memory function
(Y page 105).
Mirrors
103
Mirrors
Rear-view mirror
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X Press button : for the left-hand exterior
mirror or button ; for the right-hand exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding
button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button = as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button = up, down, to
the right or to the left until the exterior mirror is set to a position that provides you
with a good overview of traffic conditions.
X
X
Anti-dazzle mode: flick anti-dazzle
switch : forwards or back.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
G WARNING
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects are actually closer than they
appear. You could misjudge the distance from
vehicles driving behind and cause an accident, e.g. when changing lane. For this reason, make sure of the actual distance from the
vehicle driving behind by glancing over your
shoulder.
Folding the exterior mirrors in or out
electrically
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger
field of vision.
The exterior mirrors are automatically heated
if the rear window heating is switched on and
the outside temperature is low.
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
X
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Rear-view mirror (manual anti-dazzle)
104
Mirrors
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while the vehicle is
in motion, as they may otherwise vibrate.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Setting the exterior mirrors
If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must
be reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise
not fold in when you select the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the on-board
computer (Y page 228).
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 in
the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
Folding the exterior mirrors in or out
automatically
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function
is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 228):
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside.
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and
then open the driver's or front-passenger
door.
i The mirrors do not fold out if they have
Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors
G WARNING
If incident light from headlamps is prevented
from striking the sensor in the rear-view mirror, for instance, by luggage piled too high in
the vehicle, the mirror's automatic anti-dazzle
function will not operate.
Incident light could then blind you. This may
distract you from the traffic conditions and,
as a result, you may cause an accident.
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror
on the driver's side automatically go into antidazzle mode if the ignition is switched on and
incident light from headlamps strikes the sensor in the rear-view mirror.
The mirrors do not go into anti-dazzle mode if
reverse gear is engaged.
Parking position for the exterior mirror on the front-passenger side
Setting and storing the parking position
You can position the front-passenger side
exterior mirror in such a way that you can see
the rear wheel on that side as soon as you
engage reverse gear. You can store this position.
been folded in manually.
Exterior mirror out of position
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position, proceed as follows:
X Vehicles without electrically folding
exterior mirrors: move the exterior mirror
into the correct position manually.
X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior mirrors: press the mirror-folding button (Y page 103) repeatedly until you hear
the mirror engage in position.
The mirror housing is engaged again and
you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 103).
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X
Memory functions
i If you shift the transmission to another
position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position.
i You can also store the parking position
using memory button M ?.
Make sure that the key is in position
2 in the ignition lock.
X With the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side activated, use adjustment button = to adjust the exterior
mirror to a position which allows you
to see the rear wheel and the kerb.
X Press memory button M ? and one of
the arrows on adjustment button =
within three seconds.
The parking position is stored if the
exterior mirror does not move.
X
If the mirror moves out of position, repeat
the steps.
Calling up a stored parking position setting
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Adjust the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side with the corresponding button (Y page 103).
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
X
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves back to its original position:
Ras
soon as you exceed a speed of
15 km/h
Rabout ten seconds after you have disengaged reverse gear
Rif you press button : for the exterior mirror on the driver's side
Memory functions
Storing settings
With the memory function, you can store up
to three different settings, e.g. for three different people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Rposition of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
Rdriver's side: steering wheel position
Rdriver's side: position of the exterior mirrors on the driver's and front-passenger
sides
G WARNING
The memory function can still be used when
the key has been removed. For this reason,
children should never be left unsupervised in
the vehicle. They could otherwise become
trapped when adjusting the seat or the steering wheel.
G WARNING
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side when the vehicle is stationary. Otherwise, you could be distracted from the traffic
conditions by the steering wheel and seat
moving of their own accord, and as a result
cause an accident.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror to a position that allows you
to see the rear wheel and the kerb.
The parking position is stored.
X
105
Memory functions
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
106
Adjust the seat (Y page 98).
On the driver's side, adjust the steering
wheel (Y page 102) and the exterior mirrors
(Y page 103).
X Press memory button M and then press
storage position button 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected preset position. A tone sounds when the settings have been completed.
X
X
Calling up a stored setting
X
Press and hold the relevant storage position button 1, 2 or 3 until the seat, steering
wheel and exterior mirrors are in the stored
position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as
soon as you release the storage position
button.
107
108
108
114
114
118
Lights and windscreen wipers
Useful information ............................
Exterior lighting ................................
Interior lighting .................................
Changing bulbs .................................
Windscreen wipers ...........................
Exterior lighting
108
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
If the headlamps are converted to symmetrical dipped beam, the "motorway mode" and
"extended range foglamps" functions (Intelligent Light System) are not available.
Light switch
Operation
Lights and windscreen wipers
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
Exterior lighting
Important safety notes
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched
on even during the daytime. In some countries, operation of the headlamps varies due
to legal requirements and self-imposed obligations.
Notes on driving abroad
Convert to symmetrical dipped beam
when driving abroad: switch the headlamps
to symmetrical dipped beam in countries in
which traffic drives on the opposite side of the
road to the country where the vehicle is registered. This prevents glare to oncoming traffic. Symmetrical lights do not illuminate as
large an area of the edge of the carriageway.
Convert the headlamps as close to the border
as possible before driving in these countries
(Y page 224).
Convert to asymmetrical dipped beam
after returning: convert the headlamps back
to asymmetrical dipped beam as soon as possible after crossing the border when returning
(Y page 224).
5
1W Left-hand parking lamps
2X Right-hand parking lamps
3T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment cluster lighting
4Ã Automatic headlamp mode/daytime
driving lights
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam headlamps
BR Rear foglamp
CN Foglamps5
The turn signals, main-beam headlamps and
the headlamp flasher are operated using the
combination switch (Y page 110).
! Switch off the side lamps and parking
lamp when you leave the vehicle. This prevents the battery from discharging.
The exterior lighting (except the side lamps/
parking lamps) switches off automatically if
you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door with the key in position 0
Ropen
Only vehicles with front foglamps have the "Foglamps" function.
Exterior lighting
When the dipped-beam headlamps are
switched on, the L indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
To switch on the dipped-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The L indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
X
Daytime driving lights
You can activate or deactivate the daytime
driving lights function using the on-board
computer (Y page 224).
X To activate the daytime driving lights:
you can activate the daytime driving lights
function using the on-board computer
(vehicles with a 12-button multifunction
steering wheel).
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
When the engine is on: depending on the
ambient light conditions, the daytime driving lights or the parking and dipped-beam
headlamps are switched on.
When the dipped-beam headlamps are
switched on, the L indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
Automatic headlamp mode
X
6
To switch on automatic headlamp
mode: turn the light switch to Ã.
Key in position 1 in the ignition lock: the
side lamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the
ambient light.
With the engine running: depending on the
brightness of the ambient light, the daytime
driving lights6 or the dipped-beam headlamps are switched on or off automatically.
G WARNING
If the light switch is set to Ã, the dippedbeam headlamps will not come on automatically if it is foggy. This could endanger you and
others. Therefore, turn the light switch to
L in fog.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle's
lighting at all times.
Foglamps and rear foglamp
Front foglamps
Only vehicles with front foglamps have the
"Foglamps" function.
G WARNING
If you suspect that driving conditions will be
foggy, turn the light switch to L before you
start your journey. Otherwise, your vehicle
may not be visible and you could endanger
yourself and others.
To switch on the front foglamps: turn the
key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start
the engine.
X Turn the light switch to T, L or
Ã.
X Press the N button.
The green N indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the front foglamps: press
the N button.
The green N indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
X
Rear foglamp
X To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the
key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start
the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
Only if daytime driving lights have been activated via the on-board computer.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Dipped-beam headlamps
109
Exterior lighting
110
Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear foglamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
X
Lights and windscreen wipers
Vehicles with front foglamps: when the light
switch is in the T position, the rear foglamp can only be switched on if the foglamps
(without dipped-beam headlamps) are
switched on.
Headlamp cleaning system
The headlamps are cleaned automatically if
the "Wipe with washer fluid" function is operated ten times while the lights are on and the
engine is running (Y page 118). When you
switch off the ignition, the automatic headlamp cleaning system is reset and counting is
resumed from 0.
Combination switch
Turn signals
Adjusting the headlamp range (halogen
headlamps)
The headlamp range control allows you to
adjust the cone of light from the headlamps
to suit the vehicle load.
: Main-beam headlamps
; Turn signal, right
= Headlamp flasher
? Turn signal, left
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction
of arrow ; or ?.
X
Headlamp range control
g Driver's seat and front-passenger seat
occupied
1 Driver's seat, front-passenger seat and
rear seats occupied
2 Driver's seat, front-passenger seat and
rear seats occupied, boot laden
3 Driver's and front-passenger seats occu-
pied and maximum permissible rear axle
load utilised, e.g. when towing a trailer
Start the engine.
X Turn headlamp range control to the position which corresponds to the load in your
vehicle.
X
Main-beam headlamps
To switch on the main-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X
Exterior lighting
Headlamp flasher
only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning
lamps: press button :.
The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of
over 10 km/h again after full brake application.
i The hazard warning lamps still operate if
the ignition is switched off.
Intelligent Light System
Active light function
To switch on: turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 1 or 2 or start the engine.
X Pull the combination switch in the direction
of arrow =.
X
Hazard warning lamps
The active light function is a system that
moves the headlamps according to the steering movements of the front wheels. In this
way, relevant areas remain illuminated while
driving. This allows you to recognise pedestrians, cyclists and animals.
Active: when the lights are switched on.
The hazard warning lamps automatically
switch on if:
Cornering light function
Ran
airbag is deployed.
vehicle decelerates rapidly from a
speed of more than 70 km/h and comes to
a standstill.
X To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on
a turn signal using the combination switch,
Rthe
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of
arrow :.
In the à position, the main-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark
and the engine is running.
The K indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the main-beam headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the main-beam headlamps: move the combination switch back
to its normal position.
The K indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
X
111
112
Exterior lighting
The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the
direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. It can only
be activated when the dipped-beam headlamps are switched on.
Active:
Rif
Lights and windscreen wipers
you are driving at speeds below
40 km/h, the cornering light function is
activated either by the turn signal or by the
steering wheel being turned.
Rif you are driving at speeds between
40 km/h and 70 km/h, the cornering light
function is activated by the steering wheel
being turned.
Not active: if you are driving at speeds above
40 km/h or switch off the turn signal or turn
the steering wheel to the straight-ahead position.
The cornering light function may remain lit for
a short time, but is automatically switched off
after no more than three minutes.
Extended range foglamps
Motorway mode
Motorway mode increases the range of the
beam.
Active:
Rif
you are driving at speeds above
110 km/h and do not make any large steering movements for 1,000 m
Rif you are driving at speeds above
130 km/h
Not active: if you are driving at speeds below
80 km/h following activation
The extended range foglamps reduce the
glare experienced by the driver and improve
the illumination of the edge of the carriageway.
Active: if you are driving at speeds below
70 km/h and you switch on the rear foglamp
Not active: if you are driving at speeds above
100 km/h or if you switch off the rear foglamp
following activation
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
You can use this function to set the headlamps to change between dipped beam and
main beam automatically. The system recognises vehicles with their lights on, either
approaching from the opposite direction or
travelling in front of your vehicle, and consequently switches the headlamps from main
beam to dipped beam.
The system automatically adapts the dippedbeam headlamp range depending on the distance to the other vehicle. Once the system
no longer detects any other vehicles, it reactivates the main-beam headlamps.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windscreen near the overhead control
panel.
Exterior lighting
113
indicator lamp in the instrument cluster
stays on.
X To deactivate: move the combination
switch back to its normal position.
The _ indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is only an aid
designed to assist driving. The driver is
responsible for adjusting the vehicle's lighting
to the prevailing light, vision and traffic conditions.
The system may be impaired or deactivated:
Rif
To activate: activate the Adaptive Highbeam Assist function using the on-board
computer (Y page 225).
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :
(Y page 110).
The _ indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up if it is dark and the light
sensor activates the dipped-beam headlamps.
If you are driving at speeds above
45 km/h:
the headlamp range is set automatically
depending on the distance between the
vehicle and other road users.
If you are driving at speeds above
55 km/h and no other road users are recognised:
the main-beam headlamps are switched on
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster also lights up.
If you are driving at speeds below
45 km/h or other road users are recognised or the roads are adequately lit:
the main-beam headlamps are switched off
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out. The _
X
there is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray
Rif the area of the windscreen around the
optical sensor is dirty, misted up or covered
up, e.g. by a sticker
The system may not recognise the following
road users:
Rroad users that have no lighting, e.g. pedes-
trians
users that have poor lighting, e.g.
cyclists
Rroad users whose lighting is not clearly visible, e.g. road users behind a crash barrier
Ron rare occasions: road users that have
lights that may be recognised too late or not
at all
The automatic main-beam headlamps will not
be deactivated, or they may be activated
despite road users travelling in front of or
approaching the vehicle.
Thus, you could cause an accident and injure
yourself and others. Always observe traffic
conditions and, if necessary, dip the lights
manually.
Rroad
Headlamps misted up inside
The headlamps may mist up on the inside if
there is high atmospheric humidity.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
G WARNING
Changing bulbs
114
X
Drive with the headlamps switched on.
The level of moisture diminishes, depending on the length of the journey and the
weather conditions (humidity and temperature).
If the level of moisture does not diminish:
X Have the headlamps checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Automatic interior lighting control
X
To switch on/off: press the | button.
When the automatic interior lighting control is activated, the button is flush with the
overhead control panel.
The interior lighting automatically switches
on if you:
Runlock
the vehicle
a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
The interior light is activated for a short while
when the key is removed from the ignition
lock. You can activate this delayed switch-off
using the on-board computer (Y page 225).
Ropen
Lights and windscreen wipers
Interior lighting
Overview of interior lighting
Manual interior lighting control
To switch the interior lighting on/off:
press the c button.
X To switch the reading lamps on/off:
press the p button.
X
: u To switch the rear interior lighting
;
=
?
A
on/off
| To switch the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
p To switch the right-hand front reading lamp on/off
c To switch the front interior lighting
on/off
p To switch the left-hand front reading
lamp on/off
Interior lighting control
Important notes
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time
except for when the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Crash-responsive emergency lighting
The interior lighting is activated automatically
if the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X To switch off the crash-responsive
emergency lighting: press the hazard
warning lamp button.
or
X Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
key.
Changing bulbs
Important safety notes
Xenon bulbs
If your vehicle is equipped with xenon bulbs,
you can recognise this by the following: the
cone of light from the xenon bulbs moves
from the top to the bottom and back again
when you start the engine. For this to be
Changing bulbs
G DANGER
Xenon bulbs carry a high voltage. You could
get an electric shock and be seriously or even
fatally injured if you touch the electric contacts on xenon bulbs. Therefore, never
remove the cover from xenon bulbs.
Do not change xenon bulbs yourself, but have
them replaced at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist
knowledge and tools to carry out the work
required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Other bulbs
There are bulbs other than the xenon bulbs
that you cannot replace. Replace only the
bulbs listed (Y page 115). Have the bulbs that
you cannot replace yourself changed at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
If you require assistance changing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Do not touch the glass tube of new bulbs with
your bare hands. Even minor contamination
can burn into the glass surface and reduce
the service life of the bulbs. Always use a lintfree cloth or only touch the base of the bulb
when fitting.
Only use bulbs of the correct type.
If the new bulb still does not light up, consult
a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
G WARNING
Bulbs and lights can become very hot. For this
reason, allow them to cool down before
changing them. Otherwise, you could burn
yourself when you touch them.
Keep bulbs out of the reach of children. Otherwise, they could damage them, for example,
and injure themselves.
Never use a bulb which has been dropped.
Such a bulb may explode and injure you.
Halogen bulbs are pressurised and could
explode when you change them, especially if
they are very hot. You should therefore wear
eye protection and gloves when you are
changing them.
Overview of bulb replacement – bulbs
You can change the following bulbs. The bulb
type can be found in the legend.
Halogen headlamps
: Side lamp/parking lamp: W 5 W
; Main-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
= Dipped-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
observed, the lights must be switched on
before starting the engine.
115
Changing bulbs
116
Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Turn bulb holder ; anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages.
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Bi-xenon headlamps
: Cornering lamp: H7 55 W
Tail lamps
: Reversing lamp: P 21 W
; Brake lamp: P 21 W
= Brake lamp/tail lamp: P 21 W
Changing the front bulbs
Dipped-beam headlamps (halogen
headlamps)
X
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
Main-beam headlamps (halogen headlamps)
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
X Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Turn bulb holder ; anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages.
X
X
Changing bulbs
Side lamps/parking lamps (halogen
headlamps)
117
Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages.
X
Changing the rear bulbs
Switch off the lights.
X Open the bonnet.
X Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Pull out bulb holder ;.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ;.
X Align housing cover : and turn it clockwise until it engages.
X
Cornering light function (Intelligent
Light System)
You must open the side trim panel in the boot
and remove the first-aid kit before you can
change the bulbs in the tail lamps.
Example: right-hand side trim panel
To open: loosen side trim panel : at the
top and fold it down in the direction of the
arrow.
X To close: insert side panel :.
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the bonnet.
X Turn housing cover : anti-clockwise and
pull it out.
X Turn bulb holder ; anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X
X
Left-hand side trim panel (vehicles with a sound
system or trailer coupling)
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Opening and closing the side trim panels
Windscreen wipers
118
To open: turn rotary catch : 90° in the
direction of the arrow and remove side trim
panel ;.
X To close: insert side trim panel ; and turn
release knob : 90° in the opposite direction to the arrow.
X
Tail lamps
Switch off the lights.
Open the boot.
X Open the side trim panel (Y page 117).
X
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Press the respective bulb :, ; or = back
and turn it anti-clockwise to remove it from
the bulb holder.
X Insert the new bulb into the bulb holder and
turn it clockwise.
X Reinsert the connector for LED light functions in the bulb holder.
X Insert the bulb holder again and lock it in
place.
X Insert the tail lamp connector.
X Close the side trim panel (Y page 117).
X
Windscreen wipers
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
Remove the tail lamp connector
Simultaneously press retaining lugs : in
the direction of the arrow and slightly pull
out the bulb holder with the bulbs.
X Remove the connector for LED light functions from the top of the bulb holder.
X Pull the bulb holder out with the bulbs.
X
X
G WARNING
The windscreen will not longer be wiped properly if the wiper blades are worn. This could
prevent you from observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident. Replace
the wiper blades twice a year, ideally in spring
and autumn.
! Do not operate the windscreen wipers
when the windscreen is dry, as this could
damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust
that has collected on the windscreen can
scratch the glass if wiping takes place when
the windscreen is dry.
! If the windscreen wipers leave smears on
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, this may
be due to wax or other residue. Clean the
windscreen with washer fluid after an automatic car wash.
: reversing lamp
; brake lamp
= Side lamp/brake lamp
Windscreen wipers
119
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The wiper arms could start moving and cause
an injury if you leave the windscreen wipers
switched on.
Remove the key from the ignition lock before
replacing the wiper blades.
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low7
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high8
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/ î To wipe the
windscreen using washer fluid
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
X
! Intermittent wiping with rain sensor: due
to optical influences and the windscreen
becoming dirty in dry weather conditions,
the windscreen wipers may be activated
inadvertently. This could damage the windscreen wiper blades or scratch the windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
In the Ä or Å position, the appropriate
wiping frequency is set automatically according to the intensity of the rain. In the Å
position, the rain sensor is more sensitive
than in the Ä position, causing the windscreen wiper to wipe more frequently.
7
8
! To avoid damaging the windscreen wiper
blades, make sure that you touch only the
wiper arm of the windscreen wiper.
! Never open the bonnet if a windscreen
wiper arm has been folded away from the
windscreen.
Never fold a windscreen wiper arm without
a wiper blade back onto the windscreen.
Hold the windscreen wiper arm firmly when
you change the wiper blade. If you release
the windscreen wiper arm without a wiper
blade and it falls onto the windscreen, the
windscreen may be damaged by the force
of the impact.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the wiper blades replaced by a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. at a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Replacing the wiper blades
Removing the wiper blades
X Remove the key from the ignition lock or
turn the key to position 0 (KEYLESS-GO).
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen until it engages.
X Set the wiper blade at right angles to the
wiper arm.
Rain sensor set to low sensitivity.
Rain sensor set to high sensitivity.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Combination switch
1 $ Windscreen wipers off
Windscreen wipers
120
Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windscreen wipers checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
X
The spray nozzles are misaligned
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Remove the wiper blade from the retaining
pin on the wiper arm in the direction of the
arrow.
Fitting the wiper blades
X Push the new wiper blade onto the retaining pin on the wiper arm in the opposite
direction to the arrow.
Make sure that the wiper blade slides fully
onto the retaining pin on the wiper arm.
X Turn the wiper blade parallel to the wiper
arm.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
Problems with the windscreen wipers
The windscreen wipers are obstructed
Leaves or snow, for example, may be
obstructing the windscreen wiper movement.
The wiper motor has been deactivated.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the
key from the ignition lock.
or
X Switch off the engine using the Start/Stop
button and open the driver's door.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
The windscreen wipers are inoperative
The windscreen wiper drive is malfunctioning.
The windscreen washer fluid from the spray
nozzles no longer hits the centre of the windscreen. The spray nozzles are misaligned.
X Have the spray nozzles adjusted at a qualified specialist workshop.
121
122
122
124
132
Climate control
Useful information ............................
Overview of climate control systems ...................................................
Operating the climate control system .....................................................
Adjusting the air vents .....................
122
Overview of climate control systems
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Please read the information on qualified
Climate control
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
Overview of climate control systems
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Observe the settings recommended on the
following pages. Otherwise, the windows
could mist up. This may obstruct your view of
the traffic situation and, as a result, you may
cause an accident.
THERMATIC automatic climate control controls the temperature and the humidity in the
vehicle interior and filters undesirable substances from the air.
THERMATIC automatic climate control is only
operational when the engine is running. Optimum operation is only achieved when you
drive with the side windows and panorama
sliding sunroof closed.
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 88). This
will speed up the cooling process and the
desired vehicle interior temperature will be
reached more quickly.
i The integrated filter can filter out most
particles of dust and completely filters out
pollen. A clogged filter reduces the amount
of air supplied to the vehicle interior. For
this reason, you should always observe the
interval for replacing the filter, which is
specified in the Service Booklet. As it
depends on environmental conditions, e.g.
heavy air pollution, the interval may be
shorter than stated in the Service Booklet.
i It is possible that the residual heat func-
tion may be activated automatically an hour
after the key is removed. The vehicle is then
ventilated for 30 minutes to dry the airconditioning system.
Overview of climate control systems
123
Climate control
Control panel for THERMATIC automatic climate control (2-zone)
: Sets the temperature, left (Y page 125)
; Demists the windscreen (Y page 126)
= Activates/deactivates the ZONE function (Y page 125)
? Activates/deactivates cooling with air dehumidification (Y page 124)
A Switches the rear window heating on/off (Y page 126)
B Sets the temperature, right (Y page 125)
C Activates/deactivates air-recirculation mode (Y page 127)
D Sets the air distribution (Y page 125)
E Increases the airflow (Y page 125)
F Reduces the airflow (Y page 125)
G Switches climate control on/off (Y page 124)
H Sets climate control to automatic mode (Y page 124)
Notes on using THERMATIC automatic
climate control
The following contains notes and recommendations on optimum use of THERMATIC automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons. The indicator lamps in the
à and ¿ buttons light up.
RSet the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly use the demisting function briefly until
the windscreen is clear again.
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
if there are unpleasant outside odours or
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise mist up, as in air-recirculation mode,
no fresh air is drawn into the vehicle.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for
the front-passenger side as well. The indicator lamp in the á button goes out.
Z
Operating the climate control system
124
Operating the climate control system
Switching climate control on/off
Important information
i When climate control is switched off, the
air supply and air circulation are also
switched off. Only select this setting
briefly. Otherwise, the windows may mist
up.
more quickly. This may prevent you from
observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when THERMOTRONIC is in cooling mode. This is normal and not a sign that
there is a malfunction.
i The cooling with air dehumidification
function uses refrigerant R134a. This coolant does not contain chlorofluorocarbons,
and therefore does not damage the ozone
layer.
i Switch on climate control primarily using
the à button (Y page 124).
Climate control
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To switch on: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X Press button ^.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previously selected settings come
into effect again.
X To switch off: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
X
Activating/deactivating cooling with
air dehumidification
Important information
The cooling with air dehumidification function
is only available when the engine is running.
The air inside the vehicle is cooled and dehumidified according to the temperature selected.
G WARNING
If the "cooling with air dehumidification" function is deactivated, the air inside the vehicle
will not be cooled (during warm weather) or
dehumidified. The windows could mist up
Activating/deactivating
To activate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up.
X To switch off: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes
out. The cooling with air dehumidification
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
X
Problems with the cooling with air
dehumidification function
When you press the ¿ button, the indicator lamp in the button flashes three times or
remains off. You can no longer switch on the
cooling with air dehumidification function.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Setting climate control to automatic
mode
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and
the air distribution.
Automatic mode will achieve optimal operation if cooling with air dehumidification is also
activated. If desired, cooling with air dehumidification can be deactivated.
Operating the climate control system
X
a Directs the airflow through the footwell and demister vents
_ Directs the airflow through the demister, centre and side air vents as well as
the footwell air vents
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
airflow is always directed through the side
air vents. The side air vents can only be
closed when the controls on the side air
vents are turned downwards.
To switch off: press the _ button.
or
X
Press the K or I button.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are deactivated.
Setting the temperature
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase/reduce: turn controls : and
B clockwise or anti-clockwise
(Y page 123).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the _ button repeatedly until the
desired symbol appears in the display.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out. Automatic control is deactivated and
the air distribution is controlled according
to the selected setting.
X
X
Setting the air distribution
Air distribution settings
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents
S Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents and the footwell air
vents
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister vents
b Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the demister vents
Setting the airflow
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase/reduce: press the K or
I button.
X
Switching the ZONE function on/off
X
To switch on: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button lights
up.
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is not adopted for the front-passenger
side.
When the buttons for temperature, airflow or
air distribution are activated, the temperature
setting for the driver's side is not adopted for
the other climate control zones.
X To switch off: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out.
Z
Climate control
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are activated.
X
125
Operating the climate control system
126
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the front-passenger
side.
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
Activate the ¿ cooling with air dehumidification function.
X Activate automatic mode Ã.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the demisting function (Y page 126).
X
Demisting the windscreen
You can use this function to defrost the windscreen or to demist the inside of the windscreen and the side windows.
i You should only select the demisting
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
function until the windscreen is clear again.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
Climate control
X
Rcooling
with air dehumidification on
airflow9
Rhigh temperature9
Rair distribution to the windscreen and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
Rhigh
X
To switch off: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previously selected settings come
into effect again. The cooling with air dehumidification function remains on. Air-recirculation mode remains deactivated.
or
X
Press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X
Turn temperature control : or B clockwise or anti-clockwise (Y page 123).
or
X
Press the K or I button.
9
Depending on the outside temperature.
Windows misted up on the outside
Activate the windscreen wipers.
Press the _ button repeatedly until the
O or P symbol appears in the display.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
X
X
Rear window heating
Activating/deactivating
G WARNING
Clear all windows of ice or snow before setting
off. Otherwise, impaired visibility could
endanger you and others.
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as
soon as the window is clear. as it only
switches off automatically after several
minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window heating may switch off.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the ¤ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
Operating the climate control system
The rear window heating has switched off
prematurely or cannot be activated.
X Switch off any consumers that are not
required, e.g. reading lamps or interior
lighting.
When the battery is sufficiently charged,
the rear window heating is activated again
automatically.
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
You can deactivate the flow of fresh air if
unpleasant odours are entering the vehicle
from outside. The air already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated.
G WARNING
Only switch over to air-recirculation mode
briefly at low outside temperatures. Otherwise, the windows could mist up, thus impairing visibility and endangering yourself and
others. This may prevent you from observing
the traffic conditions, thereby causing an
accident.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up.
X
i In the event of high pollution levels or at
high outside temperatures, air-recirculation mode is automatically activated. When
air-recirculation mode is activated automatically, the indicator lamp in the g
button is not lit.
Outside air is added after about 30
minutes.
X
To switch off: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out.
Convenience opening/closing using
the air-recirculation button
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
between the side window and the door frame
as the side windows are opened and closed.
Make sure that all objects and body parts are
clear of the side windows when they are being
opened or closed. You or the objects could be
drawn in or become trapped between the side
window and the door frame as the window
moves. If there is a risk of entrapment, operate the W switch to move the side window
in the opposite direction.
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
as the panorama sliding sunroof is opened
and closed. If there is a risk of entrapment,
operate the 3 switch to move the panorama sliding sunroof in the opposite direction.
X
Convenience closing feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows and the panorama sliding sunroof are
closed.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
X
Convenience opening feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows and the panorama sliding sunroof
have opened. The side windows and the
panorama sliding sunroof move back to
their original position.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
i If you open the side windows or the pan-
orama sliding sunroof manually after closing with the convenience closing feature,
they will remain in this position when
opened using the convenience opening feature.
Z
Climate control
Problems with the rear window heating
127
128
Operating the climate control system
Auxiliary heating
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Exhaust fumes are produced when the auxiliary heating is in operation. Inhaling these
exhaust fumes can be poisonous. You should
therefore switch off the auxiliary heating in
confined spaces without an extraction system, e.g. a garage.
Climate control
G WARNING
When operating the auxiliary heating, parts of
the vehicle may become very hot, and highly
inflammable material such as fuels could be
ignited. Operating the auxiliary heating is thus
prohibited at filling stations or when your vehicle is being refuelled. You must therefore
switch off the auxiliary heating at filling stations.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
You cannot use the auxiliary ventilation to
cool the vehicle interior to a temperature
lower than the outside temperature.
Before switching on
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Set the temperature.
X
The auxiliary heating/ventilation can be activated even when the climate control is being
controlled manually. Optimum comfort can
be attained when the system is set to automatic mode. Set the temperature to 22 †.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation can be activated or deactivated using the remote control
or the button on the centre console.
The on-board computer can be used to specify up to three departure times, one of which
may be preselected (Y page 227).
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the centre console
button
i Switch on the auxiliary heating regularly,
e.g. for about ten minutes every month.
The auxiliary heating heats the air in the vehicle interior to the set temperature without
using the heat of the running engine. The auxiliary heating is operated directly using the
vehicle's fuel. For this reason, the tank content must be at least at reserve fuel level to
ensure that the auxiliary heating functions.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation automatically adjusts to changes in temperature and
weather conditions. For this reason, the auxiliary heating could switch from ventilation
mode to heating mode or from heating mode
to ventilation mode.
The auxiliary heating switches off automatically after 50 minutes. This time limit can be
altered. To do this, visit a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Button on the centre console
The colours of the indicator lamps on the button have the following meanings:
Blue Auxiliary ventilation switched on
Red
Auxiliary heating switched on
Yellow Departure time preselected
(Y page 227)
Operating the climate control system
129
Switching on auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button : lights up.
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the remote control
Your vehicle comes with one remote control.
You may use two additional remote controls
for your vehicle. For further information, consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The remote control has a maximum range of
approximately 300 metres. This range is
reduced by:
Rsources
of radio interference
objects between the remote control
and the vehicle
Rthe remote control being in an unfavourable position in relation to the vehicle
Rtransmitting from an enclosed space
Rsolid
i The optimum range can be achieved if you
hold the remote control vertically, pointing
upwards when you press one of the buttons.
i A battery symbol appears in the display
when the battery in the remote control is
low. Replace the remote control battery
(Y page 130).
Auxiliary heating remote control
: Display
; . To check the status/set the depar-
ture time
= ^ To switch off the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
? u To switch on the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
A , To check the status/set the depar-
ture time
Switching on auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press the u button.
ON is shown in the remote control display.
Switching off auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
Checking the status of the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press the , or . button.
The following messages can appear in the
display:
Display
Meaning
The auxiliary heating/
ventilation is switched
off.
Z
Climate control
Switching off auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button : goes out.
130
Operating the climate control system
The auxiliary ventilation
is switched on. The number in the display shows
the remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
ventilation.
Climate control
The auxiliary heating is
switched on. The number
in the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
heating.
A departure time has
been activated. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary ventilation is currently selected. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary heating is currently
selected. The departure
time appears in the display.
Setting a departure time
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the time to be changed appears in the
display.
X Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The Î symbol in the remote control display flashes.
X Press the , or . button to set the
desired departure time.
i The longer you press the , or .
button, the faster the time changes.
X
Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The new departure time is stored.
Activating a set departure time
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the desired departure time appears in
the display.
X Press the u button.
The Í symbol and the departure time
appear in the display.
Deactivating a set departure time
X Press the , or . button.
The status of the auxiliary heating is shown
in the display.
X Press the . button.
The first departure time stored appears in
the display.
X Press the ^ button.
The display message OFF appears in the
display.
Replacing the remote control battery
One 6 V pin battery, type 2CR11108 is
required.
Prise apart the side arms of battery
cover ; and pull off battery cover ;.
X Remove old battery :.
X Insert the new battery. Observe the polarity
signs on the back of the remote control
when doing so.
X
Operating the climate control system
131
Slide battery cover ; back onto the
remote control.
X Use the remote control to check the vehicle's auxiliary heating functions.
Climate control
X
Z
132
Adjusting the air vents
Problems with the auxiliary heating/ventilation
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
FAIL
The starter battery is not charged sufficiently or the system is
faulty.
X Charge the starter battery.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
$
The signal transmission between the transmitter and the vehicle
is faulty.
X Change your position in relation to the vehicle, moving closer if
necessary.
X Make another attempt to switch the auxiliary heating on or off
using the remote control.
Climate control
FAIL
©
FAIL
There is not enough fuel in the fuel tank, or the auxiliary heating
is faulty.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Adjusting the air vents
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could cause burns or frostbite to
bare skin in the immediate vicinity of the
vents. Keep bare skin away from these air
outlets. If necessary, direct the airflow away
to a different area of the vehicle interior.
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
Rnever
cover the vents or air inlets in the
vehicle interior.
i For virtually draught-free ventilation,
adjust the sliders of the air vents to the
centre position.
Adjusting the air vents
Setting the centre air vents
133
flow depends on the airflow and air distribution settings.
! Close the air vent when heating the vehi-
cle.
At high outside temperatures, open the air
vent and activate the "cooling with air dehumidification" function. Otherwise, temperature-sensitive items stored in the glove
compartment could be damaged.
: Centre air vent, left
; Centre air vent, right
Climate control
= Centre vent thumbwheel, right
? Centre vent thumbwheel, left
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheels =
and ? up or down.
Setting the side air vents
: Air vent thumbwheel
; Air vent
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel :
clockwise or anti-clockwise.
Setting the rear-compartment air
vents
Setting the centre vents in the rear compartment
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel = to the
left or right.
i Side window demister vent : is never
completely shut, even if side air vent ; is
shut.
Setting the glove compartment air
vent
When automatic climate control is activated,
the glove compartment can be ventilated, for
instance to cool its contents. The level of air-
: Rear-compartment air vent thumbwheel
; Rear-compartment air vent, right
= Rear-compartment air vent, left
Z
Adjusting the air vents
134
Climate control
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel : up or
down.
Useful information ............................
Running-in notes ...............................
Driving ...............................................
Manual transmission ........................
Automatic transmission ...................
Refuelling ...........................................
Parking ...............................................
Driving tips ........................................
Driving systems ................................
Trailer towing ....................................
136
136
136
144
145
152
158
159
162
199
Driving and parking
135
136
Driving
Useful information
Driving and parking
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
Running-in notes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
New brake pads/linings only have optimal
braking performance after several hundred
kilometres. Until then, compensate for this by
applying greater force to the brake pedal. This
also applies when brake pads/linings or
brake discs have been changed.
The first 1,500 km
The more you look after the engine when it is
new, the more satisfied you will be with its
performance in the future.
RTherefore,
drive at varying speeds and
engine speeds for the first 1,500 km.
RAvoid heavy loads on the engine during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RChange gear in good time, at the latest
when the rev counter needle is 2/3 of the
way to the red area in the rev counter display.
RDo not manually shift to a lower gear to
brake the vehicle.
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
RIf
possible, do not depress the accelerator
pedal past the point of resistance (kickdown).
ROnly select shift ranges 3, 2 or 1 when driving slowly, e.g. in mountainous terrain.
After 1,500 km, you may gradually bring the
vehicle up to full road and engine speeds.
Additional running-in notes for AMG vehicles:
Rdo not drive at speeds above 140 km/h for
the first 1,500 km.
allow the engine to reach a maximum
engine speed of 4,500 rpm briefly.
Ronly
i You should also observe these notes on
running in if the engine or parts of the drive
train on your vehicle have been replaced.
AMG vehicles with rear axle locking
differential
Your vehicle is fitted with a self-locking differential on the rear axle. Change the oil after
a running-in period of 3,000 km to improve
protection of the rear axle differential. This oil
change extends the service life of the differential. Have the oil change carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a MercedesBenz Service Centre for this purpose.
Driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Do not place any objects in the driver's footwell. If you use a floormat or carpet in the
driver's footwell, make sure that it is correctly
secured and that there is sufficient clearance
for the pedals.
Do not place several floormats on top of one
another.
Loose objects or the floormats could otherwise get caught between the pedals if you
Driving
Key positions
Key
Driving and parking
accelerate or brake suddenly. You will then
not be able to brake, declutch or accelerate
as intended. This could lead to accidents and
injury.
G WARNING
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid. This could cause you
to lose control of your vehicle and cause an
accident.
! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use
the engine's full performance until it has
reached operating temperature.
Only set the automatic transmission to the
respective drive positions when the vehicle
is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery
roads. Otherwise, you could damage the
drive train.
! AMG vehicles: at low engine oil tempera-
tures (below +20 †), the maximum engine
speed is restricted in order to protect the
engine. To protect the engine and maintain
smooth engine operation, avoid driving at
full throttle when the engine is cold.
137
g To remove the key
1 Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windscreen wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 To start the engine
If the key is at position 0 in the ignition lock
for a longer period, it can no longer be turned
in the ignition lock. The steering is then
locked. To unlock it, remove the key and reinsert it into the ignition lock.
The steering wheel is locked when the key is
removed from the ignition lock.
i If the key does not belong to the vehicle
it can still be turned in the ignition lock.
However, the ignition will not be switched
on The engine cannot be started.
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO are equipped with
a key featuring an integrated KEYLESS-GO
function and a detachable Start/Stop button.
The Start/Stop button must be inserted into
the ignition lock and the key must be in the
vehicle.
Pressing the Start/Stop button several times
in succession corresponds to the different
key positions in the ignition lock. This is only
the case if you are not depressing the brake
pedal.
Z
Driving
138
Driving and parking
If you depress the brake pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately.
X
Position 0: if Start/Stop button : has not
yet been pressed, this corresponds to the
key being removed from the ignition.
X Position 1: press Start/Stop button :.
You can now activate the windscreen wipers, for example.
X
i If you then open the driver's door when in
this position, the power supply is deactivated.
X
Position 2 (ignition): press Start/Stop button : twice.
i If you press Start/Stop button : once
when in this position and the driver's door
is open, the power supply is deactivated
again.
Removing the Start/Stop button
You can remove the Start/Stop button from
the ignition lock and start the vehicle as normal using the key.
i When you insert Start/Stop button :
into ignition lock ;, the system needs
approximately two seconds recognition
time before you can use Start/Stop button :.
Starting the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Never leave the engine running in enclosed
spaces. The exhaust gases contain carbon
monoxide. Inhaling exhaust fumes constitutes a health hazard and could lead to loss
of consciousness or even death.
! Do not depress the accelerator pedal
when starting the engine.
i Vehicles with a petrol engine: the cat-
alytic converter is preheated for up to 30
seconds after a cold start. The sound of the
engine may change during this time.
i You do not have to remove the Start/Stop
button from the ignition lock when you
leave the vehicle.
Remove Start/Stop button : from ignition
lock ;.
Manual transmission
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Fully depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to neutral N.
X
i You can only start the engine when the
clutch pedal is fully depressed.
Automatic transmission
X
the key into the ignition lock. The key must
be in the vehicle and the Start/Stop button
must be inserted in the ignition lock. This
mode for starting the engine operates independently of the ECO start/stop automatic
engine start function.
Shift the transmission to position P.
The transmission position display in the
multifunction display shows P.
i You can also start the engine when the
transmission is in position N.
Starting procedure with the key
i To start the engine using the key instead
of KEYLESS-GO, pull the Start/Stop button
out of the ignition lock.
To start a petrol engine: turn the key to
position 3 in the ignition lock
(Y page 137) and release it as soon as the
engine is running.
X To start a diesel engine: turn the key to
position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 137).
The % preglow indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X When the % preglow indicator lamp
goes out, turn the key to position 3
(Y page 137) and release it as soon as the
engine is running.
X
i You can start the engine without preglow
if the engine is warm.
i Vehicles with automatic transmis-
sion: you can also use the touch-start function. To do this, turn the key to position 3
(Y page 137) and release it immediately.
The engine then starts automatically.
Using KEYLESS-GO to start the engine
G WARNING
Your vehicle can be started using a valid KEYLESS-GO key. For this reason, children should
never be left unsupervised in the vehicle.
Always take the key with you when leaving the
vehicle, even if you are only leaving it for a
short time.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X To start a petrol engine: press the Start/
Stop button (Y page 137) once.
The engine starts.
X To start a diesel engine: press the Start/
Stop button (Y page 137) once.
Preglow is activated and the engine starts.
X
Pulling away
Manual transmission
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Fully depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to either first gear or reverse gear R.
X Release the parking brake (Y page 159).
X Release the brake pedal.
X Slowly release the clutch pedal and gently
depress the accelerator pedal.
X
! Change gear in good time and avoid spin-
ning the wheels. Otherwise, you could damage the vehicle.
i Follow the shift recommendations in the
multifunction display for an economical
driving style (Y page 145).
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 226).
i The Start/Stop button can be used to
start the vehicle manually without inserting
Z
139
Driving and parking
Driving
Driving
Driving and parking
140
Automatic transmission
Hill start assist will not function if:
i It is only possible to shift the transmission
Ryou
from position P to the desired position if
you depress the brake pedal. Only then is
the selector lever lock released.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
X Release the parking brake (Y page 159).
X Release the brake pedal.
X Carefully depress the accelerator pedal.
X
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 226).
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission is in position N.
Rthe parking brake is applied.
RESP® is malfunctioning.
ECO start/stop function
General notes
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle stops
moving.
The engine starts automatically when you pull
away again. The ECO start/stop function
thereby helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and emissions of your vehicle.
i Upshifts take place at higher engine
speeds after a cold start. This helps the
catalytic converter to reach its operating
temperature more quickly.
Hill start assist
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away
forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient.
It holds the vehicle for a short time after you
have removed your foot from the brake pedal.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
and depress it before the vehicle begins to
roll.
G WARNING
Never leave the vehicle when it is held by hill
start assist. After approximately one second,
hill start assist will no longer brake your vehicle and it could roll away.
X
Take your foot off the brake pedal.
i Once you have taken your foot off the
brake pedal, the vehicle is held for around
one second.
X
Pull away.
Example: ECO start/stop display
The ECO start/stop function is activated each
time the engine is switched on. If all conditions for automatic engine switch-off are fulfilled (Y page 141), ECO symbol : is shown
in green in the multifunction display.
If not all conditions are fulfilled, ECO symbol : is shown in yellow.
If the ECO start/stop function is deactivated
(Y page 142), ECO symbol : is not shown.
G WARNING
If the engine is switched off and the ECO symbol is shown in green in the multifunction display, the engine has been switched off auto-
Driving
can be switched off with the ECO button
(Y page 142).
Vehicles with manual transmission
! Always switch the ignition off and take the
key with you when leaving the vehicle.
Automatic engine switch-off
The engine is only switched off if:
Rthe outside temperature is within the range
that is suitable for the system.
engine is at normal operating temperature.
Rthe set temperature for the vehicle interior
has been reached.
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged.
Rthe system detects that the windscreen is
not misted up when the air-conditioning
system is switched on.
Rthe bonnet is closed.
Rthe vehicle is not being steered.
Rthe driver's door is closed and the seat belt
is fastened.
Rthe
i The engine can be switched off automat-
ically a maximum of four times (initial stop
and three repeats) in succession. The ECO
symbol is shown in yellow in the multifunction display after the engine has been started automatically for the fourth time. The
engine can only be switched off automatically again when the ECO symbol is shown
in green in the multifunction display.
i During an automatic engine switch-off, air
The ECO start/stop function switches off the
engine automatically at low speeds.
Brake the vehicle until it comes to a standstill.
X Engage neutral N(Y page 145) (follow
gearshift instruction : to engage neutral
N, if necessary).
X Release the clutch pedal.
The engine is switched off automatically.
X
Vehicles with automatic transmission
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is
braked to a standstill and the brake remains
depressed with the transmission in position
D or N.
i You can still activate HOLD when the vehi-
cle is stationary, even if the engine has
been switched off automatically. It is then
not necessary to continue applying the
brakes during the automatic stop phase.
When you depress the accelerator pedal,
the engine starts automatically and the
braking effect of the HOLD function is deactivated. Depress the accelerator pedal
carefully, as the engine must be started
first.
conditioning is reduced. If full air conditioning is required, the ECO start/stop function
Z
Driving and parking
matically. All of the vehicle's systems remain
active. If you open the door, unfasten your
seat belt or remove your foot from the brake
pedal, the engine will automatically start. The
vehicle may begin moving. You could suffer
serious or even fatal injury or cause an accident resulting in injury or death.
Never leave the vehicle while the ECO symbol
in the multifunction display is shown in green
or yellow. Always secure the vehicle against
rolling away before leaving it.
141
142
Driving
Automatic engine start
The engine is started automatically if:
Rthe
Driving and parking
ECO start/stop function is deactivated
by pressing the ECO button.
Rthe vehicle starts to roll.
Rthe brake system requires this.
Rthe battery's charge status is too low.
Rthe driver's seat belt is removed or the driver's door is opened.
Rthe bonnet is opened.
Ryou shift the transmission from position D
to R.
Ryou steer the vehicle.
Deactivating/activating the ECO start/
stop function
Vehicles with manual transmission
The engine is started automatically if you:
Rdepress
the clutch pedal
Rdepress the accelerator pedal
! Only engage gear when the clutch pedal
is depressed.
Vehicles with automatic transmission
The engine is started automatically if you:
Rrelease
the brakes when in transmission
position D or N, unless the HOLD function
is activated or
Rengage reverse gear R or
Rdepress the accelerator pedal
i Shifting the transmission to position P
does not start the engine.
X
To deactivate: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; and the ECO symbol in
the multifunction display go out.
X
To activate: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up and the ECO
symbol is shown in green in the multifunction display.
If not all conditions are fulfilled, the ECO
symbol is shown in yellow in the multifunction display. If this is the case, the ECO
start/stop function is not available.
If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/stop
function has been deactivated manually or as
the result of a malfunction. The engine will
then not be switched off automatically when
the vehicle stops.
i The ECO start/stop function is activated
each time the engine is switched on.
Driving
143
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start.
The HOLD function or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 177) or DISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 164).
X Try to start the engine again.
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
can be heard.
RThere
is a malfunction in the engine electronics.
is a malfunction in the fuel supply.
X Before attempting to start the engine again, turn the key in the
ignition back to position 0 or press the Start/Stop button
repeatedly until all indicator lamps in the instrument cluster go
out.
X Try to start the engine again (Y page 138). Avoid excessively
long and frequent attempts to start the engine, as this will drain
the battery.
RThere
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
The engine does not
The fuel tank is empty.
start. The starter motor X Refuel the vehicle.
can be heard. The
reserve fuel warning
lamp is lit and the fuel
gauge display shows 0.
The engine does not
start. You cannot hear
the starter motor.
The on-board voltage is too low because the battery is too weak
or discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 329).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high.
X Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two
minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Z
Driving and parking
Problems with the engine
Driving and parking
144
Manual transmission
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Vehicles with a petrol
engine:
The engine is not running smoothly and is
misfiring.
There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or in a mechanical
component of the engine management system.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter and damage it.
The coolant temperaThe coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine
ture display is showing is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
more than 120 †. The X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant
coolant warning lamp
to cool down.
may also be lit and a
X Check the coolant level (Y page 303). Observe the warning
warning tone may
notes as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
sound.
If the coolant level is correct, the engine radiator fan may be faulty.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X At coolant temperatures under 120 †, drive on to the nearest
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. to a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving on
mountain roads and stop/start driving.
Manual transmission
Gear lever
the way to the right. Otherwise, you could
shift unintentionally into 3rd or 4th gear
and damage the transmission.
If you shift down at too high a speed (transmission braking), this can cause the engine
to overrev, leading to engine damage.
Do not use the clutch bite point to keep the
vehicle stationary on uphill gradients.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
clutch.
! On long and steep downhill gradients,
Gear lever
! Only engage gear when the clutch pedal
is depressed.
! When shifting between 5th and 6th gear,
you should always push the gear lever all
especially if the vehicle is laden or towing
a trailer, you must shift into gear 1, 2 or 3
in good time. This uses the engine's braking
effect. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly.
Automatic transmission
145
X
X
X
Depress the clutch pedal fully.
Move the gear lever to position N:.
Neutral N with ECO start/stop function activated
In neutral N, the engine is switched off if the
vehicle speed is below a certain threshold and
the clutch pedal is not depressed.
For further information on the ECO start/stop
function, see (Y page 140).
Engaging reverse gear
! Only shift into reverse gear R when the
vehicle is stationary. Otherwise, you could
damage the transmission.
i The ECO start/stop function is not available when reverse gear is engaged.
For further information on the ECO start/
stop function, see (Y page 140).
X
Move the gear lever firmly to the left
beyond the point of resistance and then
forwards.
Shift recommendation
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style. The recommended gear is shown in the multifunction
display.
Shift gear according to gearshift recommendation : shown in the multifunction
display of the instrument cluster.
Automatic transmission
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The movement of the pedals must not be
impaired in any way. Do not keep any objects
in the driver's footwell. Make sure that floormats or carpets are correctly secured and
that there is sufficient clearance for the pedals.
Do not place several floormats on top of one
another.
G WARNING
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid. This could cause you
to lose control of your vehicle and cause an
accident.
i Bear in mind that the power transmission
between the engine and the transmission
is interrupted when the engine is switched
off. Therefore, to prevent the vehicle from
rolling away, shift the automatic transmission to position P and apply the parking
brake when the engine is switched off and
the vehicle is stationary.
Z
Driving and parking
Shifting to neutral N
146
Automatic transmission
Selector lever
Driving and parking
Overview of transmission positions
Selector lever (example)
P Park position with selector lever lock
R Reverse gear
N Neutral
D Drive
Transmission positions
B
Park position
Prevents the vehicle from rolling
away when stopped. Do not shift
the transmission into position P
(Y page 158) unless the vehicle is
stationary.
The key can only be removed if the
transmission is in position P. If the
key is removed from the ignition
lock, the selector lever is locked.
C
Reverse gear
Only shift the transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
A
Neutral
Do not shift the transmission to N
while driving. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged.
Releasing the brakes will allow you
to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to
push it or tow it.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty:
only shift the transmission to position N if the vehicle is in danger of
skidding, e.g. on icy roads.
Transmission position and drive program display
! Rolling in neutral N can lead to
damage to the transmission.
7
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
Drive
The automatic transmission
changes gear automatically. All
forward gears are available.
Changing gear
The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. This automatic gearshifting behaviour is determined by:
Ra
shift range restriction, if selected
selected drive program (Y page 147)
Rthe
Automatic transmission
position of the accelerator pedal
road speed
Driving tips
Accelerator pedal position
Program selector button
General notes
The program selector button allows you to
choose between different driving characteristics.
Your style of driving influences how the automatic transmission shifts gear:
Rlittle
throttle: early upshifts
throttle: late upshifts
Rmore
AMG vehicles
When shifting down, the double-clutch function is active regardless of the currently selected drive program. The double-clutch function
reduces load change reactions and is conducive to a sporty driving style. The sound generated by the double-clutch function depends
on the drive program selected.
Kickdown
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The automatic transmission shifts back up.
X
Trailer towing
Drive in the middle of the engine speed
range on uphill gradients.
X Shift down to shift range 3 or
2(Y page 149) depending on the uphill or
downhill gradient, even if cruise control or
SPEEDTRONIC is activated.
X
Program selector button (example)
E Economy
Comfortable, economical
driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
i Further information on the automatic
drive program (Y page 148).
X
Press program selector button : repeatedly until the letter for the desired gearshift
program appears in the multifunction display.
i The automatic transmission switches to
automatic drive program E each time the
engine is started.
Z
Driving and parking
Rthe
Rthe
147
Automatic transmission
148
Driving and parking
AMG vehicles
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
Drive program selector with manual drive program
C Controlled
Efficiency
Comfortable, economical
driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
S+ SportPlus
Extremely sporty driving
style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
RS RACE
START
Optimal vehicle acceleration from a standstill
i Further information on the automatic
drive program (Y page 148).
X
Turn drive program selector : until the
desired drive program appears in the multifunction display in the speedometer.
The drive program indicator on drive program selector : lights up in red.
i The automatic transmission switches to
automatic drive program C each time the
engine is started.
i RS cannot be selected during normal driving. For further information on RACE START
(Y page 178).
: Left-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle
; Right-hand steering wheel gearshift pad-
dle
In the automatic drive program, you can
restrict or derestrict the shift range by using
the steering wheel gearshift paddles or the
selector lever (Y page 149).
In the manual drive program, you can change
gear using the steering wheel gearshift paddles or the selector lever (Y page 150).
i You can only change gear with the steer-
ing wheel gearshift paddles when the transmission is in position D.
Automatic drive program
Drive program E (drive program C on AMG
vehicles) is characterised by the following:
Rcomfort-oriented engine and automatic
transmission settings.
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner.
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears, unless the
accelerator pedal is depressed fully.
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example.
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. This results in the vehicle being
driven at lower engine speeds and the
wheels being less likely to spin.
Drive program S (or, in the case of AMG vehicles, drive programs S and S+) is characterised by the following:
engine and automatic transmission
settings
Rthe vehicle pulling away in first gear
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
later
Ras a result of the later automatic transmission shift points, the fuel consumption possibly being higher
X
Rsporty
i If the engine exceeds the maximum
engine speed when shifting down, the automatic transmission protects against engine
damage by not shifting down.
i If the maximum engine speed for the shift
range is reached and you continue to accelerate, the automatic transmission shifts up
in order to prevent the engine from overrevving, even if the shift range is restricted.
Shift ranges
Introduction
When the automatic transmission is in position D, it is possible to restrict or derestrict
the shift range (Y page 149).
The shift range selected is shown in the multifunction display. The automatic transmission shifts only as far as the selected gear.
Derestricting the shift range
X
To use the engine's braking effect.
5
To use the braking effect of the
engine on downhill gradients and
for driving:
Ron
steep mountain roads
mountainous terrain
Rin arduous conditions
Rin
4
To use the braking effect of the
engine on extremely steep downhill
gradients and on long downhill
stretches
Restricting the shift range
X
or
Press the selector lever to the left towards
D–.
Briefly press the selector lever to the right
towards D+.
or
X
Driving situations
=
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
The automatic transmission shifts down
one gear and restricts the shift range to the
relevant gear.
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
The shift range is derestricted.
Clearing the shift range restriction
X
Press and hold the selector lever towards
D+ until D is shown once more in the multifunction display.
or
X
Pull and hold the right-hand steering wheel
gearshift paddle until D is shown again in
the multifunction display.
The automatic transmission shifts from the
current shift range directly to D.
Selecting the ideal shift range
X
Press the selector lever to the left towards
D– and hold it in position.
or
X
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle and hold it in position.
The automatic transmission shifts to the
gear which allows optimum acceleration
Z
149
Driving and parking
Automatic transmission
Automatic transmission
150
Driving and parking
and deceleration. To do this, the automatic
transmission shifts down one or more
gears.
Manual drive program
Switching on the manual drive program
Manual drive program M can be selected
using the program selector or the drive program selector button. In manual drive program M, you can change gear yourself using
the steering wheel gearshift paddles or the
selector lever if the transmission is in position
D.
X Press the program selector button
(Y page 147) repeatedly until M appears in
the multifunction display.
X
AMG vehicles: turn the drive program
selector (Y page 148) until M appears in the
multifunction display.
The indicator M on the drive program selector lights up in red.
Upshifting
X
Briefly press the selector lever to the right
towards D+.
or
X
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 148).
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
X
Downshifting
X
matic transmission does not shift up automatically even when the engine limiting
speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. You must make sure that
the engine speed does not reach the red
area of the rev counter. Otherwise, there is
a risk of engine damage.
Briefly press the selector lever to the left
towards D–.
or
X
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 148).
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
i If you slow down or stop without shifting
down, the automatic transmission automatically shifts down.
i If you desire maximum acceleration, push
the selector lever to the left or pull and hold
the left-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle until the transmission shifts to the optimal gear for the current speed.
Kickdown
i Vehicles with an AMG engine: it is not
possible to use kickdown in manual drive
program M.
You can also use kickdown for maximum
acceleration in manual drive program M.
X
Vehicles with AMG engines
! In manual gearshift program M, the auto-
Shift up a gear if the colour in the multifunction display in the speedometer
changes to red and UP appears in the rev
counter.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
Switching off the manual drive program
Vehicles without the dynamic handling
package with sports mode: press the
program selector button (Y page 147)
repeatedly until E or S appears in the multifunction display.
X Vehicles with the dynamic handling
package with sports mode: press the
program selector button (Y page 147). M
X
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
is no longer shown in the multifunction display.
X AMG vehicles: turn the drive program
selector (Y page 148) until C, S or S+
appears in the multifunction display.
151
Z
Refuelling
152
Problems with the transmission
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The transmission has
The transmission is losing oil.
problems shifting gear. X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, immediately.
The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode.
is deteriorating.
It is only possible to shift into second gear and reverse gear.
The transmission no
X Stop the vehicle.
longer changes gear.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Wait at least 10 seconds before restarting the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
If D is selected, the transmission shifts into second gear; if R is
selected, the transmission shifts into reverse gear.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, immediately.
Releasing the parking lock manually
In the event of an electrical fault, it is possible
to release the selector lever lock manually to
move it out of position P, e.g. if you wish to
tow the vehicle away.
cloth) from the right-hand edge, pulling it
up and out.
X Press release button ; down and simultaneously move the selector lever out of
position P.
The selector lever can now be moved freely
until it is returned to position P.
Refuelling
Important safety notes
! Do not use any sharp-edged objects to lift
up the selector lever cover in the centre
console. Otherwise, the selector lever
cover could be damaged.
X
X
Engage the parking brake.
Prise out selector lever gaiter : with a flat,
blunt object, (e.g. a screwdriver wrapped in
G WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable. Fire, naked flames
and smoking are therefore prohibited when
handling fuels.
Switch off the engine and the auxiliary heating
before refuelling.
G WARNING
Do not come into contact with fuels.
It is hazardous to your health if your skin
comes into direct contact with fuels or you
breathe in fuel vapours.
Refuelling
G WARNING
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel
Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a diesel engine. Do not mix diesel with petrol. This
would result in damage to the fuel system and
engine, which could lead to a vehicle fire.
i If the recommended fuel is not available,
diesel engine. Do not use diesel to refuel
vehicles with a petrol engine. Even small
amounts of the wrong fuel result in damage
to the fuel system and the engine.
! Do not switch on the ignition if you acci-
dentally refuel with the wrong fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel lines. Notify
a qualified specialist workshop and have
the fuel tank and fuel lines drained completely.
Petrol (EN 228, DIN 51626)
can. The fuel lines and/or the diesel injection system could otherwise be blocked by
particles from the fuel can.
but only as a temporary measure, you may
also use regular unleaded petrol,
91 RON/82.5 MON. This may reduce
engine performance and increase fuel consumption. Avoid driving at full throttle.
In some countries, the fuel grade available
may not be adequate and could cause
deposits to build up. In such cases, and in
consultation with a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre, the petrol may be mixed with the
additive recommended by Mercedes-Benz
(part number A000989254510). You must
observe the notes and mixing ratios specified on the container.
Fuel grade
For further information on "Fuel", see
(Y page 354).
! Only refuel using unleaded premium-
AMG vehicles and 12-cylinder engines
grade petrol with at least
95 RON/85 MON, which conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent
specification.
! Do not use the following:
RE85
(petrol with 85% ethanol)
(100% ethanol)
RM15 (petrol with 15% methanol)
RM85 (petrol with 85% methanol)
RM100 (100% methanol)
RDiesel
Do not mix these fuels with petrol, and do
not use any additives. Otherwise, this can
lead to damage to the engine. This does not
include additives for the removal and prevention of residue build-up. Only additives
recommended by Mercedes-Benz may be
added to petrol. More information about
recommended additives can be obtained
from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
RE100
! Only refuel using super-grade unleaded
petrol with at least 98 RON/88 MON,
which conforms to European standard EN
228 or equivalent.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the engine.
i If the recommended fuel is not available
and only as a temporary measure, you may
also use premium-grade unleaded petrol,
95 RON/85 MON. This may reduce engine
performance and increase fuel consumption. Avoid driving at full throttle.
! In emergencies, and only if the recom-
mended fuel is not available, you may also
use standard unleaded petrol, 91 RON/
82.5 MON.
However, using this fuel results in considerably higher petrol consumption and significantly reduced engine performance.
Avoid driving at full throttle.
Z
Driving and parking
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
153
Driving and parking
154
Refuelling
If no fuel other than regular petrol with
91 RON/82.5 MON or a lower grade is permanently available, you should have the
vehicle adapted to run on this fuel in a
qualified specialist workshop. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose.
C 350 BlueEFFICIENCY
! Only refuel using unleaded, sulphur-free
premium-grade petrol with at least
95 RON/85 MON, which conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent
specification.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the emission control system.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Diesel (EN 590)
Fuel grade
! When refuelling, only use diesel fuel that
conforms to the European standard EN 590
or is of equivalent quality. You can otherwise impair engine output or damage the
engine.
! Vehicles with diesel particle filters: in
countries outside the EU, only use low sulphur Euro diesel with a sulphur content of
under 50 ppm. Otherwise, the emission
control system could be damaged.
! Vehicles without a diesel particle fil-
ter: in countries where only diesel fuels
with a higher sulphur content are available,
the vehicle's oil change intervals are
shorter. More information about intervals
for changing the oil can be obtained from
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! Only use fuel that complies with the EN
590 European standard. Fuel that does not
comply with EN 590 can lead to increased
wear, engine damage and damage to the
exhaust system.
Do not use the following:
Rmarine
diesel
oil
Rbio-diesel
Rvegetable oil
Rpetrol
Rparaffin
Rkerosene
Do not mix these fuels with diesel fuels and
do not use any special additives. Otherwise, this can lead to damage to the engine.
This excludes flow improver; see "Low outside temperatures".
Rheating
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel
can. Otherwise, the fuel lines and/or the
diesel injection system could be blocked by
particles from the fuel can.
For further information on "Fuel", see
(Y page 354).
Low outside temperatures
Diesel fuel with improved cold flow qualities
is available during the winter months. In
Europe, various climate-dependent low-temperature classes are defined in EN 590. Refuelling with diesel fuel which complies with the
climatic specifications of standard EN 590
can help to prevent operating problems. At
exceptionally low temperatures, it is possible
that the flow properties of the fuel may be
inadequate. This also applies to fuel that has
not been adapted to suit the climatic conditions, e.g. diesel fuel from warmer regions.
i Further information about country-spe-
cific fuel properties can be obtained from
oil companies, e.g. at filling stations.
Refuelling
155
Flow improvers can be added to improve the
cold resistance of diesel fuel. The effectiveness of a flow improver is not guaranteed with
every fuel.
Correct dosage and thorough mixing are decisive factors in ensuring improvement in lowtemperature resistance. Under certain circumstances, an excessive dosage may
actually decrease low-temperature resistance and should therefore be avoided. Follow
the manufacturer's dosing instructions.
Mix the additive with the diesel in good time,
before the flow properties of the diesel
become inadequate. Malfunctions can otherwise only be rectified by heating the entire
fuel system, e.g. by parking the vehicle in a
heated garage.
Observe the information provided by the manufacturer when using a flow improver. Only
use flow improvers that have been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. You can obtain
further information from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Refuelling
Fuel filler flap
The fuel filler flap is unlocked or locked automatically when you open or close the vehicle
with the key or using KEYLESS-GO.
The position of the fuel filler cap is displayed
in the instrument cluster 8. The arrow
next to the filling pump indicates the side of
the vehicle.
Driving and parking
Flow improver
: To open the fuel filler flap
; To insert the fuel filler cap
= Tyre pressure table
? Fuel type
Opening
X
Switch off the engine.
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
KEYLESS-GO: open the driver's door. This
switches the ignition to position 0, which
corresponds to having removed the key.
The driver's door can be closed again.
X Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap opens slightly.
X Open the fuel filler flap.
X Turn the fuel filler cap anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder
bracket on the inside of filler flap ;.
X Completely insert the pump nozzle into the
filler neck and refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
X
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
Closing
Replace the fuel filler cap and turn it clockwise. The fuel filler cap audibly engages.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
X
Z
156
Refuelling
i Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
Driving and parking
vehicle. A locking pin otherwise prevents
the fuel filler flap from closing after the
vehicle has been locked.
Refuelling
157
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Fuel is leaking from the
vehicle.
The engine does not
start.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of explosion or fire
The fuel line or the fuel tank is faulty.
X Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 137) in the ignition lock
immediately and remove it.
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The fuel tank of a vehicle with a diesel engine has been run completely dry.
X Refuel the vehicle with at least five litres of diesel.
X Turn the ignition on for at least 10 seconds (Y page 137).
X Start the engine continuously for up to 10 seconds until it runs
smoothly.
If the engine does not start:
X Turn the ignition on again for approximately 10 seconds
(Y page 137).
X Start the engine again continuously for up to 10 seconds until
it runs smoothly.
If the engine does not start after three attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The fuel filler flap cannot be opened.
The fuel filler flap is not unlocked.
or
The key battery is discharged.
X Unlock the vehicle (Y page 78).
or
X Unlock the vehicle using the emergency key element
(Y page 80).
The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is jammed.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
158
Parking
Parking
Driving and parking
Important safety notes
Therefore, do not switch off the engine while
you are driving.
G WARNING
Vehicles with manual transmission
Only remove the key from the ignition lock
when the vehicle is stationary, as you cannot
steer the vehicle when the key is removed.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. They could release the parking brake. This
could lead to a serious or fatal accident.
Shift to either first gear or reverse gear R.
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X Apply the parking brake firmly.
G WARNING
Vehicles with automatic transmission
Under no circumstances should the exhaust
system come into contact with flammable
materials such as dry grass or petrol, for
example. Do not park the vehicle on dry grassland or harvested grain fields. The hot exhaust
system could otherwise ignite the flammable
material and set the vehicle on fire.
X
To ensure that the vehicle is secured against
rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe
parking brake must be applied.
Ron vehicles with manual transmission,
engage first gear or reverse gear.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission must be in position P and
the key must be removed from the ignition
lock.
Ron steep uphill or downhill gradients, turn
the front wheels towards the kerb.
Switching off the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the engine is not running, there is no power
assistance for the steering and brakes. Steering and braking then requires significantly
greater effort.
As a result, you might lose control of the vehicle, cause an accident and injure yourself and
others.
X
X
X
Apply the parking brake firmly.
Shift the transmission to position P.
Using the key
X
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
i The key can only be removed if the transmission is in position P.
Using KEYLESS-GO
Press the Start/Stop button (Y page 137).
The engine stops and all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster go out.
i When the driver's door is closed, this corresponds to key position 1. When the driver's door is open, this corresponds to key
position 0, i.e. key removed.
X
i The engine can be turned off while the
vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding
the Start/Stop button for three seconds.
This function operates independently of the
ECO start/stop automatic engine switchoff function.
Driving tips
Parking brake
159
Driving tips
General driving tips
G WARNING
To apply: depress parking brake ; firmly.
The J indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up if the engine is running.
X To release: depress the brake pedal and
keep it depressed.
X Pull release handle :.
The J indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
X
Parking up the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than four weeks, the battery may be damaged
by exhaustive discharge.
X Disconnect the battery (Y page 327) or
connect it to a trickle charger.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than six weeks, the vehicle may suffer damage as a result of lack of use.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
Never switch the engine off while the vehicle
is in motion.
There is no power assistance for the steering
and the service brake when the engine is not
running.
You will require considerably more effort to
steer and brake, and you could therefore lose
control of the vehicle and cause an accident.
Engine oil
! Vehicles with a diesel particle filter:
If the vehicle is mostly driven for short distances, it is possible that malfunctions may
occur during the automatic cleaning of the
diesel particle filter. This can lead to engine
damage. Therefore, if you frequently drive
short distances, make sure to drive on
motorways or country roads for 20 minutes
at least every 500 km.
Brakes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
G WARNING
Make sure that other road users are not
endangered by your braking.
Downhill gradients
On long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden or towing a trailer,
you must shift to a lower gear in good time or,
Z
Driving and parking
Rolling with the engine switched off
160
Driving tips
on vehicles with automatic transmission,
select shift range 1, 2 or 3.
Driving and parking
i This also applies if you have activated
cruise control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC PLUS.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
the speed. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly.
Heavy and light loads
G WARNING
Never depress the brake pedal continuously
while the vehicle is in motion, e.g. never cause
the brakes to rub by applying constant slight
pedal pressure. This causes the brake system
to overheat, increases the braking distance
and can lead to the brakes failing completely.
If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy
load, do not stop the vehicle immediately, but
drive on for a short while. This allows the airflow to cool the brakes more quickly.
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness. To do this, brake more firmly from a
higher speed. This improves the grip of the
brakes.
Wet road surface
If driving in heavy rain for a prolonged period
of time without braking, there may be a
delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first time. This may also occur after
the vehicle has been washed.
You have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance from the
vehicle in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying attention to the traffic conditions. This will warm
up the brake discs, thereby drying them more
quickly and protecting them against corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salt
treated roads
G WARNING
The layer of salt on the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings may cause a delay in the
braking effect, resulting in a significantly longer braking distance, which could lead to an
accident.
To avoid this danger, you should:
Roccasionally brake carefully, without putting other road users at risk, when you are
driving on salted roads. This helps to
remove any salt that may have started to
build up on the brake discs and the brake
pads/linings.
Rmaintain a greater distance to the vehicle
ahead and drive with particular care.
Rcarefully apply the brakes at the end of a
trip and immediately after commencing a
new trip, so that salt residues are removed
from the brake discs.
New brake pads/linings
G WARNING
New brake pads/linings only reach their optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Before this optimum braking effect is reached, you should compensate
for the reduced braking effect by applying
greater pressure when braking. This also
applies after the brake discs or the brake
pads/linings have been replaced.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings
fitted to your vehicle which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which correspond to an equivalent quality
standard. Brake pads/linings which have not
been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which are not of an equivalent quality could
affect your vehicle's operating safety.
Driving tips
The high-performance brake system is
designed for heavy loads. This may lead to
noise when braking. This will depend on:
Rspeed
Rbraking
force
Renvironmental conditions, such as temperature and humidity
The wear of individual components of the
brake system, such as the brake pads/linings
or brake discs, depends on the individual driving style and operating conditions.
For this reason, it is impossible to state a
mileage that will be valid under all circumstances. An aggressive driving style will lead
to high wear. You can obtain further information about this from your Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Tyre traction
G WARNING
Whereas the vehicle can be fully controlled at
a certain speed on dry roads, you must reduce
your speed on wet or icy roads to achieve the
same road safety. You could otherwise cause
an accident.
Pay particular attention to the road conditions
at temperatures around freezing point.
If ice has formed on the road surface (e.g.
from fog), a thin film of water rapidly forms on
the ice when you brake, considerably reducing tyre traction. Drive with particular care in
such weather conditions.
Driving on wet roads
Aquaplaning
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou
drive at low speeds
tyres have adequate tread depth
For this reason, do not drive in tyre ruts, and
brake carefully.
Rthe
Driving on flooded roads
If you have to drive on stretches of road on
which water has collected, please bear in
mind that:
Rthe maximum permitted still water depth is
25 cm.
should drive no faster than at walking
pace.
Ryou
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in
front or in the opposite direction create
waves. This may cause the maximum permissible water depth to be exceeded.
These notes must be observed under all
circumstances. You could otherwise damage the engine, the electronics or the transmission.
Winter driving
General notes
G WARNING
If the vehicle becomes trapped in snow,
ensure that snow is kept away from the
exhaust pipe and from around the vehicle as
long as the engine is running. Otherwise, poisonous carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the
vehicle, resulting in loss of consciousness and
even death.
To assure sufficient fresh air ventilation, open
a window slightly on the side of the vehicle
not facing the wind.
Z
Driving and parking
High-performance brake system for
AMG vehicles
161
Driving systems
Driving and parking
162
At the onset of winter, have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 337).
Driving with summer tyres
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 337).
Slippery road surfaces
G WARNING
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking manoeuvres.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
Vehicles with manual transmission: engage
neutral.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift
the transmission to position N.
X Try to bring the vehicle under control by
using corrective steering.
X
i For more information on driving with
snow chains, see (Y page 338).
Driving systems
Cruise control
Important safety notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. It brakes automatically in order
to avoid exceeding the set speed. On long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden or towing a trailer, you must
shift to a lower gear in good time or select
shift range 1, 2 or 3 on vehicles with automatic transmission. By doing so, you will
make use of the braking effect of the engine,
which relieves the load on the brake system
and prevents the brakes from overheating
and wearing too quickly.
G WARNING
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions make it appropriate to maintain a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
store any road speed above 30 km/h.
G WARNING
Cruise control cannot take account of road
and traffic conditions.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions
even when cruise control is activated.
Cruise control is only an aid designed to assist
driving. You are responsible for the vehicle's
speed and for braking in good time.
G WARNING
Do not use cruise control
Rin traffic conditions that do not allow you to
drive at a constant speed (e.g. heavy traffic
or winding roads). You may otherwise
cause an accident.
Ron slippery roads. The drive wheels may
lose their grip when braking or accelerating
and the vehicle may skid.
Rwhen there is low visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow.
Cruise control lever
You can operate cruise control and variable
SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control lever.
Driving systems
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control is
selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
: To store the current speed or a higher
;
=
?
A
B
speed
LIM indicator lamp
To store the current speed or call up the
last stored speed
To store the current speed or a lower
speed
To switch between cruise control and variable SPEEDTRONIC
To deactivate cruise control
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display
for five seconds. Vehicles with the 4-button
multifunction steering wheel: the stored
speed is then permanently displayed in the
status indicator together with the ¯ symbol. Vehicles with the 12-button multifunction steering wheel: the segments from the
stored speed up to the maximum speed light
up in the multifunction display.
Selecting cruise control
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp ; is off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
You can store the current speed if you are
driving faster than 30 km/h.
X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever
up : or down ? to the pressure point.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the stored speed.
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by
automatically applying the brakes.
i Vehicles with manual transmission:
Ralways
drive at adequate, but not excessive, engine speeds.
Rchange gear in good time.
Rif possible, do not change down several
gears at a time.
Storing the current speed or calling up
the last stored speed
G WARNING
Only call up a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and if it is suitable for the current
traffic and driving situation. You can otherwise endanger yourself or others by unintentionally triggering sudden acceleration or
braking.
Z
Driving and parking
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
163
Driving systems
164
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously
stored speed.
Driving and parking
X
Setting a speed
Press the cruise control lever to the pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down ? for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
X
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake,
cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Making adjustments in 1 km/h increments
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever to the
pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down ? for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Making adjustments in 10 km/h increments
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever
beyond the pressure point, up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Deactivating cruise control
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards B.
or
X
Brake.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou
depress the parking brake.
are driving at less than 30 km/h.
RESP® intervenes or if you deactivate ESP®.
Ryou shift into neutral in a vehicle with manual transmission while driving or depress
the clutch pedal for longer than six seconds.
Ron vehicles with manual transmission, you
shift to a gear that is too high and as a result
the engine speed is too low.
Ron vehicles with automatic transmission,
you shift into position N while driving.
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear
a warning tone. You will see the Cruise
control off message in the multifunction
display for approximately five seconds.
Ryou
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
DISTRONIC PLUS
Important safety notes
DISTRONIC PLUS regulates the speed and
automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. It
brakes automatically in order to avoid
exceeding the set speed.
Driving systems
G WARNING
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS is only an aid designed to
assist driving. The driver remains fully responsible for the vehicle's distance from other
vehicles, the vehicle's speed and for braking
in good time.
DISTRONIC PLUS does not react in particular
to:
Rpedestrians
Rstationary obstacles on the road, e.g. stop-
ped or parked vehicles
and crossing traffic
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect narrow vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or vehicles driving on a different line. Therefore,
always pay attention to traffic conditions even
when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in
time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
Roncoming
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take account of road
and traffic conditions. If DISTRONIC does not
recognise or no longer recognises the vehicle
in front, do not activate DISTRONIC or, if it is
already active, deactivate it. This is especially
the case:
Rbefore
corners
filter lanes
Rwhen changing to a lane with faster moving
traffic
Rin complex driving situations or where lanes
are diverted, e.g. at roadworks on a motorway
DISTRONIC PLUS otherwise maintains the
current speed set by you or accelerates up to
the set speed.
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take account of
weather conditions. Deactivate, or do not
activate, DISTRONIC PLUS:
Ron
Rif
the roads are slippery, snow-covered or
icy. The wheels could lose their grip when
braking or accelerating. The vehicle could
start to skid.
Rif the sensors are dirty or there is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow, rain or fog. Distance control may be impaired.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions
even when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers
in time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
! You must deactivate the radar sensor system in certain countries and near radio
telescope facilities. You will find further
information under "Radar sensor system"
in the index.
The radar sensor system is automatically
deactivated near radio telescope facilities
(Y page 363).
If you want DISTRONIC PLUS to assist you,
the radar sensor system must be activated
(Y page 226) and operational.
Z
Driving and parking
On long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden or towing a trailer,
you must select shift range 1, 2 or 3 in good
time. By doing so, you will make use of the
braking effect of the engine, which relieves
the load on the brake system and prevents
the brakes from overheating and wearing too
quickly.
If a slower-moving vehicle is detected in front,
DISTRONIC PLUS causes your vehicle to
brake and maintain a preset distance to the
vehicle in front.
165
Driving and parking
166
Driving systems
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control in the speed range between
30 km/h and 200 km/h. If a vehicle is driving
in front of you, DISTRONIC operates in the
speed range between 0 km/h and
200 km/h.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS while driving on
roads with steep gradients.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS brakes your vehicle up to a
maximum of 4 m/s2 depending on its speed.
This corresponds to approximately 40% of
your vehicle's maximum braking power. You
must also apply the brakes yourself if this
braking power is not sufficient.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a risk of collision
with a vehicle in front, an intermittent warning
tone sounds. In addition, the · distance
warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights
up. Brake to avoid a collision.
Cruise control lever
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: DISTRONIC PLUS
is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; To set the specified minimum distance
= LIM indicator lamp
? To store the current speed or call up the
last stored speed
A To store the current speed or a lower
speed
B To switch between DISTRONIC PLUS and
variable SPEEDTRONIC
C To deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
Selecting DISTRONIC PLUS
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp = is off.
If it is off, DISTRONIC PLUS is already selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow B.
LIM indicator lamp = in the cruise control
lever goes out. DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Switching on DISTRONIC PLUS, storing
the current speed and maintaining it
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The vehicle can be braked when DISTRONIC
PLUS is activated. For this reason, deactivate
DISTRONIC PLUS if the vehicle is to be set in
motion by other means (e.g. in a car wash or
by towing).
Driving systems
vehicle in front will then not be maintained.
You will be driving at the speed you determine by the position of the accelerator
pedal.
Rfor vehicles not equipped with a navigation
system, the Becker® MAP PILOT must be
connected. See the separate Audio 20
operating instructions.
Rthe engine must be running. It may take up
to two minutes of driving before DISTRONIC PLUS is ready for use.
Rthe parking brake is not applied.
RESP® is activated.
Rthe transmission is in position D.
Rthe bonnet is closed.
Rthe driver's door must be closed when you
shift from P to D or your seat belt must be
fastened.
Rthe front passenger door is closed.
Rthe vehicle is not skidding.
Activating while driving
When driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you
can only activate DISTRONIC PLUS if the vehicle in front has been detected and is shown
in the multifunction display. If the vehicle in
front is not shown in the multifunction display
and is no longer being detected, for example
because it has changed lanes, DISTRONIC
PLUS is deactivated and a tone sounds.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ? or press it up : or down A to the
pressure point.
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed
up : or down A until the desired speed
is set.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the
vehicle in front, but only up to the desired
stored speed.
i If you do not fully release the accelerator
pedal, the DISTRONIC PLUS suspended
message appears in the multifunction display. The set distance to a slower-moving
Activating when driving towards a stationary vehicle
If the vehicle in front of you is stationary, you
can only activate DISTRONIC PLUS once your
vehicle is stationary as well.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ? or press it up : or down A to the
pressure point.
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
i DISTRONIC PLUS can only be activated at
under 30 km/h if a vehicle in front has been
detected. Therefore, the DISTRONIC PLUS
distance display in the instrument cluster
should be activated (Y page 221).
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed
up : or down A until the desired speed
is set.
i You can use the cruise control lever to set
the stored speed and the control on the
cruise control lever to set the specified
minimum distance (Y page 170).
Pulling away
X If the vehicle in front pulls away: remove
your foot from the brake pedal.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
or
X
Accelerate briefly.
Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its
speed to that of the vehicle in front.
Driving
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control.
If a slower-moving vehicle is detected in front,
DISTRONIC PLUS causes your vehicle to
brake and maintain a preset distance to the
vehicle in front.
Z
Driving and parking
To activate the DISTRONIC PLUS, the following conditions must be fulfilled:
167
168
Driving systems
Driving and parking
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a faster-moving
vehicle in front, it increases the driving speed,
but only up to the desired speed you have
stored.
G WARNING
If you depress the brake, DISTRONIC PLUS is
deactivated unless your vehicle is stationary.
DISTRONIC PLUS then no longer brakes your
vehicle. In such cases, control the distance
from vehicles travelling in front with the brake
alone. You could otherwise cause an accident
and thereby injure yourself and others. The
driver remains fully responsible for the vehicle's distance from other vehicles, the speed
being driven and for braking in good time.
Changing lanes
If you wish to change to the passing lane (in
countries where traffic drives on the right, the
passing lane is the left-hand lane), DISTRONIC PLUS supports you if:
are driving faster than 60 km/h.
PLUS is maintaining the distance to a vehicle in front.
Ryou switch on the appropriate turn signals.
RDISTRONIC PLUS does not detect a danger
of collision.
If these conditions are met, your vehicle is
accelerated. Acceleration will be interrupted
if changing lanes takes too long or if the distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front becomes too small.
Vehicles with COMAND Online
i The following function is not operational
in all countries.
DISTRONIC PLUS uses additional information
from your navigation system so that it can
react appropriately to certain traffic situations. This is the case if, while following a
vehicle, DISTRONIC PLUS is active and you:
Rapproach
or drive through a roundabout
a T junction
Rturn off at a motorway exit
Even if the vehicle in front leaves the detection range, DISTRONIC PLUS temporarily
maintains the current driving speed and does
not accelerate. This is based on the current
map data in the navigation system.
Rapproach
Ryou
RDISTRONIC
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS and Active Blind Spot Assist
are only an aid designed to assist driving.
They do not relieve you of the responsibility
of paying attention. The driver remains fully
responsible for the vehicle's distance from
other vehicles, the vehicle's speed and for
braking in good time. Always pay attention to
traffic conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in
time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
Example: roundabout
The current speed is maintained:
Rapproximately
10 seconds before the
roundabout/T junction and for approximately 1.5 seconds when driving on the
roundabout
Rapproximately 12 seconds before reaching
a motorway exit and approximately 4 seconds after the motorway exit
Afterwards, the vehicle accelerates back to
the set speed you specified.
Stopping
G WARNING
Never get out of the vehicle when DISTRONIC
PLUS is activated.
X
Move the selector lever to P to prevent the
vehicle from rolling away.
DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated. The warning message in the multifunction display
disappears.
DISTRONIC PLUS must also never be operated, activated or deactivated by a passenger
or from outside the vehicle.
DISTRONIC PLUS does not replace the parking brake and must not be used for parking.
The DISTRONIC PLUS braking effect is cancelled and the vehicle can start moving if:
The horn will also sound at regular intervals if
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated and you:
RDISTRONIC
Rswitch
PLUS is deactivated using the
cruise control lever.
Ryou accelerate.
Rthere is a malfunction in the system or an
interruption in the power supply, e.g. battery failure.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
If you wish to leave the vehicle or park it,
deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS and secure the
vehicle against rolling away.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle
in front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle until
it is stationary.
Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains
stationary and you do not need to depress the
brake.
i Depending on the specified minimum dis-
tance, your vehicle will come to a standstill
at a sufficient distance behind the vehicle
in front. The specified minimum distance is
set using the control on the cruise control
lever.
You will see a warning message in the multifunction display if DISTRONIC PLUS is activated and:
Rthe
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened.
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
Rthe bonnet is opened.
Select Park (P)
the engine off, open the driver's
door and take off your seat belt
Ropen the bonnet
The sounding of the horn alerts you to the fact
that the vehicle has been parked while DISTRONIC PLUS is still activated. The sound
becomes louder if you attempt to lock the
vehicle. The vehicle is not locked until DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
i If the engine has been switched off, it
cannot be started again until DISTRONIC
PLUS has been deactivated.
If DISTRONIC PLUS is activated and a fault
occurs in the system or if there is a disruption
in the power supply, the Brake immedi‐
ately message is shown in the multifunction
display. Immediately depress the brake firmly
until the warning message in the multifunction display goes out or shift the transmission
to position P. DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
Setting a speed
Press the cruise control lever to the pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down A for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored. DISTRONIC PLUS
is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the new speed stored.
X
Z
169
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
170
Making adjustments in 1 km/h increments
Driving and parking
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever to the
pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down A for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Making adjustments in 10 km/h increments
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever
beyond the pressure point, up : for a
higher speed or down A for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Storing the current speed or calling up
the stored speed
G WARNING
Only call up a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and if it is suitable for the current
traffic and driving situation. You can otherwise endanger yourself or others by unintentionally triggering sudden acceleration or
braking.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. The first
time it is activated, the current speed is
stored. Otherwise, it sets the vehicle cruise
speed to the previously stored value.
X
To increase: turn control ; in direction
=.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a greater
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X To decrease: turn control ; in direction :.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a shorter
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X
i Make sure that you maintain a sufficient
and safe distance from the vehicle in front.
Adjust the distance to the vehicle in front if
necessary.
DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the speedometer
Setting the specified minimum distance
You can set the specified minimum distance
for DISTRONIC PLUS by varying the time span
between one and two seconds. With this function, you can set the minimum distance that
DISTRONIC PLUS keeps to the vehicle in
front, dependent on vehicle speed. You can
see this distance in the multifunction display
(Y page 171).
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, one or
two segments ; in the set speed range light
up.
i For design reasons, the speed displayed
in the speedometer may differ slightly from
the speed set for DISTRONIC PLUS.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front,
segments ; between speed of the vehicle in
front : and stored speed = light up.
DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the multifunction display
General notes
In the Assistance menu (Y page 220) of the
on-board computer, you can select the distance display and activate or deactivate PRESAFE® Brake.
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
X Select the Distance display function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 221).
When DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you
will see the following in the multifunction display:
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
X Select the Distance display function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 221).
You will see the stored speed for about five
seconds when you activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
After this time, you will see the following in
the multifunction display while DISTRONIC
PLUS is activated:
: DISTRONIC PLUS activated
; Own vehicle
= Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
? Vehicle in front, if detected
Deactivating DISTRONIC PLUS
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
: Symbol for activated PRE-SAFE® Brake
; Vehicle in front, if detected
= Distance indicator: current distance to
the vehicle in front
? Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
A Own vehicle
There are several ways to deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X
Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary.
Z
171
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
172
or
Driving and parking
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
If you deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS, the DIS‐
TRONIC PLUS off message is shown in the
multifunction display for approximately five
seconds.
i The last speed stored remains stored until
you switch off the engine.
i DISTRONIC PLUS is not deactivated if you
away. DISTRONIC PLUS is then deactivated,
and the message disappears.
Tips for driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
General notes
The following contains descriptions of certain
road and traffic conditions in which you must
be particularly attentive. In such situations,
brake if necessary. DISTRONIC PLUS is then
deactivated.
Cornering, going into and coming out of a
bend
depress the accelerator pedal. If you accelerate to overtake, DISTRONIC PLUS
adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last
speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
DISTRONIC PLUS is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou
apply the parking brake.
are driving slower than 25 km/h and
there is no vehicle in front, or if the vehicle
in front is no longer detected.
RESP® intervenes or if you deactivate ESP®.
Rthe transmission is in the P, R or N position.
Rthe vehicle is near a radio telescope facility
(Y page 363).
Ryou switch off the radar sensor system
(Y page 226).
Ryou pull the cruise control lever towards
you in order to pull away and the frontpassenger door is open.
Rthe vehicle has skidded.
If DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you will
hear a warning tone. The DISTRONIC PLUS
off message is shown in the multifunction
display for approximately five seconds.
If the vehicle has been stopped by DISTRONIC
PLUS and a fault occurs in the system, the
Brake immediately message appears in the
multifunction. Depress the brake pedal
immediately so that the vehicle does not roll
Ryou
The ability of DISTRONIC PLUS to detect vehicles when cornering is limited. Your vehicle
may brake unexpectedly or late.
Vehicles travelling on a different line
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect vehicles
travelling on a different line. The distance to
the vehicle in front will be too short.
Driving systems
Other vehicles changing lane
173
detected vehicle turns a corner and reveals
an obstacle or stationary vehicle, DISTRONIC
PLUS will not brake for these.
Driving and parking
Crossing vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS has not detected the vehicle cutting in yet. The distance to this vehicle
will be too short.
Narrow vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS may detect vehicles that
are crossing your lane by mistake. Activating
DISTRONIC PLUS at traffic lights with crossing traffic, for example, could cause your vehicle to pull away unintentionally.
SPEEDTRONIC
Important safety notes
DISTRONIC PLUS has not yet detected the
vehicle in front on the edge of the carriageway, because of its narrow width. The distance to the vehicle in front will be too short.
Obstructions and stationary vehicles
SPEEDTRONIC brakes automatically so that
you do not exceed the set speed. On long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden or towing a trailer, you must
shift to a lower gear in good time or select
shift range 1, 2 or 3 on vehicles with automatic transmission. By doing so, you will
make use of the braking effect of the engine,
which relieves the load on the brake system
and prevents the brakes from overheating
and wearing too quickly. If you need additional braking, depress the brake pedal
repeatedly rather than continuously.
G WARNING
DISTRONIC PLUS does not brake for obstacles or stationary vehicles. If, for example, the
Never depress the brake pedal continuously
while the vehicle is in motion, e.g. never cause
the brakes to rub by applying constant slight
pedal pressure. This causes the brake system
to overheat, increases the braking distance
and can lead to the brakes failing completely.
Z
174
Driving systems
Driving and parking
G WARNING
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
You can set a variable or permanent limit
speed:
Rvariable
for speed limits, e.g. in built-up
areas
Rpermanent for long-term speed restrictions, e.g. when driving with winter tyres
fitted (Y page 176)
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; LIM indicator lamp
G WARNING
= To store the current speed or to call up
Speedtronic is only an aid designed to assist
driving. You are responsible for the vehicle's
speed and for braking in good time.
? To store the current speed or a lower
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
may differ slightly from the limit speed
stored.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
General notes
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control or
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
the last stored speed
speed
A To switch between cruise control and var-
iable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC
Selecting variable SPEEDTRONIC
X Check whether LIM indicator lamp ; is on.
If it is on, variable SPEEDTRONIC is already
selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever lights up. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
selected.
G WARNING
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the limit speed stored.
Only use variable SPEEDTRONIC if you will not
have to accelerate suddenly to a speed above
that stored as the limit speed. You could otherwise cause an accident.
You can only exceed the limit speed stored if
you deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC:
Rusing
the cruise control lever
depressing the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown)
Rby
It is not possible to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC by braking.
Storing the current speed
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever to the
pressure point up : or down ?.
The current speed is stored. For five seconds, the multifunction display shows the
stored speed, e.g. Limit 100 km/h.
Vehicles with the 4-button multifunction
steering wheel: the stored speed is permanently displayed in the status indicator,
e.g. LIM 100 km/h.
Vehicles with a 12-button multifunction
steering wheel: on the speedometer, the
segments from the start of the scale up to
the stored speed are lit up.
Storing the current speed or calling up the
last stored speed
G WARNING
Only select a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and whether it is suitable for the
current driving and traffic situation. Otherwise, sudden braking could endanger you or
others.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
Making adjustments in 10 km/h increments
X Briefly press the cruise control lever
beyond the pressure point, up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
or
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed
beyond the pressure point until the desired
speed is set. Press the cruise control lever
up : for a higher speed or down ? for a
lower speed.
Making adjustments in 1 km/h increments
X Briefly press the cruise control lever to the
pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down ? for a lower speed.
or
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press the cruise control lever up : for
a higher speed or down ? for a lower
speed.
Deactivating variable SPEEDTRONIC
There are several ways to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards B.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
deactivated.
Cruise control is selected.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is automatically
deactivated:
Rwhen
you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown), but
only if your current speed does not differ by
more than 20 km/h from the stored speed.
You will hear a warning tone if this is the
case.
Ron vehicles with manual transmission, if
you shift to a higher gear and as a result the
engine speed is too low.
G WARNING
It is not possible to deactivate variable Speedtronic by braking.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Z
175
Driving and parking
Driving systems
176
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can use the on-board computer to limit
the speed permanently to a value between
160 km/h (e.g. for driving on winter tyres)
and the maximum speed (Y page 225).
Shortly before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multifunction display.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC remains active,
even if variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated.
You cannot exceed the stored limit speed,
even if you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
Dynamic handling package with
sports mode
General notes
The most important part of the dynamic handling package with sports mode is the adjustable suspension system. This automatically
controls and adapts the suspension to the
respective driving situation.
The calibration of the suspension depends
on:
Ryour
driving style
road surface conditions
Ryour individual selection; see the following
description
If your vehicle is equipped with automatic
transmission, the dynamic handling package
with sports mode also includes steering
wheel gearshift paddles (Y page 148) with a
manual drive program (Y page 150).
Rthe
Example: position of dynamic handling package
with sports mode button
X
Start the engine.
Sports tuning
The firmer setting of the suspension tuning in
sports mode ensures even better contact
with the road. Select this mode when employing a sporty driving style, e.g. on winding
country roads.
Your selection remains stored until you
switch off the engine.
X Press button ;.
Indicator lamp : lights up. Sports suspension tuning is selected. Depending on the
engine output, the accelerator pedal is
more responsive. On vehicles with automatic transmission, drive program S is
selected.
Comfort tuning
In comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select
this mode if you prefer a more comfortable
driving style, but also when driving fast on
straight roads, e.g. motorways.
X Press button ;.
Indicator lamp : goes out. Comfortable
suspension tuning is selected. On vehicles
with automatic transmission, drive program E is selected.
HOLD function
General notes
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
X
Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until HOLD display : appears in the multifunction display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
pulling away, especially on steep
slopes
Rwhen manoeuvring on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
The vehicle is kept stationary without the
driver having to depress the brake pedal.
The braking effect is cancelled and the HOLD
function is deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
i If depressing the brake pedal the first
Activation conditions
Deactivating the HOLD function
You can activate the HOLD function if:
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically if:
Rwhen
Rthe
vehicle is stationary.
Rthe engine is running or if it has been automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
Rthe driver's door is closed or if your seat
belt is fastened.
Rthe parking brake is not applied.
Rthe bonnet is closed.
Rthe selector lever is in position D, R or N on
vehicles with automatic transmission.
RDISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
Activating the HOLD function
Make sure that the activation conditions
are met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X
time does not activate the HOLD function,
wait briefly and then try again.
G WARNING
The vehicle's brakes are applied when the
HOLD function is activated. For this reason,
deactivate the HOLD function if the vehicle is
to be set in motion by other means (e.g. in a
car wash or by towing).
Ryou accelerate. The transmission is in posi-
tion D or R on vehicles with automatic
transmission.
Rthe transmission is in position P on vehicles
with automatic transmission.
Ryou apply the brakes again with a certain
amount of pressure until HOLD disappears
from the multifunction display.
Ryou activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
G WARNING
Never get out of the vehicle when the HOLD
function is activated.
The HOLD function must never be operated
or deactivated by a passenger or from outside
the vehicle.
The HOLD function does not replace the parking brake and must not be used for parking.
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
Z
177
Driving and parking
Driving systems
178
Driving systems
The braking effect of the HOLD function is
cancelled and the vehicle could roll away if:
Driving and parking
Rthe
HOLD function is deactivated by
depressing the accelerator pedal or the
brake pedal.
Rthere is a malfunction in the system or an
interruption in the power supply, e.g. battery failure.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
If you leave the vehicle or park it, deactivate
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
against rolling away.
You will see a warning message in the multifunction display if the HOLD function is activated and:
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened.
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
Rthe bonnet is opened.
For vehicles with manual transmission:
Brake immediately
X Immediately depress the brake pedal firmly
until the warning message in the multifunction display goes out. This deactivates the
HOLD function.
The sounding of the horn alerts you to the fact
that the vehicle has been parked while the
HOLD function is still activated. The tone
becomes louder if you attempt to lock the
vehicle. The vehicle is not locked until the
HOLD function is deactivated.
i If the engine has been switched off, it
cannot be started again until the HOLD
function has been deactivated.
If there is a fault in the system or power supply
while the HOLD function is activated, the
Brake immediately message is shown in
the multifunction display. Immediately
depress the brake firmly until the warning
message in the multifunction display goes
out.
On vehicles with automatic transmission, you
can also shift into position P. This deactivates
the HOLD function.
Rthe
On vehicles with automatic transmission:
Select Park (P)
X Move the selector lever to P to prevent the
vehicle from rolling away.
The HOLD function is deactivated. The
warning message in the multifunction display disappears.
A horn will also sound at regular intervals if
the HOLD function is activated and you:
Rswitch
the engine off, open the driver's
door and take off your seat belt
Ropen the bonnet
RACE START
Important safety notes
i RACE START is only available in AMG vehicles.
RACE START enables optimal acceleration
from a standing start. The precondition for
this is a suitable high-grip road surface.
G WARNING
RACE START is only available when SPORT
handling mode is activated. SPORT handling
mode will only be able to stabilise the vehicle
to a limited degree if the vehicle starts to skid
or a wheel starts to spin. The vehicle is therefore harder to control at the threshold range.
You could lose control of the vehicle and
cause an accident.
RACE START should only be used on closed
off circuits. Always adapt your driving style to
suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
Driving systems
RACE START can be activated when:
Rthe
doors are closed.
Rthe engine is running and it has reached an
operating temperature of approximately
80 †. This is the case when the engine oil
temperature in the multifunction display
stops flashing.
RSPORT handling mode is activated.
(Y page 69)
Rthe steering wheel is in the straight-ahead
position.
Rthe vehicle is stationary and the brake
pedal is depressed (left foot).
Rthe transmission is in position D.
Activating RACE START
Depress the brake pedal with your left foot,
and keep it depressed.
X Turn the drive program selector clockwise
(Y page 147) until the RS lamp lights up.
The multifunction display shows the RACE
START Confirm: Paddle UP Cancel:
Paddle DOWN message.
i If the conditions for activation are no longer fulfilled, RACE START is cancelled. The
multifunction display shows the RACE
START cancelled message.
X
X
To cancel: pull the left steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 148).
or
To confirm: pull the right steering wheel
shift paddle (Y page 148).
The multifunction display shows the RACE
START available Depress accelera‐
tor message.
i If you do not depress the accelerator
pedal fully within two seconds, RACE
START is cancelled. The multifunction display shows the RACE START not possi‐
ble See Owner's Manual message.
X
Depress the accelerator pedal fully.
The engine speed rises to approximately
4000 rpm.
The multifunction display shows the RACE
START Release brake to start message.
i If you do not release the brake pedal
within seven seconds, RACE START is cancelled. The multifunction display shows the
RACE START cancelled message.
X
X
Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
The multifunction display shows the RACE
START active message.
RACE START is deactivated when the vehicle
reaches a speed of approximately 50 km/h.
Drive program S+ is activated. SPORT handling mode remains activated.
RACE START is deactivated immediately if
you release the accelerator pedal during
RACE START or if any of the activation conditions are no longer fulfilled. The multifunction
display shows the RACE START not possi‐
ble See Owner's Manual message.
i If RACE START is used repeatedly in a
short period of time, it is only available
again after having driven the vehicle a certain distance.
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
G WARNING
PARKTRONIC is only an aid and may not
detect all obstacles. It is not a substitute for
attentive driving.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. You could otherwise endanger
yourself and others.
Z
Driving and parking
Conditions for activation
179
180
Driving systems
G WARNING
Driving and parking
Make sure that no persons or animals are in
the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It indicates visually and
audibly the distance between your vehicle
and an object.
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically when
you:
Rswitch
on the ignition
Rshift to position D, R or N on vehicles with
automatic transmission
Rrelease the parking brake
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower speeds.
PARKTRONIC monitors the area around your
vehicle using six sensors in the front bumper
and four sensors in the rear bumper.
Side view
Top view
Front sensors
Centre
approximately 100 cm
Corners
approximately 60 cm
Rear sensors
: Sensors in the front bumper, left-hand
side (example)
Range of the sensors
General notes
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and
slush; otherwise, they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 309).
Centre
approximately 120 cm
Corners
approximately 80 cm
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer drawbars. PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects when
they are in the immediate vicinity of the
vehicle. You could damage the vehicle or
the objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and
objects which absorb ultrasonic sources.
Ultrasonic sources, such as an automatic
car wash, a lorry's compressed-air brakes
or a pneumatic drill, could cause PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
Driving systems
Minimum distance
Centre
approximately 20 cm
Corners
approximately 15 cm
If there is an obstacle within this range, the
relevant warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below
the minimum, the distance may no longer be
shown.
Warning displays
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located
on the dashboard above the centre air vents.
The warning display for the rear area is located on the roof lining in the rear compartment.
the direction in which the vehicle is rolling
determine which warning display is active
when the engine is running.
Manual transmission:
Gear lever position
Warning display
Forwards gear
or
Neutral
Front area activated
Reverse gear, or
Rear and front areas
the vehicle is rolling activated
backwards
Automatic transmission:
Transmission
position
Warning display
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle
is rolling backwards
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
From the:
Rsixth
Warning display for the front area
: Segments on the left-hand side of the
vehicle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the
vehicle
= Segments showing operational readiness
segment onwards, you will hear an
intermittent warning tone for approximately two seconds.
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately two seconds. This indicates that you have now
reached the minimum distance.
The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow
segments showing operational readiness =
light up.
The gear lever position or the transmission
position of the automatic transmission and
Z
Driving and parking
PARKTRONIC may not function correctly on
uneven terrain.
181
182
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
: Indicator lamp
; To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC
If indicator lamp : lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated. Parking Guidance is also deactivated.
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Trailer towing
PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area
when you establish an electrical connection
between your vehicle and a trailer.
! Fold in the ball coupling if the trailer tow
hitch is not required. PARKTRONIC measures the minimum detection range to an
obstacle from the bumper, not the ball coupling.
Driving systems
183
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has switched off.
in the PARKTRONIC
X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified
warning displays are lit.
specialist workshop.
You also hear a warning
tone for approximately
two seconds.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approximately 20 seconds,
and the indicator lamp
in the PARKTRONIC
button lights up.
Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
in the PARKTRONIC
X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 309).
warning displays are lit. X
Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approxThe problem may be caused by an external source of radio or
imately 20 seconds.
ultrasound waves.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Parking Guidance
Important safety notes
Parking Guidance is an electronic parking aid
with ultrasound. Ultrasound is used to measure the road on both sides of the vehicle. A
suitable parking space is indicated by the
parking symbol. You receive steering instructions when parking. You may also use PARKTRONIC (Y page 179).
G WARNING
Parking Guidance is merely an aid and may
recommend parking spaces that are not suitable for parking. For example, these might be
spaces where parking is prohibited, driveways, unsuitable surfaces, etc.
Parking Guidance measures the parking
space as you drive past it. Any later changes
to the parking space are not taken into
account. For instance, this may be the case
when the vehicle parked in front of or behind
the space changes its position or when an
obstacle is moved into the parking space.
Parking Guidance does not relieve you of the
responsibility for paying attention. If you rely
solely on Parking Guidance, you could cause
an accident and injure yourself and others.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring.
G WARNING
Objects located above the height range of
Parking Guidance will not be detected when
the parking space is measured. These are not
taken into account when the parking procedure is calculated, e.g. overhanging loads, tail
sections or loading ramps of goods vehicles.
In some circumstances, Parking Guidance
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
184
Driving systems
Driving and parking
might therefore issue steering instructions
too soon. This may lead to a collision. For this
reason, you should avoid using Parking Guidance in such situations.
G WARNING
Make sure that no persons or animals are in
the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
lead you across or onto the kerb. If necessary, cancel the parking procedure with
Parking Guidance.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over
obstacles such as kerbs slowly and not at
a sharp angle. Otherwise, you may damage
the wheels or tyres.
Detecting parking spaces
When PARKTRONIC is deactivated, Parking
Guidance is also unavailable.
Use Parking Guidance for parking spaces:
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
are on straight roads, not bends
Rthat are on the same level as the road, i.e.
not on the pavement, for example. Parking
Guidance may not detect flat kerbs
Parking tips:
; Parking symbol
Ron
= Detected parking space on the right
Rthat
narrow roads, drive past the parking
space as close as possible.
Rparking spaces that are littered, overgrown
or partially occupied by trailer drawbars
might be identified incorrectly or not at all.
Rsnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately.
Rpay attention to the PARKTRONIC
(Y page 181) warning messages during the
parking procedure.
Rwhen transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle, you must not use Parking
Guidance.
Rnever use Parking Guidance with snow
chains or an emergency spare wheel fitted.
Rmake sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct. This has a direct effect on
the steering instructions.
Rthe way your vehicle is positioned in the
parking space after parking is dependent
on various factors. These include the position and shape of the vehicles parked in
front and behind it and the conditions of the
location. In some cases, Parking Guidance
may guide you too far or not far enough into
a parking space. In some cases, it may also
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
: Detected parking space on the left
Parking Guidance is automatically activated
when you drive forwards. The system is
operational at speeds of up to approximately
35 km/h. While in operation, the system independently locates and measures parking
spaces on both sides of the vehicle. When
driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you will see
parking symbol ; as a status indicator in the
instrument cluster.
When a parking space has been detected, an
arrow towards the right = or the left : also
appears. Parking Guidance only displays
parking spaces on the front-passenger side
as standard. Parking spaces on the driver's
side are displayed as soon as the turn signal
on the driver's side is activated. To park on
the driver's side, you must leave the driver's
side turn signal switched on until you have
engaged reverse gear.
Driving systems
185
Parking Guidance will only detect parking
spaces:
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
are at least 1.5 m wide
Rthat are at least 1.3 m longer than your
vehicle
A parking space is displayed while you are
driving past it, and until you are approximately 15 m away from it.
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
X
Parking
G WARNING
PARKTRONIC and Parking Guidance are
merely parking aids and may not detect all
obstacles. They do not relieve you of the
responsibility of paying attention.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. You could otherwise endanger
yourself and others.
Stop the vehicle when the parking space
symbol shows the desired parking space in
the instrument cluster.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: shift to
reverse gear.
Vehicles with automatic transmission: shift
into position R.
The following message appears in the multifunction display: Check vehicle sur‐
roundings Confirm with OK.
X Press the a button on the multifunction
steering wheel to confirm.
The multifunction display switches to Parking Guidance.
Depending on your distance from the parking space, the Please drive backwards
message appears in the multifunction display.
If necessary, reverse towards the parking
space. This is indicated by an arrow pointing backwards.
Continue reversing until you hear a tone.
Stop – the parking position has been
reached. The arrow is white.
The Please steer to the right or
Please steer to the left message
appears in the multifunction display.
X
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
While the vehicle is stationary, turn the
steering wheel in the specified direction
until the arrow is white and a warning tone
sounds.
X To reverse into the parking space: maintain the steering wheel angle and reverse
carefully.
X Stop as soon as you hear a warning tone,
The vehicle has reached the position in
which you need to countersteer.
The Please steer to the left or
Please steer to the right message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Countersteering: while the vehicle is stationary, turn the steering wheel in the
specified direction until the arrow is white
and a warning tone sounds.
X
Z
Driving and parking
Rthat
Driving systems
186
To reverse into the parking space: maintain the steering wheel angle and reverse
carefully.
X Stop as soon as you hear a warning tone,
at the latest when PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone.
The Parking Guidance finished message appears in the multifunction display
and a warning tone sounds. You may be
asked to steer in a different direction and
then change gear. In this case, further displays in the multifunction display will direct
you to the final position.
Driving and parking
X
X
X
Manoeuvre if necessary.
Always observe the warning messages displayed by PARKTRONIC (Y page 181).
Reversing camera
Important safety notes
The reversing camera is an optical parking
aid. It shows the area behind your vehicle in
the COMAND Online display.
G WARNING
Make sure that no persons or animals are in
the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
The reversing camera is located in the handle
strip of the boot lid.
Cancelling Parking Guidance
X
Press the PARKTRONIC button on the
centre console (Y page 182).
Parking Guidance is cancelled immediately
and PARKTRONIC is deactivated.
Parking Guidance is cancelled automatically
if it is no longer possible to guide you into the
parking space, or if a malfunction occurs.
The parking space symbol goes out and a
warning tone sounds. The Parking Guid‐
ance cancelled message appears in the
multifunction display.
Trailer towing
For vehicles with a trailer tow hitch, the minimum length for parking spaces is slightly
increased.
If you have attached a trailer to your vehicle,
you should not use Parking Guidance. When
the electrical connection is established
between your vehicle and the trailer, Parking
Guidance ceases to be available. PARKTRONIC is deactivated for the rear area.
: Reversing camera
View through the camera
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
G WARNING
The reversing camera is only an aid and may
display obstacles in a distorted or incorrect
manner, or may not even display them at all.
The reversing camera does not relieve you of
the responsibility to pay attention. The camera cannot show objects:
Rvery near to the rear bumper
Rbelow the rear bumper
Rin the area immediately above the boot lid
handle
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. This applies to the areas
Driving systems
G WARNING
Under the following circumstances, the
reversing camera will not function, or will
function in a limited manner:
Rif
the boot lid is open
heavy rain, snow or fog
Rat night or in very dark places
Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light
Rif the area is lit by fluorescent light (the display may flicker)
Rif there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage in
winter
Rif the camera lens is dirty or obstructed
Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
event, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this
purpose.
Do not use the reversing camera in these
types of situation. You could otherwise injure
others or damage objects and your vehicle
while you are parking.
Rin
Activating the reversing camera
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the "Reversing camera"
function is selected in COMAND Online
(see the separate operating instructions for
COMAND Online).
X Engage reverse gear.
The area behind the vehicle is shown in the
COMAND Online display with guide lines.
X
Guide lines in the COMAND Online display
Depending on the date of manufacture of the
vehicle, the guide lines are shown in the
COMAND Online display.
G WARNING
Using the reversing camera can be dangerous
if you are colour blind or if your ability to distinguish colours is impaired.
Only use the reversing camera if you can see
and distinguish between all the coloured
guide lines that are displayed by the reversing
camera in the COMAND Online display.
G WARNING
Please note that objects not at ground level
may appear to be further away than they
actually are. These include:
Rthe
bumper of a vehicle that is parked
behind your vehicle
Ra trailer drawbar
Rthe ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
Rthe tail-end of a lorry
Rslanted posts
The lines are only guides, not accurate measurements of the distance to an obstacle.
Therefore, you should never pass the red line
when approaching an obstacle. You could otherwise cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
Example: information in the COMAND Online display
Z
Driving and parking
behind, in front of and next to the vehicle. You
could otherwise endanger yourself and others.
187
Driving and parking
188
Driving systems
Guide lines ; and = show the approximate
distance to the rear area. Yellow guide
line ; indicates a distance of approximately
1.0 m and red guide line = indicates a distance of approximately 0.25 m. The distances
only apply to objects that are at ground level.
Blue guide lines : depict the width required
for the vehicle. They are used to align the
vehicle with the edge of the carriageway, e.g.
the kerb.
ATTENTION ASSIST
Important safety notes
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys such as on motorways
and trunk roads. It is active in the 80 km/h
to 180 km/h range.
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration on the part of the driver, it suggests taking a break.
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted and warnings may be delayed or
not occur at all:
Rif
the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface is uneven or if there are potholes
Rif there is a strong side wind
Rif you have adopted a sporty driving style
with high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
Rif you are predominantly driving slower
than 80 km/h or faster than 180 km/h
Rif you are currently using COMAND Online
or making a telephone call with it
Rif the time has been set incorrectly
Rin active driving situations, such as when
you change lanes or change your speed
Warning and display messages in the
multifunction display
G WARNING
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid and may
detect your tiredness or lapses in concentration too late or not at all. It is not a substitute
for a well rested and attentive driver.
Fatigue may cause you to recognise hazardous situations too late, misjudge a situation
or react slower. For this reason, make sure
you feel rested before you begin driving and
during your journey. Always take breaks in
good time and regularly, especially during
long journeys. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in time, cause an accident and
injure yourself and others.
ATTENTION ASSIST assesses your level of
fatigue or lapses in concentration by taking
the following criteria into account:
Ryour
personal driving style, e.g. steering
characteristics
Rdriving conditions, e.g. time, driving time
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
X
Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 222).
Symbol : appears in the multifunction
display.
If ATTENTION ASSIST is active, you will be
warned no sooner than 20 minutes after your
journey has begun. You will then hear an
intermittent warning tone twice, and the
Attention Assist: Drowsiness detec‐
ted message appears in the multifunction
display.
X If necessary, take a break.
X Press the a button to confirm the message.
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good
time to allow yourself to rest properly. If you
do not take a break and ATTENTION ASSIST
Driving systems
Ryou
switch off the engine.
take off your seat belt and open the
driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or
to take a break.
Ryou
Speed Limit Assist
Important safety notes
i Speed Limit Assist is not operational in all
countries.
Speed Limit Assist shows you detected speed
limits in the multifunction display. Data from
the navigation system is also used for this
purpose. The display appears if a traffic sign
indicating a speed limit or the end of a speed
limit is detected. If Speed Limit Assist does
not detect any traffic signs, the speed limit
from the digital road map is taken and shown
in the display.
Speed Limit Assist detects the traffic signs
with a camera at the top of the windscreen.
: Speed Limit Assist camera
G WARNING
Speed Limit Assist is only an aid and may
detect speed limit signs incorrectly or not at
all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray.
Rthere is glare, e.g. from the sun or from
oncoming traffic.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera.
Rthe traffic signs are covered, for instance
by dirt, snow or trees.
Rthe traffic signs are poorly illuminated.
Rthere are ambiguous traffic signs, for
instance near roadworks or on multi-lane
roads.
Traffic signs always have priority over the
Speed Limit Assist display. Speed Limit Assist
cannot detect road and traffic conditions. It is
not a substitute for attentive driving.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
Information in the multifunction display
Example: vehicles featuring automatic transmission with a selector lever
: Traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit
; Speed Limit Assist is available and the
warning function is switched on in the onboard computer
= Units used in the traffic sign displayed
Z
Driving and parking
still detects typical indicators of fatigue or
increasing lapses in concentration, you will be
warned again after 15 minutes at the earliest.
ATTENTION ASSIST is reset when you continue your journey and it starts assessing your
tiredness again if:
189
Driving and parking
190
Driving systems
Briefly showing detected traffic signs in
the multifunction display
When you activate the Speed Limit Assist
warning function, a traffic sign indicating the
speed limit or end of speed limit zone : may
appear in the multifunction display. The traffic
sign appears for approximately five seconds
as soon as it is detected. Any other information in the multifunction display is hidden for
this period.
X Activate the Speed Limit Assist warning
function using the on-board computer
(Y page 220).
Symbol ; appears.
Permanently showing detected traffic
signs in the multifunction display
If Speed Limit Assist is selected in the onboard computer, a traffic sign indicating the
speed limit or end of a speed limit zone :
appears in the multifunction display as soon
as it is detected.
Traffic sign indicating a speed limit : is generally displayed until:
Ra traffic sign indicating the end of the speed
limit is detected.
make a turn.
Ryou leave or enter a city or town.
Rthe road type changes (e.g. motorway,
country road).
Ryou have travelled a certain minimum distance without the traffic sign being repeated or detected again.
X Display Speed Limit Assist using the onboard computer (Y page 220).
Ryou
i You can also activate Speed Limit Assist
on COMAND Online. The maximum permissible speed is then displayed in the
COMAND Online display; see the COMAND
Online operating instructions.
Lane Tracking package
General notes
The Lane Tracking package consists of Blind
Spot Assist (Y page 190) and Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 192).
Blind Spot Assist
Important safety notes
Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor system
to monitor the areas on both sides of your
vehicle. Blind Spot Assist provides assistance
at speeds higher than 30 km/h. A warning
display in the exterior mirrors draws your
attention to detected vehicles in the monitored area. If you then switch on the corresponding turn signal to change lane, you will
also receive a visual and acoustic collision
warning. The Blind Spot Assist monitoring
system uses sensors in the rear bumper.
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist is only an aid designed to
assist driving. It may fail to detect some vehicles and is no substitute for attentive driving.
Blind Spot Assist cannot detect road and traffic conditions. It may fail to detect narrow
vehicles, such as motorcycles or bicycles, or
only detect them too late.
Monitoring may be affected by dirty sensors,
strong spray or poor visibility caused by snow,
rain or mist, for example. In this case, vehicles
are detected late or not at all.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
The radar sensor system is automatically
deactivated near radio telescope facilities
(Y page 363).
For Blind Spot Assist to assist you when driving, the radar sensor system must be activated (Y page 226) and operational.
Driving systems
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist monitors certain areas in the
immediate vicinity of your vehicle. Vehicles
that approach and drive past at high speeds
are not detected. There is no display and no
warning.
If the lanes are very wide, it may not be possible to monitor the complete width of the
neighbouring lane. For this reason, vehicles in
the next lane may not be detected, especially
if they are driving in a staggered formation in
different lanes. This may be the case if vehicles are driving at the edge of their lane that
is furthest away from your vehicle.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
If the lanes are narrow, the system may be
unable to distinguish the neighbouring lane
from the one beyond it. For this reason, vehicles in the farther lane may be indicated,
especially if the vehicles are driving in a staggered formation in different lanes. In particular, this may be the case if the vehicles are
driving at the edge of their lane nearest your
vehicle.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders.
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside particularly long vehicles, for
example lorries, for a prolonged time.
The two sensors for Blind Spot Assist are
integrated into the sides of the rear bumper.
Make sure that the bumper is free of dirt, ice
or slush around the sensors. For example, the
radar sensors must not be covered by cycle
racks or overhanging loads. Following a
severe impact or in the event of damage to
the bumpers, have the function of the radar
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre. Blind Spot Assist may otherwise not
work properly.
Indicator and warning display
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
If Blind Spot Assist is switched on, indicator
lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights up yellow up to a speed of 30 km/h. At speeds
above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp goes out
and Blind Spot Assist is operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up in red. This warning is
always emitted when a vehicle enters the
blind spot monitoring range from behind or
Z
Driving and parking
Monitoring range of the sensors
Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up to
three metres behind your vehicle and directly
next to your vehicle, as shown in the diagram.
191
Driving and parking
192
Driving systems
from the side. When you overtake a vehicle,
the warning only occurs if the difference in
speed is less than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Blind Spot Assist is then
deactivated.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds below
30 km/h, and the indicator lamps in the exterior mirrors are yellow. Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not indicated.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
Collision warning
If a vehicle is detected in the monitoring range
of Blind Spot Assist and you switch on the turn
signal, a double warning tone sounds. Red
warning lamp : flashes. If the turn signal
remains on, detected vehicles are indicated
by the flashing of red warning lamp :. There
are no further warning tones.
Switching on Blind Spot Assist
X On vehicles without a navigation system,
make sure that the Becker® MAP PILOT is
connected; see the separate operating
instructions for Audio 20.
X Make sure that the radar sensor system
(Y page 226) and Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 222) are activated in the on-board
computer.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : light up red in the exterior mirrors for approximately 1.5 seconds
and then turn yellow.
Trailer towing
If you attach a trailer, make sure you have
correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking
the trailer lighting. In this event, Blind Spot
Assist is deactivated. The indicator lamp in
the exterior mirrors lights up yellow, and the
Blind Spot Assist currently unavail‐
able See Owner's Manual message
appears in the multifunction display.
i You can deactivate the indicator lamps in
the exterior mirrors.
To do so, switch off Blind Spot Assist if:
Rthe
key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Rthe engine is not running.
Rthe electrical connection to the trailer
has been established.
Lane Keeping Assist
Important safety notes
Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of a camera at
the top of the windscreen. Lane Keeping
Assist detects lane markings on the road and
warns you before you leave your lane unintentionally.
: Lane Keeping Assist camera
If you have chosen the Display unit
Speed-/odometer:(Y page 223) function in
the on-board computer and select kmkm as
the unit of measurement, Active Lane Keeping Assist is active from speeds of 60 km/h.
If the miles display unit is selected, the assistance range begins at 40 mph.
G WARNING
Lane Keeping Assist does not keep your vehicle in its lane. It is only an aid and may detect
the lane markings on the road incorrectly or
not at all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray.
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun, or reflection from other vehicles.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera
Rseveral or no lane markings for a single lane
are present.
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow.
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected.
Rthe lane markings on the road are unclear,
e.g. near roadworks.
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge.
Rthe road is narrow and winding.
Lane Keeping Assist cannot detect road and
traffic conditions. It is not a substitute for
attentive driving. You are responsible for the
vehicle's speed, braking in good time, and
steering correctly. Always adapt your driving
style to suit the prevailing road and weather
conditions. Always pay attention to traffic
conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise,
you may fail to recognise dangers in time,
cause an accident and injure yourself and others.
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you
by means of intermittent vibration in the
steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend.
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway.
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings.
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
road has narrow lanes.
cut the corner on a bend.
No warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou
Ryou
clearly and actively steer, brake, or
accelerate.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this event, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Activating Lane Keeping Assist
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
X
Activate Lane Keeping Assist using the onboard computer (Y page 222).
Symbol : appears in the multifunction
display.
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, symbol : is
displayed in green. Lane Keeping Assist is
ready for use.
Z
193
Driving and parking
Driving systems
194
Driving systems
Active Driving Assistance package
Driving and parking
General notes
The Active Driving Assistance package consists of DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 164), Active
Blind Spot Assist (Y page 194) and Active
Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 197).
Active Blind Spot Assist
Important safety notes
Active Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor
system to monitor the side areas of your vehicle that are behind the driver. A warning display in the exterior mirrors draws your attention to detected vehicles in the monitored
area. If you then switch on the corresponding
turn signal to change lane, you will also
receive a visual and acoustic collision warning. If a risk of lateral collision is detected,
corrective braking may help you avoid a collision. To support the course-correcting brake
application, Active Blind Spot Assist also uses
the forward-facing radar sensor system.
Active Blind Spot Assist provides assistance
at speeds higher than about 30 km/h.
style to suit the prevailing road and weather
conditions. Always pay attention to traffic
conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise,
you may fail to recognise dangers in time,
cause an accident and injure yourself and others.
The radar sensor system is automatically
deactivated near radio telescope facilities
(Y page 363).
For Active Blind Spot Assist to assist you
when driving, the radar sensor system must
be activated (Y page 226) and operational.
Monitoring range
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up
to three metres behind your vehicle and
directly next to your vehicle, as shown in the
diagram. For this purpose, Active Blind Spot
Assist uses radar sensors in the rear bumper.
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid and may
detect vehicles/obstacles incorrectly or not
at all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray.
Rthe rear and/or front sensors are dirty.
Active Blind Spot Assist may not detect narrow vehicles, such as motorcycles or bicycles,
or only detect them too late. It cannot detect
vehicles which are overtaken at a small distance and then enter the blind spot area.
Active Blind Spot Assist cannot detect road
and traffic conditions. It is not a substitute for
attentive driving. You are responsible for the
vehicle's speed, braking in good time, and
steering correctly. Always adapt your driving
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors certain
areas in the immediate vicinity of your vehicle.
Vehicles that approach and drive past at high
speeds are not detected. No visual nor audible warnings are emitted and the system does
not brake the vehicle to correct your course.
If the lanes are very wide, it may not be possible to monitor the complete width of the
neighbouring lane. For this reason, vehicles in
Driving systems
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may
be the case if the vehicles are driving on the
inner side of their lane.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders.
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside particularly long vehicles, for
example lorries, for a prolonged time.
Two Active Blind Spot Assist radar sensors
are integrated into the front and rear bumpers
respectively. An additional radar sensor is
located behind the cover in the radiator grille.
Make sure that the bumpers are free of dirt,
ice or slush around the sensors. The rear sensors must not be covered, for example by
cycle racks or overhanging loads. Following a
severe impact or in the event of damage to
the bumpers, have the function of the radar
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre. Active Blind Spot Assist may otherwise fail to work correctly.
Indicator and warning display
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
When Active Blind Spot Assist is activated,
indicator lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights
up in yellow at speeds of up to 30 km/h. At
speeds above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp
goes out and Active Blind Spot Assist is
operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. This warning is
always emitted when a vehicle enters the
blind spot monitoring range from behind or
from the side. When you overtake a vehicle,
the warning only occurs if the difference in
speed is less than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Active Blind Spot Assist is
then no longer active.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds
below 30 km/h. The indicator lamps in the
exterior mirrors are yellow. Vehicles in the
monitoring range are then not indicated.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
Z
Driving and parking
the next lane may not be detected, especially
if they are driving in a staggered formation.
This may be the case if vehicles are driving at
the edge of their lane that is furthest away
from your vehicle.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
195
Driving and parking
196
Driving systems
Visual and acoustic collision warning
If you switch on the appropriate turn signals
to change lanes, and a vehicle is detected in
the side monitoring range of Active Blind Spot
Assist, you will receive a visual and acoustic
collision warning. You will then hear a double
warning tone, and red warning lamp :
flashes. If the turn signal remains on, detected vehicles are indicated by the flashing of
red warning lamp :. There are no further
warning tones.
Course-correcting brake application
If Active Blind Spot Assist detects a risk of a
lateral collision in the monitoring range, a
course-correcting brake application is carried
out. This is designed to help you avoid a collision.
The course-correcting brake application is
available in the range between 30 km/h and
200 km/h.
If a course-correcting brake application
occurs, red warning lamp : flashes in the
exterior mirror and the following is shown in
the multifunction display, for example:
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
G WARNING
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid
designed to assist driving. It is not a substitute
for attentive driving. Automatic braking by the
system may not always be sufficient to avoid
a collision. In such cases, you need to steer,
brake or accelerate yourself.
In very rare cases, the system may detect a
risk of collision where there is none and brake
in error near crash barriers or similar road
boundaries. Active Blind Spot Assist cannot
detect all traffic situations and road users.
Ensure at all times that there is sufficient lat-
eral distance between you and other road
users or obstacles. You can, for example,
countersteer gently or depress the accelerator pedal at any time to cancel inappropriate
braking action.
You are responsible for the vehicle's speed,
correct steering and for braking in good time.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
prevailing road and weather conditions.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
Either a very slight course-correcting brake
application, or none at all, may occur if:
Rthere
are vehicles or obstacles, e.g. crash
barriers, on both sides of your vehicle.
Ra vehicle approaches too closely on the
side.
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds.
Ryou brake or accelerate decisively.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP® or PRE-SAFE® Brake.
RESP® is deactivated.
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre is
detected.
Activating Active Blind Spot Assist
X On vehicles without a navigation system,
make sure that the Becker® MAP PILOT is
connected; see the separate operating
instructions for Audio 20.
X Make sure that the radar sensor system
(Y page 226) and Active Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 222) are activated in the on-board
computer.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : light up red in the exterior mirrors for approximately 1.5 seconds
and then turn yellow.
Driving systems
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Important safety notes
Active Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area
in front of your vehicle by means of a camera
at the top of the windscreen. Active Lane
Keeping Assist detects lane markings on the
road and warns you before you leave your
lane unintentionally. If you do not react to the
warning, a lane-correcting application of the
brakes can bring the vehicle back into the
original lane.
: Active Lane Keeping Assist camera
If you have selected the Display unit
Speed-/odometer:(Y page 223) function in
the on-board computer and select kmkm as
the unit of measurement, Active Lane Keeping Assist is active from speeds of 60 km/h.
If the miles display unit is selected, the assistance range begins at 40 mph.
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not keep
your vehicle in its lane. It is only an aid and
may detect the lane markings on the road
incorrectly or not at all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rseveral or no lane markings for a single lane
are present.
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray.
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun, or reflection from other vehicles.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera.
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow.
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected.
Rthe lane markings on the road are unclear,
e.g. near roadworks.
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge.
Rthe road is narrow and winding.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot detect
road and traffic conditions. It is not a substitute for attentive driving. You are responsible
for the vehicle's speed, braking in good time,
and steering correctly. Always adapt your
driving style to suit the prevailing road and
weather conditions. Always pay attention to
traffic conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in
time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
Rthere
Warning vibration in the steering wheel
A warning may be given if a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. You will be
warned by way of intermittent vibrations in
the steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
Z
Driving and parking
Trailer towing
If you attach a trailer, make sure you have
correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking
the trailer lighting. Active Blind Spot Assist is
then deactivated. The indicator lamp in the
exterior mirrors lights up yellow, and the
Active Blind Spot Assist currently
unavailable See Owner's Manual message appears in the multifunction display.
197
198
Driving systems
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Driving and parking
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend.
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway.
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings.
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
road has narrow lanes.
Ryou cut the corner on a bend.
No warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou
clearly and actively steer, brake, or
accelerate.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou have switched on the turn signals. In
this event, the warnings are suppressed for
a certain period of time.
Lane-correcting brake application
If you leave your lane under certain circumstances, the vehicle will brake briefly on one
side. This is designed to help you bring the
vehicle back into the original lane.
This function is available in the range between
60 km/h and 200 km/h.
A lane-correcting brake application can only
be made after driving over a solid, recognisable lane marking. Before this, a warning
must be emitted by means of intermittent
vibration in the steering wheel. In addition, a
lane with lane markings on both sides must
be recognised. The brake application also
slightly reduces driving speed.
If a lane-correcting brake application occurs,
the following message appears in the multifunction display:
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
i A further lane-correcting brake applica-
tion can only occur after your vehicle has
returned to the original lane.
G WARNING
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not keep
your vehicle in its lane. It is only an aid
designed to assist driving. It is not a substitute
for attentive driving. Corrective braking may
not always be sufficient to return your vehicle
to its original lane. In such cases, you must
steer the vehicle yourself to ensure that it
does not leave the lane.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot detect the
current traffic situation or other road users.
Ensure at all times that there is sufficient lateral distance between you and other road
users or obstacles. In rare cases, broken lines
or certain structures on the road surface may
be detected by the system as solid lane markings. You can, for example, countersteer gently at any time to cancel inappropriate braking
action, e.g. if you intentionally drive across a
solid lane marking.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot take
weather conditions into account.
You are responsible for the vehicle's speed,
correct steering and for braking in good time.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
prevailing road and weather conditions.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
No lane-correcting brake application occurs
if:
Ryou
clearly and actively steer, brake, or
accelerate.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
Ryou have switched on the turn signals.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist.
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration.
Ron vehicles with a trailer tow hitch, the
electrical connection to the trailer has been
correctly established.
RESP® is deactivated.
Rthe transmission is not in position D.
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre
has been detected and displayed.
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not detect
road and traffic conditions. An inappropriate
brake application may be interrupted at any
time if:
Ryou
steer slightly in the opposite direction.
use a turn signal.
Ryou clearly brake or accelerate.
A lane-correcting brake application is interrupted automatically if:
Ryou
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist.
Rlane markings can no longer be recognised.
Activating Active Lane Keeping Assist
Example: vehicles with automatic transmission
X
Activate Active Lane Keeping Assist using
the on-board computer (Y page 222).
Symbol : appears in the multifunction
display.
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, symbol : is
displayed in green. Active Lane Keeping
Assist is ready for use.
Trailer towing
If you attach a trailer, make sure you have
correctly established the electrical connection. This can be accomplished by checking
the trailer lighting.
Trailer towing
Notes on towing a trailer
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When reversing the vehicle towards the
trailer, make sure there is nobody between
the trailer and the vehicle.
Couple and uncouple the trailer carefully. If
you do not couple the trailer to the towing
vehicle correctly, the trailer could become
detached.
Make sure that the following values are not
exceeded:
Rthe permissible trailer drawbar noseweight
Rthe
permissible trailer load
Rthe permissible rear axle load of the towing
vehicle
maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight of both the towing vehicle and the
trailer
You will find the applicable permissible values, which must not be exceeded, in the vehicle documents.
You will find the values approved by the manufacturer on the vehicle identification plates
and those for the towing vehicle in the "Technical data" section.
Rthe
Z
199
Driving and parking
Trailer towing
200
Trailer towing
Driving and parking
G WARNING
If the Check trailer hitch locking
mechanism message appears in the multifunction display while the vehicle is in motion,
pull over immediately and check whether the
ball coupling is correctly engaged.
G WARNING
Always observe the maximum speed permitted in Germany for vehicle/trailer combinations, even in countries where higher speeds
are permitted. This lowers the risk of an accident.
G WARNING
Never depress the brake pedal continuously
while the vehicle is in motion, e.g. never cause
the brakes to rub by applying constant slight
pedal pressure. This causes the brake system
to overheat, increases the braking distance
and can lead to the brakes failing completely.
G WARNING
On no account should you attempt to draw the
vehicle/trailer combination out by increasing
speed.
General information
i When towing a trailer, set the tyre pres-
sure on the rear axle of the towing vehicle
for a maximum load; see the tyre pressure
table in the fuel filler flap (Y page 339).
You will find installation dimensions and loads
in the "Technical data" section
(Y page 361).
The maximum permissible trailer drawbar
noseweight on the ball coupling is 75 kg.
However, the actual noseweight must not
exceed the value given on the trailer tow hitch
and trailer identification plates. The lowest
weight applies.
! Use a noseweight as close as possible to
the maximum permissible noseweight. Do
not use a noseweight of less than 50 kg,
otherwise the trailer may come loose.
Bear in mind that the payload and the rear
axle load are reduced by the actual noseweight.
Please note that when towing a trailer, PARKTRONIC (Y page 179), parking guidance
(Y page 183) and Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 190) are only available with limitations, or not at all.
i The height of the ball coupling changes
with the load of the vehicle. If necessary,
use a trailer with a height-adjustable drawbar.
Driving tips
i Observe the notes on ESP® trailer stabilisation (Y page 70).
In Germany, the maximum permissible speed
for vehicle/trailer combinations depends on
the type of trailer, and is either 80 km/h or
100 km/h. In some countries, higher maximum speeds are permissible for vehicle/
trailer combinations. Before beginning the
journey, check the trailer's documents to see
what the maximum permitted speed is.
For certain Mercedes-Benz vehicles, the maximum permissible rear axle load is increased
when towing a trailer. Refer to the "Technical
data" section to find out whether this applies
to your vehicle. If you utilise any of the added
maximum rear axle load when towing a trailer,
the vehicle/trailer combination may not
exceed a maximum speed of 100 km/h for
reasons concerning the operating permit.
This also applies in countries in which the
permissible maximum speed for vehicle/
trailer combinations is above 100 km/h.
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different in comparison
to when driving without a trailer.
The vehicle/trailer combination:
Ris
heavier
restricted in its acceleration and gradient-climbing capability
Rhas an increased braking distance
Ris
Trailer towing
affected more by strong crosswinds
more sensitive steering
Rconsumes more fuel
On long and steep downhill gradients, you
must shift to a lower gear in good time, or on
vehicles with automatic transmission, select
the shift range 1, 2 or 3.
Rdemands
G WARNING
Make sure that the ball coupling is engaged,
either in its folded-out or folded-in position,
and that the indicator lamp is off.
Do not turn the release wheel when a trailer
is coupled up. Otherwise, the trailer might
detach.
i This also applies if you have activated
cruise control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC PLUS.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
the speed. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. If you need
additional braking, depress the brake pedal
repeatedly rather than continuously.
Driving tips
a greater distance from the vehicle in front than when driving without a
trailer.
RAvoid braking abruptly. If possible, brake
gently at first to allow the trailer to run on.
Then, increase the braking force rapidly.
RThe values given for gradient-climbing
capabilities from a standstill refer to sea
level. When driving in mountainous areas,
note that the power output of the engine,
and consequently the vehicle's gradientclimbing capability, decrease with increasing altitude.
If the trailer swings from side to side:
X
RMaintain
Do not accelerate.
Do not counter-steer.
X Brake if necessary.
X
X
To open the cover: turn handle : anticlockwise and fold down cover ;.
Pull out release wheel =.
X Turn release wheel = anti-clockwise until
the ball coupling releases and folds out
from under the rear bumper. Indicator
lamp ? flashes.
X
Folding out the ball coupling
Before you can tow a trailer with your vehicle,
you must fold out the ball coupling.
The release wheel is located behind the lefthand side trim panel in the boot.
Z
Driving and parking
Ris
201
Trailer towing
202
Establish the electrical connection
between the vehicle and the trailer.
X Check that the trailer lighting system is
working.
Driving and parking
X
Decoupling a trailer
G WARNING
Pull the ball coupling in the direction of the
arrow until it engages in a vertical position.
Indicator lamp ? goes out. The power
socket folds down automatically.
Vehicles with a 4-button multifunction
steering wheel: the Trailer hitch
Check lock mech. message is shown in
the multifunction display until the ball coupling has engaged.
Vehicles with a 12-button multifunction steering wheel: the Trailer hitch
Check lock mech. message is shown in
the multifunction display until the ball coupling has engaged.
X Remove the protective cap from the ball
coupling and store it in a safe place.
X Make sure that the ball of the ball coupling
is clean and that, depending on the trailer
specification, it is greased or dry (without
grease) when used.
X
Coupling up a trailer
G WARNING
Do not disconnect a trailer with an engaged
overrun brake. Otherwise, your hand could
become trapped between the bumper and
trailer drawbar.
Make sure that the transmission is in position P.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Position the trailer level behind the vehicle.
X Couple up the trailer.
X
As soon as you raise the trailer drawbar, the
unladen vehicle rises slightly. The vehicle then
lowers to driving level.
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel arch or the underbody. You could otherwise trap yourself or others.
G WARNING
The vehicle is lowered as soon as you disconnect the trailer cable. Make sure that nobody
is in the vicinity of the wheel arch or the
underbody. You could otherwise trap yourself
or others.
As soon as you decouple the trailer, the unladen vehicle rises slightly. Make sure that you
or others are not injured in the process.
! Do not disconnect a trailer with an
engaged overrun brake. Otherwise, your
vehicle could be damaged by the rebounding of the overrun brake.
Make sure that the transmission is in position P.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Secure the trailer against rolling away.
X Remove the trailer cable and decouple the
trailer.
X
Folding in the ball coupling
i Fold the ball coupling back in if you are
not using the trailer tow hitch.
G WARNING
Make sure that no persons or animals are in
the pivoting range of the ball coupling. Otherwise, they could be injured.
X
Place the protective cap on the ball coupling.
The release wheel is located behind the lefthand side trim panel in the boot.
X
Press the ball coupling in the direction of
the arrow until it engages behind the
bumper.
Indicator lamp ? goes out and the message in the multifunction display disappears.
Trailer power supply
Coupé
X
To open the cover: turn handle : anticlockwise and fold down cover ;.
When it leaves the factory, your vehicle's
trailer socket is equipped with a permanent
power supply and a power supply that is
switched on via the ignition lock.
The permanent power supply is supplied via
trailer socket pin 9.
The power supply that is switched on via the
ignition lock is supplied via trailer socket pin
10.
! You can connect consumers with a power
rating of up to 240 W to the permanent
power supply and up to 180 W to the power
supply that is switched on via the ignition
lock.
You must not charge a trailer battery using
the power supply.
Pull out release wheel =.
X Turn release wheel = anti-clockwise.
The ball coupling unlocks and lowers. Indicator lamp ? flashes.
X
The trailer's permanent power supply is
switched off in the event of low vehicle supply
voltage and after six hours at the latest.
You can obtain further information about
installing the trailer electrics from a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
X To switch the connected power supply
on or off: turn the key in the ignition lock
to position 2 or 0 respectively.
Bulb failure indicator for LED lamps
i If LED lamps are fitted in the trailer, an
error message may appear in the multifunction display even if there is no fault. The
reason for the error message may be that
the current has fallen below the minimum
of 50 milliamperes (mA).
Z
203
Driving and parking
Trailer towing
Trailer towing
204
Driving and parking
To ensure reliable operation of the bulb failure
indicator, each LED chain in the trailer lighting
must be guaranteed a minimum current of
50 mA.
Trailer with 7-pin connector
General information
If your trailer has a 7-pin connector, you can
connect it to the 13-pin socket on the ball
coupling using an adapter or, if necessary, an
adapter cable. Both of these can be obtained
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Fitting the adapter
Open the socket cover.
X Insert the connector with lug : into
groove ; on the socket and turn the connector clockwise to the stop.
X Let the cover engage.
X If you are using an adapter cable, secure
the cable to the trailer with cable ties.
X
! Make sure that there is sufficient cable
play so that the cable cannot become
detached when cornering.
Useful information ............................
Important safety notes ....................
Displays and operation (4-button
multifunction steering wheel) .........
Displays and operation (12-button
multifunction steering wheel) .........
Display messages .............................
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster ............................
206
206
206
210
232
273
On-board computer and displays
205
On-board computer and displays
206
Displays and operation (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
Important safety notes
You will find an illustration of the instrument
cluster in the "At a glance" section
(Y page 32).
G WARNING
Only use the on-board computer when road
and traffic conditions permit. You would otherwise be distracted and unable to concentrate properly on driving, and could cause an
accident.
G WARNING
If the instrument cluster or multifunction display fails, no messages can be displayed.
This means that you will not see information
about the driving situation, such as the speed,
outside temperature, warning/indicator
lamps, display messages or system failures.
Handling characteristics may be affected.
Adapt your driving style and speed accordingly.
Immediately consult a qualified specialist
workshop which has the necessary specialist
knowledge and tools to carry out the work
required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that
you use a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for
this purpose. In particular, work relevant to
safety or on safety-related systems must be
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
The on-board computer only records and displays malfunctions and warnings from certain
systems. For this reason, you should always
make sure that your vehicle is safe to use. You
could otherwise cause an accident by driving
an unsafe vehicle.
G WARNING
The operating safety of your vehicle could be
jeopardised if maintenance work is carried
out incorrectly. As a result, you could lose
control of the vehicle and cause an accident.
In addition, the safety systems may no longer
be able to protect you or others as they are
designed to do.
Always have maintenance work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop. The qualified
specialist workshop must have the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose. In particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Displays and operation (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Coolant temperature gauge
The coolant temperature gauge is in the
instrument cluster on the left-hand side.
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
The coolant temperature may rise to the top
end of the scale at high outside temperatures
and on long uphill stretches.
Rev counter
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
Displays and operation (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
! Do not drive in the overrevving range.
Doing so will damage the engine.
The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the
engine when the red band is reached.
Outside temperature display
The outside temperature display is in the
instrument cluster (Y page 32).
G WARNING
At temperatures just above freezing point, the
street may be icy, especially in wooded areas
or on bridges. If you do not adapt your driving
style to the conditions, the vehicle could skid.
For this reason, adapt your driving style and
speed to the weather conditions.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
: Multifunction display
; W Increases the volume
= X Decreases the volume
? C Scrolls through lists/adjusts val-
ues/confirms display messages
Operating the on-board computer
The on-board computer is activated as soon
as you turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock. You can use the on-board computer to
call up information relating to your vehicle
and to make and adjust settings.
i You can have certain functions set at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Example:
Rautomatic
door lock
Rspeed limit for winter tyres
You can obtain information about this at
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
207
A V Selects a menu
i If you press and hold the V button, the
standard display appears.
i In the Day. driv. lights: menu, you
can use the W or X button to switch
the function on or off. You cannot adjust
the volume when in the Day. driv.
lights: menu.
Multifunction display
To activate the multifunction display:
Rswitch
on the ignition.
on the lights.
Ropen the driver's door.
Rswitch
Z
On-board computer and displays
208
Displays and operation (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Values and settings as well as display messages are shown in multifunction display :.
Displays and operation (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
Menu overview
Function
:
Standard display(Y page 209)
Shows the standard display or resets the trip meter
;
Trip computer(Y page 210)
Displays or resets the trip computer
=
Range(Y page 210)
?
Current fuel consumption
A
Digital speedometer
B
Message memory(Y page 232)
C
Service(Y page 305)
Calls up the service due date
D
Tyre pressure loss warning system(Y page 340)
E
Daytime driving lights(Y page 210)
Standard display
209
X
Press and hold the V button on the
steering wheel, until the standard display
with trip meter : and total distance
recorder ; is shown.
Z
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
210
To reset the trip meter: press and hold
the V until the standard display
appears.
X Press and hold the C button until the
value has been reset.
X
Trip computer
X
Press the V button on the steering
wheel repeatedly until the trip computer
appears.
: Distance
; Average speed
= Time
? Average fuel consumption
X
To reset the trip computer: press and
hold the C button on the steering wheel
until the values have been reset.
Calling up the range
X
Press the V button on the steering
wheel repeatedly until the approximate
range appears.
The approximate range which can be covered
depends on the fuel level and your current
driving style. If there is only a small amount
of fuel left in the fuel tank, the display shows
a vehicle being refuelled C instead of the
range.
Switching the daytime driving lights
on/off
If you have activated the Day. driv.
lights: function and the light switch is in the
à position, the daytime driving lights are
automatically switched on during daylight
hours when the engine is running. When it is
dark, the side lamps and the dipped-beam
headlamps are switched on automatically.
On vehicles with daytime driving lamps, the
factory setting is on.
If you want to change the setting for the Day.
driv. lights: function, you have to turn
the key in the ignition lock to position 1.
X Press the V button on the steering
wheel repeatedly until the Day. driv.
lights: menu appears.
You will see the selected setting: on or
off.
X Press the W or X button to change
the setting.
Displays and operation (12-button
multifunction steering wheel)
Coolant temperature gauge
The coolant temperature gauge is in the
instrument cluster on the left-hand side.
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
At high outside temperatures and when driving uphill, the coolant temperature may rise
to the end of the scale.
Rev counter
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
! Do not drive in the overrevving range.
Doing so will damage the engine.
The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the
engine when the red band is reached.
Outside temperature display
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 212).
G WARNING
At temperatures just above freezing point, the
street may be icy, especially in wooded areas
or on bridges. If you do not adapt your driving
style to the conditions, the vehicle could skid.
For this reason, adapt your driving style and
speed to the weather conditions.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Speedometer with segments
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
Cruise control (Y page 162) activated:
The segments light up from the stored speed
to the maximum speed.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 173) activated:
The segments light up from the start of the
scale to the selected limit speed.
DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 164) activated:
One or two segments in the set speed range
light up.
DISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front:
The segments between the speed of the vehicle in front and the stored speed light up.
Operating the on-board computer
Overview
The on-board computer is activated as soon
as you turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
: Multifunction display
; Switches on LINGUATRONIC; see the sep-
arate operating instructions
= Right control panel
? Left control panel
A Back button
Left control panel
=
;
RCalls
9
:
Press briefly:
up the menu and menu bar
RScrolls
through lists
a submenu or function
RIn the Audio menu: selects a
stored station, an audio track or
a video scene
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone
number
RSelects
Z
211
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
212
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
9
:
a
Press and hold:
RIn
the Audio menu: selects the
previous/next station or selects
an audio track or a video scene
using rapid scrolling
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
starts rapid scrolling through the
phone book
%
sage
the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the telephone book
and starts dialling the selected
number
RIn the Audio menu: stops the
station search function at the
desired station
Right control panel
Press briefly:
RBack
RSwitches
off LINGUATRONIC
display messages or calls
up the last Trip menu function
used
RExits the telephone book/redial
memory
RHides
RConfirms selection/display mesRIn
~
Back button
%
Press and hold:
RCalls
up the standard display in
the Trip menu
Multifunction display
Values and settings as well as display messages are shown in the multifunction display.
RRejects
or ends a call
telephone book/redial
memory
RExits
6
RMakes
or accepts a call
to the redial memory
RSwitches
W
X
RAdjusts
8
RMute
the volume
: Description field
; Menu bar
= Drive program
? Outside temperature or speed
(Y page 223)
A Transmission position
X
To show menu bar ;: press the =
or ; button on the steering wheel.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the
indicators in the lower part of the multifunction display differ from the display shown
here.
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
The following messages can appear in the
multifunction display:
Z
Shift recommendation
(Y page 145)
XjY
Parking Guidance (Y page 183)
_
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
(Y page 112)
À
ATTENTION ASSIST (Y page 188)
¤
ECO start/stop function
(Y page 140)
Ä
Speed Limit Assist (Y page 189)
Ã
Lane Keeping Assist
(Y page 192) or Active Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 197)
HOLD function (Y page 177)
HOLD
Ä
PRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 71)
120km/h! Maximum permissible speed
exceeded (only for certain countries)
213
Z
On-board computer and displays
214
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Menu overview
The number of menus shown depends on the optional equipment in the vehicle.
Function
:
Trip menu (Y page 215)
;
Navi menu (navigation instructions) (Y page 216)
=
Audio menu (Y page 217)
?
Tel menu (telephone) (Y page 219)
A
Assist. menu (assistance) (Y page 220)
B
Service menu (Y page 222)
Rcalls up display messages (Y page 233)
Rtyre pressure loss warning (Y page 340)
RTyre pressure monitor (Y page 342)
RASSYST PLUS service interval display (Y page 305)
C
Settings menu (Y page 223)
D
AMG menu in AMG vehicles (Y page 229)
The Audio, Navi and Tel menus differ slightly in vehicles with an audio system and vehicles
with COMAND Online. The examples given in this Owner's Manual apply to vehicles equipped
with COMAND Online.
Trip menu
Standard display
X
Press and hold the % button on the
steering wheel until the Trip menu with
total distance recorder : and trip
meter ; is shown.
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
The values in the From start submenu are
calculated from the start of a journey, whilst
the values in the From reset submenu are
calculated from the last time the submenu
was reset (Y page 216).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press 9 or : to select From start
or From reset.
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than four hours.
hours have been exceeded.
R9999 kilometres have been exceeded.
The From reset trip computer is reset if the
trip exceeds 9999 hours or 99,999 kilometres.
R999
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
current fuel consumption10 and approximate range.
X
The approximate range which can be covered
depends on the fuel level and your current
driving style. If there is only a small amount
of fuel left in the fuel tank, the display shows
a vehicle being refuelled C instead of the
range.
Digital speedometer
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
digital speedometer.
X
Trip computer "From start" (example)
: Distance
; Time
= Average speed
? Average fuel consumption
The From start trip computer is reset automatically when:
10 Not
AMG vehicles.
Z
215
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
216
information, see the separate operating
instructions.
Switch on the audio system with Becker®
MAP PILOT or COMAND Online (see the
separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu.
X
: Shift recommendation
; Digital speedometer
i If the gearshift recommendation is shown
Route guidance not active
in the multifunction display, it is not shown
in the status bar.
For further information on gearshift recommendations, see (Y page 145).
Resetting values
You can reset the values of the following functions:
Rtrip
meter
computer "From start"
Rtrip computer "From reset"
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X Press a.
Rtrip
: Direction of travel
; Current street
Activated route guidance
No change of direction announced
: Distance to the destination
; Distance to the next change of direction
= Current street
? Symbol for "follow the road's course"
Resetting the trip computer "From start" (example)
X
Press : to select Yes and press a
to confirm.
Navigation menu
Displaying navigation instructions
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows navigation instructions. For more
Change of direction announced without a
lane recommendation
Lane recommendation display (example)
: Lane continues through change of direc: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Current street
? Change-of-direction icon
When a change of direction has been
announced, you will see visual distance display ; next to the symbol for change of
direction ?. This decreases in size as you
approach the announced change of direction.
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
Lane recommendations are only displayed if
the relevant data is available on the digital
map.
tion
; New lane during a change of direction
Other status indicators of the navigation system
RO: you have reached the destination or an
intermediate destination.
route... or Calculating route: a
new route is being calculated.
ROff map or Off road: the vehicle position
is outside the area of the digital map (offmap position).
RNo route: no route could be calculated to
the selected destination.
RNew
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
You can only change the waveband and store
new stations using the audio system or
COMAND Online.
X Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online and select Radio (see the separate
operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
= Lane recommendation
? Change-of-direction icon
On multi-lane roads, lane recommendation
= may be shown for the next change of
direction. During the change of direction,
additional lanes may be displayed.
Z
217
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
218
To select the next/previous track:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the
9 or : button until the desired track
has been reached.
X
: Waveband
;
Station11
To select a stored station: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a station from the station
list: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
X To select a station using station
search12: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
X
i DAB radio mode (Digital Audio Broadcasting); see the separate operating instructions.
Audio player or audio media operation
Audio data from various audio devices or
media can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
X Switch on the audio system or COMAND
Online and select the audio device or
medium (see the separate operating
instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
If you press and hold the 9 or : button, the rapid scrolling speed is increased.
Not all audio devices or media support this
function.
If track information is stored on the audio
device or medium, the multifunction display
will show the number and name of the track.
The current track does not appear in audio
AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external
audio source connected).
Video DVD operation
Switch on COMAND Online and select
video DVD (see the separate operating
instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X
DVD changer display (example)
: Current scene
To select the next or previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the
9 or : button until the desired
scene has been reached.
X
CD changer display (example)
: Current track
11 If
the station has been stored, the memory position will also be displayed.
if no station list is received.
12 Only
Telephone menu
Introduction
Functions and displays are dependent on the
optional equipment installed in your vehicle.
You can place your mobile phone in the
mobile phone bracket (Y page 292), or set
up a Bluetooth® connection to the audio system or COMAND Online (see the separate
operating instructions).
i You can obtain further information about
RTelephone
ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found
a network and is ready to receive.
RTelephone No Service: no network is
available, or the mobile phone is searching
for a network.
Accepting a call
If someone calls you when you are in the
Telmenu, a display message appears in the
multifunction display, for example:
suitable mobile phones and connecting
mobile phones via Bluetooth®:
Rin
any Mercedes Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Ron
G WARNING
Observe the legal requirements of the country
in which you are currently driving regarding
the use of mobile phones in the vehicle.
If it is permitted to use mobile phones while
the vehicle is in motion, you should only use
them when the road and traffic conditions
allow. Otherwise, you may be distracted from
the traffic conditions, cause an accident and
injure yourself and others.
Switch on the mobile phone and audio system or COMAND Online (see the separate
operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RPlease enter PIN: the mobile phone has
been placed in the mobile phone bracket
and the PIN has not been entered.
X Enter the PIN using the mobile phone, LINGUATRONIC, the audio system or
COMAND Online.
The mobile phone will search for a network.
X
Press the 6 button on the steering
wheel to accept an incoming call.
If you are not in the Tel menu, you can still
accept a call.
Rejecting or ending a call
X
Press the ~ button on the steering
wheel.
If you are not in the Tel menu, you can still
reject or end a call.
Dialling a number from the phone book
If your mobile phone is able to receive calls,
you can search for and dial a number from the
phone book in the audio system or COMAND
Online at any time.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to call
up the phone book.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name.
To start scrolling rapidly, press and hold the
9 or : button for longer than one
Z
219
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
220
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
second. After a short time, the rapid scroll
speeds up.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X If only one telephone number is stored
for a name: press the 6 or a button
to start dialling.
or
X If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X If you do not want to make a call: press
the ~ or % button.
Redialling
The on-board computer saves the last names
or numbers dialled in the redial memory.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X If you do not want to make a call: press
the ~ or % button.
Assistance menu
Introduction
In the Assist. menu you can:
Rdisplay Speed Limit Assist and activate/
deactivate the message function of Speed
Limit Assist
Rshow the distance display
Ractivate/deactivate ESP®
Ractivate/deactivate PRE-SAFE® Brake
Ractivate/deactivate ATTENTION ASSIST
Ractivate/deactivate Blind Spot Assist or
Active Blind Spot Assist
Ractivate/deactivate Lane Keeping Assist or
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Speed Limit Assist
Displaying Speed Limit Assist
In the Speed Lim. Asst. function, a detected speed limit is displayed under certain
conditions (Y page 189).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Speed Lim.
Asst..
X Press a.
The multifunction display shows Speed
Limit Assist.
Activating/deactivating the Speed Limit
Assist message function
You can set Speed Limit Assist (Y page 189)
to display a detected speed limit automatically for five seconds. Other messages in the
multifunction display will be faded out for this
length of time.
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Speed Lim.
Asst..
X Press a.
The multifunction display shows Speed
Limit Assist.
X Press :.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate or deactivate: press a.
X
If Speed Limit Assist is operational and the
message function is activated, the multifunction display shows the Ä symbol when the
ignition is switched on.
Showing the distance display
This function is only available with DISTRONIC PLUS.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Distance display.
X Press a.
The DISTRONIC PLUS distance display
(Y page 171) appears in the multifunction
display.
Deactivating/activating ESP®
G WARNING
If the ÷ warning lamp in the instrument
cluster flashes, proceed as follows:
RUnder no circumstances should you deactivate ESP®.
RWhen pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
RAdapt your driving style to the prevailing
road and weather conditions.
The vehicle may otherwise begin to skid.
If you drive too fast, ESP® cannot reduce the
risk of an accident. ESP® cannot override the
laws of physics.
This function is not available in AMG vehicles.
For activating or deactivating ESP® on AMG
vehicles, see (Y page 69).
For further information about ESP®, see
(Y page 67).
X Start the engine.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ESP.
X Press the a button.
X To deactivate: press a again.
The å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster comes on.
G WARNING
If the å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the engine is running,
ESP® is deactivated or is unavailable due to a
malfunction. The risk that your vehicle may
start to skid then increases in certain situations.
Always adapt your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
To activate: press a again.
The å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Activating/deactivating the PRE-SAFE®
Brake
PRE-SAFE® Brake is only available in vehicles
with DISTRONIC PLUS.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select PreSafe
Brake.
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
When PRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 71) is activated, the multifunction display shows the
Z
221
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
222
Ä symbol as long as the HOLD function is
not activated (Y page 177).
Vehicles with Parking Guidance: if PARKTRONIC is activated and you are driving at a
speed under 35 km/h, the j Parking Guidance symbol is shown instead of the Ä
symbol.
Activating/deactivating Attention
Assist
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Attention Asst..
X Press a.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
X
When ATTENTION ASSIST (Y page 188) is
activated, the À symbol appears in the
multifunction display when the ignition is on.
(Y page 192) or Active Lane Keeping Assist
(Y page 197).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Lane Keep.
Asst..
X Press a.
If the function is activated, the lane marking
symbol in the multifunction display lights
up red.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
When Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane
Keeping Assist is activated, the à symbol
appears in the multifunction display when the
ignition is on.
Service menu
Activating/deactivating Blind Spot
Assist
You can use the Blind Spot Asst. function
to activate or deactivate Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 190) or Active Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 194).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Blind Spot
Asst..
X Press a.
If the function is activated, the monitored
areas in the multifunction display light up
red.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
Activating/deactivating Lane Keeping
Assist
You can use the Lane Keep. Asst. function
to activate/deactivate Lane Keeping Assist
In the Service menu you can:
Rcall up display messages (Y page 232)
Rreset the tyre pressure loss warning system
(Y page 340)
Rreset the tyre pressure loss warning system
(Y page 340) or check the tyre pressure
electronically (Y page 342)
Rcall up the service due date (Y page 305)
Settings menu
Introduction
The Settings menu can be used for:
Rchanging the instrument cluster settings
Rchanging the light settings
Rchanging the vehicle settings
Rchanging the auxiliary heating settings
Rchanging the convenience settings
Rrestoring the factory settings
Instrument cluster
Selecting the unit of measurement for distance
The Display unit Speed-/odometer:
function allows you to choose whether certain displays appear in kilometres or miles.
The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to:
Rthe
digital speedometer in the Trip menu
total distance recorder and the trip
meter
Rthe trip computer
Rthe current consumption and the range
Rthe navigation instruction in the Navi menu
Rcruise control
RSPEEDTRONIC
RDISTRONIC PLUS
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
Rthe
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display unit Speed-/odometer function.
You will see the selected setting: km or
miles.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Switching the additional speedometer
on/off
Only vehicles with manual transmission have
this function.
i Vehicles for the United Kingdom: this
function is not available.
The Dig. speedom [mph]: function allows
you to choose whether the status area in the
multifunction display always shows the speed
in mph instead of the outside temperature.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Dig.
speedo [mph]: function.
You will see the selected setting: on or
off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Selecting the permanent display function
Only vehicles with automatic transmission
have this function.
i Vehicles for the United Kingdom: this
function is not available.
The Permanent display: function allows
you to choose whether the multifunction display always shows the outside temperature
or the speed in mph.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
Z
223
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
224
Press : or 9 to select the Perma‐
nent display function.
You will see the selected setting: outside
temperature or Dig. speedom [mph].
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Lights
Switching the daytime driving lights on/
off
If you have activated the Day lights function and the light switch is set to Ã, the
daytime driving lights are automatically
switched on during daylight hours when the
engine is running. When it is dark, the side
lamps and the dipped-beam headlamps are
also switched on automatically.
X Switch off the engine.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Day lights function.
If the Day lights have been switched on,
the cone of light and the W symbol in
the multifunction display are shown in red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Activating/deactivating the Intelligent
Light System
If you activate the Intell. Light Sys.
function, you activate the following functions:
Rmotorway mode
Ractive light function
Rcornering light function
Rextended range foglamps
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
Press : or 9 to select the Intell.
Light Sys. function.
If the Intell. Light Sys. function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
L symbol in the multifunction display
are shown in red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left (Y page 224), the
multifunction display shows the System
inoperative display message under the
image of the vehicle for the Intell. Light
Sys. function in the Light submenu.
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left
This function is only available on vehicles with
the Intelligent Light System.
You can use this function to switch between
symmetrical beam and asymmetrical dipped
beam (Y page 108).
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, then motorway
mode and the extended range foglamps are
not available.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Dipped
beams Setting for: function.
You will see the selected setting: Rightside traffic or Left-side traffic.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When you change the setting, conversion
does not take place until the next time the
vehicle is stationary.
You can also have the dipped-beam headlamps set for driving on the right/left at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist on/
off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Adapt.
main beam function.
If the Adapt. main beam function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
_ symbol in the multifunction display
are shown in red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Activating/deactivating the surround
lighting and exterior lighting delayed
switch-off
If you have activated the Surround light‐
ing function and the light switch is in the
à position,
Rthe exterior lighting remains on for another
40 seconds after you unlock the vehicle
using the key.
The exterior lighting switches off when you
open the driver’s door.
Rthe exterior lighting remains on for another
15 seconds after closing the doors when it
is dark.
If the engine is switched off and then none
of the doors are opened, or if an open door
is not closed, the exterior lighting goes out
after 60 seconds.
If you activate the Surround lighting function, the following light up depending on the
vehicle's equipment:
Rthe side lamps
Rthe foglamps
Rthe daytime driving lights
Rthe surround lighting in the exterior mirrors
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Surround lighting function.
When the Surround lighting function is
activated, the light cone and the area
around the vehicle are displayed in red in
the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Deactivating delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting temporarily:
Before leaving the vehicle, turn the key to
position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock and back to position 0.
The exterior lighting delayed switch-off is
deactivated.
X
Delayed switch-off of the exterior lighting is
reactivated the next time you start the
engine.
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off
If you activate the Light. delay function,
the interior lighting remains on for 20 seconds after you remove the key from the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light. delay function.
When the Light. delay function is activated, the vehicle interior is displayed in
red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Vehicle
Setting permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can set permanent SPEEDTRONIC
(Y page 176) using the Limit speed (win‐
ter tyres) function.
Z
225
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
226
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Limit
speed (winter tyres): function.
You will see the current setting.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to adjust permanent
SPEEDTRONIC in increments of 10
(230 km/h to 160 km/h). The Off setting
switches permanent SPEEDTRONIC off.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
X
Switching the automatic locking feature
on/off
If you select the Automatic door lock function, the vehicle is centrally locked above a
speed of around 15 km/h.
i For further information on the automatic
locking feature, see (Y page 84).
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Automatic door lockfunction.
When the Automatic door locks function is activated, the vehicle doors are displayed in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking confirmation
If you activate the Acoustic Lock function,
an audible signal sounds when the vehicle is
locked or unlocked. When unlocking, the signal sounds once. When locking, it sounds
three times.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Acoustic Lock function.
If the Acoustic Lock function is activated,
the & symbol in the multifunction display lights up red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Activating/deactivating the radar sensor
system
i You must deactivate the radar sensor system in certain countries and near radio
telescope facilities. For further information, see (Y page 363).
When you are close to radio telescope facilities, the radar sensor system will be deactivated automatically.
The following systems are switched off when
the radar sensor system is deactivated:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 164)
PLUS (Y page 66)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 71)
RBlind Spot Assist (Y page 190)
RActive Blind Spot Assist (Y page 194)
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Radar sensor (See Owner's Man.):.
You will see the selected setting: on or
off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
RBAS
Heating menu
Auxiliary heating departure time
This function is only available on vehicles with
auxiliary heating (Y page 128).
In the Heating submenu, you can select a
stored departure time or change a departure
time.
The auxiliary heating timer function calculates the switch-on time according to the outside temperature so that the vehicle is preheated by the departure time. When the
departure time is reached, the auxiliary heating continues to heat for a further five
minutes and then switches off. The auxiliary
heating adopts the THERMATIC or
THERMOTRONIC temperature setting.
You can switch off the auxiliary heating by
using the remote control or the auxiliary heating button on the centre console.
G WARNING
Exhaust fumes are produced when the auxiliary heating is in operation. Inhaling these
exhaust fumes can be poisonous. You should
therefore switch off the auxiliary heating in
confined spaces without an extraction system, e.g. a garage.
G WARNING
When operating the auxiliary heating parts of
the vehicle can get very hot. Make sure that
the exhaust system does not under any circumstances come into contact with easily
ignitable material such as dry grass or fuels.
The material could otherwise ignite and set
the vehicle alight. Choose your parking spot
accordingly.
Operating the auxiliary heating is thus prohibited at filling stations or when your vehicle
is being refuelled. You must therefore switch
off the auxiliary heating at filling stations.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
i Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly
once a month for about 10 minutes.
Selecting the departure time or deactivating a selected departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
one of the three departure times or Timer
off (no timer active).
X Press the a button to confirm.
When a departure time is selected, the yellow indicator lamp lights up on the auxiliary
heating button.
Changing the departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
Change A, B or C.
X Press the a button to confirm.
You can now change the departure time.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
display to be changed: hours, minutes.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
selected display.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
The yellow indicator lamp on the auxiliary
heating button lights up.
Z
227
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
228
Convenience
Activating/deactivating the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature
You can use the Easy Entry/Exit: function
to activate or deactivate the EASY ENTRY/
EXIT feature (Y page 102).
G WARNING
The steering wheel moves when the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature is active. There is a risk
of occupants becoming trapped. Before activating the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature, make
sure that nobody can become trapped.
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. The children could open the
driver's door and thereby unintentionally activate the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature and
become trapped.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Easy Entry/Exit function.
If the Easy Entry/Exit function is activated, the vehicle steering wheel is displayed
in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Switching the belt adjustment on/off
For further information on belt adjustment,
see (Y page 53).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Belt adjustment function.
When the Belt adjustment function is
activated, the vehicle seat belt is displayed
in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Switching the Fold in mirrors when locking function on/off
If you switch on the Auto. fold in function,
the exterior mirrors fold in when you lock the
vehicle. When you unlock the vehicle and then
open a door, the exterior mirrors fold out
again.
If you have switched the function on and you
fold the exterior mirrors in using the button
on the door (Y page 103), they will not fold
out automatically. The exterior mirrors can
then only be folded out using the button on
the door.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 to select the
Auto. fold in function.
If the Auto. fold in function is activated,
the vehicle's exterior mirror is displayed in
red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Resetting to factory settings
For safety reasons, not all functions are reset:
the Limit Speed (winter tyres) function
in permanent SPEEDTRONIC can only be set
in the Vehicle submenu. If you want to reset
the Daytime driving lights function in
the Light submenu, you must turn the key in
the ignition lock to position 1.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory setting submenu.
Press the a button to confirm.
The Reset all settings? message
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
No or Yes.
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
If you select Yes, the multifunction display
shows a confirmation message.
X
AMG menu in AMG vehicles
AMG displays
X
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
: Digital speedometer
; Gear indicator
= Upshift indicator
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until
SETUP is displayed.
X
: Drive program (C/S/S+/M)
; ESP® mode (ON/OFF) or SPORT handling
mode (SPORT)
RACETIMER
Displaying and starting RACETIMER
You can use the RACETIMER to store lap
times.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
RACETIMER is shown.
i If the RACETIMER is selected, the =
and ; buttons are inoperative.
? Engine oil temperature
A Coolant temperature
Upshift indicator UP = indicates that the
engine has reached the overrevving range
when in the manual gearshift program.
Upshift indicator UP = fades out other messages until you have shifted up.
When the engine oil temperature is below
80 †, the oil temperature is shown in blue.
Avoid driving at full engine output during this
time.
SETUP
SETUP shows the drive program, the ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program) mode and the
SPORT handling mode.
: Lap
; RACETIMER
You can start the RACETIMER when the
engine is running or if the key is in position
2 in the ignition lock.
X
To start: press the a button to start the
RACETIMER.
Z
229
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
230
Displaying the intermediate time
Press = or ; to select Interm.
Time.
X Press the a button to confirm.
The intermediate time is displayed for five
seconds.
X
Starting a new lap
It is possible to store a maximum of sixteen
laps.
X Press a to confirm New Lap.
Resetting the current lap
X Stop the RACETIMER.
X Press = or ; to select Reset Lap.
X Press a to reset the lap time to "0”.
Deleting all laps
If you switch off the engine, the RACETIMER
is reset to "0" after 30 seconds. All laps are
deleted.
You cannot delete individual stored laps. If
you have stopped 16 laps, the current lap
does not have to be reset.
X Reset the current lap.
X Press a to confirm Reset.
Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display.
X
: RACETIMER
; Fastest lap time (best lap)
= Lap
Stopping the RACETIMER
X Press the % button on the steering
wheel.
X
Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
All laps are deleted.
Overall evaluation
This function is shown if you have stored at
least one lap and stopped the RACETIMER.
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
overall evaluation is shown.
X
Press a to confirm YES.
The RACETIMER interrupts timing when you
stop the vehicle and turn the key to position
1 in the ignition lock. When you turn the key
to position 2 or 3 and then press the a to
confirm Start, timing is continued.
: RACETIMER overall evaluation
; Total time driven
Displays and operation (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
On-board computer and displays
= Average speed
? Distance covered
A Top speed
Lap evaluation
This function is only available if you have
stored at least two laps and have stopped the
RACETIMER.
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
lap evaluation is shown.
Each lap is shown in a separate submenu.
The fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol :.
X
: Lap
; Lap time
= Average lap speed
? Lap length
A Top speed during lap
X
231
Press the 9 or : button to select a
different lap evaluation.
Z
On-board computer and displays
232
Display messages
Display messages
General notes
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
Display messages with graphic displays may be shown in simplified form in the Owner's Manual
and may differ from the messages shown in the multifunction display.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in
this Owner's Manual.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on the HOLD function
(Y page 177) and parking (Y page 158).
Hiding display messages
You can hide some display messages with a low priority.
X Vehicles with a 4-button multifunction steering wheel: press C on the steering
wheel to clear the display message.
The display message is cleared.
X Vehicles with a 12-button multifunction steering wheel: press a or % on the
steering wheel to clear the display message.
The display message is cleared.
Display messages with a high priority are shown in red.
You cannot hide display messages of the highest priority. The multifunction display shows
these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.
Message memory
Vehicles with a 4-button multifunction steering wheel
The on-board computer saves certain display messages. You can call up these display messages in the message memory.
X Press the V button on the steering wheel repeatedly until the message memory is
shown.
If there are no display messages, you will see No messages. If there are display messages,
the multifunction display shows 2 messages, for example.
X Using the C button, scroll through the display messages.
For some display messages, the + symbol appears in the multifunction display. You will
find detailed information about these display messages in the section which follows.
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been
rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted.
Vehicles with a 12-button multifunction steering wheel
The on-board computer saves certain display messages. You can call up the display messages
in the message memory.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 messages, for example.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages.
X Confirm with a.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
X
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been
rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted.
Z
233
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
234
Display messages
Safety systems (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
ABS
curr. unavail.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist), PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill
start assist and ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily not available.
The adaptive brake lights may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster.
The self-diagnosis function might not be complete, for example.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist
and ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily not available.
The adaptive brake lights may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster.
For example, the on-board voltage may be insufficient.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Drive on carefully.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
ABS
inoperative
EBD and ABS
inoperative
J
Release parking
brake
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist
and ESP® trailer stabilisation are not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å, ! and J warning lamps light
up in the instrument cluster.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS,
PRE-SAFE®, hill start assist and ESP® trailer stabilisation are not
available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
You are driving with the parking brake applied. A warning tone also
sounds.
X Release the parking brake.
Z
235
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
236
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
A malfunction has occurred while the HOLD function is active.
or
Vehicles with manual transmission: with the HOLD function
activated, you have:
Brake immediately
Ropened
the driver's door and released the seat belt or
off the engine or
Ropened the bonnet
A tone may also sound at regular intervals. The tone becomes
louder if you attempt to lock the vehicle.
You cannot start the engine.
X Paying attention to the traffic situation, immediately depress the
brake pedal firmly and hold until the display message disappears.
X Prevent the vehicle from rolling away before you leave it
(Y page 321).
You can restart the engine.
Rswitched
J
G Risk of accident
Check brake fluid
level
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir. In addition, the red J warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster
and a warning tone sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the error.
#
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Check brake wear
PRE-SAFE
inoperative
ü
G Risk of injury
Important functions of PRE-SAFE® have failed. All other occupant
safety systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If the symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has been clipped into a rear seat belt buckle.
For further information on the status indicator for the rear seat
belts: (Y page 54).
Display messages
ý
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of injury
If the symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has not been clipped into a rear seat belt buckle.
X If necessary, ask the occupants in the rear to fasten their seat
belts.
For further information on the status indicator for the rear seat
belts: (Y page 54).
Child seat position
G Risk of injury
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the frontpassenger seat: the child seat is positioned incorrectly.
X Fit the child seat in the correct position.
G Risk of injury
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the frontpassenger seat: the automatic child seat recognition sensor is
faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
6
Malfunction -Work‐
shop-
6
FL malfunc. -Work‐
shop- or FR mal‐
func. -Workshop-
6
RL malfunc. -work‐
shop- or RR mal‐
func. -Workshop-
G Risk of injury
There is a malfunction in the SRS (Supplemental Restraint System). The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
SRS has malfunctioned at the front on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
SRS has malfunctioned at the rear on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left windowbag mal‐ G Risk of injury
function:wkshp
There is a malfunction in the left-hand and/or right-hand windowor
bag. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument clusRight windowbag
ter.
malfunction:wkshp
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
237
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
238
Display messages
Safety systems (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
!÷
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist), PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill
start assist and ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily not available.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster.
The self-diagnosis function might not be complete, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist
and ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily not available.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster.
For example, the on-board voltage may be insufficient.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Drive on carefully.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
!÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
÷
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist
and ESP® trailer stabilisation are not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the J, ÷, å and ! warning lamps light
up in the instrument cluster.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
G Risk of accident
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and
ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily not available.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
The self-diagnosis function might not be complete, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
239
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
240
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
T!
÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
J
Release parking
brake
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and
ESP® trailer stabilisation are not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRESAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and ESP® trailer stabilisation are not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster and a warning tone sounds.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
You are driving with the parking brake applied. A warning tone also
sounds.
X Release the parking brake.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
A malfunction has occurred while the HOLD function or DISTRONIC PLUS is active.
or
Vehicles with manual transmission: with the HOLD function activated, you have either:
Brake immediately
Ropened
the driver's door and released the seat belt or
off the engine or
Ropened the bonnet
A tone may also sound at regular intervals. The tone becomes
louder if you attempt to lock the vehicle.
You cannot start the engine.
X Paying attention to the traffic situation, immediately depress the
brake pedal firmly and hold until the display message disappears.
X Prevent the vehicle from rolling away before you leave it
(Y page 321).
You can restart the engine.
Rswitched
J
G Risk of accident
Check brake fluid
level
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir. In addition, the red J warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights
up and a warning tone sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the error.
#
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Check brake wear
PRE-SAFE
inoperative See
Owner's Man.
G Risk of injury
Important functions of PRE-SAFE® have failed. All other occupant
safety systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
241
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
242
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
PRE-SAFE
Functions cur‐
rently limited See
Owner's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
PRE-SAFE® Brake is temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
DISTRONIC PLUS cover in the radiator grille is dirty.
sensors in the bumpers are dirty.
Rits function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
RAMG vehicles only: you switch off ESP®
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range.
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
PRE-SAFE® Brake is operational again and the display message
disappears if:
Rthe
Rthe
dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
system detects that the sensors are fully available again.
RAMG vehicles only: you reactivate ESP®
Rthe system is within the operating temperature range.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Rthe
Clean the DISTRONIC PLUS cover in the radiator grille
(Y page 309).
X Clean the bumpers (Y page 309).
X Restart the engine.
X Wait until the battery is sufficiently charged.
X
PRE-SAFE
Functions limited
See Owner's Manual
ü
G Risk of accident
PRE-SAFE® Brake is faulty. BAS PLUS or the distance warning signal may also have failed.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If the symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has been clipped into a rear seat belt buckle.
For further information on the status indicator for the rear seat
belts: (Y page 54).
Display messages
ý
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of injury
If the symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has not been clipped into a rear seat belt buckle.
X If necessary, ask the occupants in the rear to fasten their seat
belts.
For further information on the status indicator for the rear seat
belts: (Y page 54).
Child seat in
G Risk of injury
wrong position
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the frontSee Owner's Manual passenger seat: the child seat is positioned incorrectly.
X Fit the child seat in the correct position.
G Risk of injury
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the frontpassenger seat: the automatic child seat recognition sensor is
faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
6
G Risk of injury
6
G Risk of injury
Restraint sys. mal‐ There is a malfunction in the SRS (Supplemental Restraint System). The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument clusfunction Consult
ter.
workshop
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Front left malfunc‐ SRS has malfunctioned at the front on the left or right. The 6
tion Consult work‐ warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
shop or Front
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
right malfunction
Consult workshop
Z
243
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
244
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
6
Rear left malfunc‐
tion Consult work‐
shop or Rear right
malfunction Con‐
sult workshop
6
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of injury
SRS has malfunctioned at the rear on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
Left windowbag mal‐ There is a malfunction in the left-hand and/or right-hand windowbag. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument clusfunction Consult
ter.
workshop or Right
windowbag malfunc‐ X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
tion Consult work‐
shop
Lights (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
i Display messages about LEDs:
This display message will only appear if all LEDs have failed.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left corner. light
or Right corner.
light
b
The left or right-hand dipped-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
Left dipped beam or
(Y page 114).
Right dipped-beam
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
Trailer left tail
lamp or Trailer
right tail lamp
The left or right-hand trailer tail lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself.
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
b
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The left or right-hand trailer turn signal lamp is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself.
Trailer left indic.
or
or Trailer right
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
indic.
b
Trailer brake lamp
X
The trailer brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself.
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
Rear left indicator
(Y page 114).
or Rear right indi‐
or
cator
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
Front left indica‐
tor or Front right
indicator
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is
faulty.
Left mirror indica‐ X
Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
tor or Right mir‐
(Y page 114).
ror indicator
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
Third brake lamp
b
Tail/brake lamp,
left or Tail/brake
lamp, right
The third brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
245
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
246
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand high beam is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left main beam or
Right main beam
b
Left fog lamp or
Right fog lamp
b
Rear fog lamp
b
Front left parking
lamp or Front
right parking lamp
b
Reversing light
b
Rear left marker
lamp or Rear right
marker lamp
The left-hand or right-hand front foglamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The rear foglamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The front left or front right parking lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The reversing lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The rear left or right side marker lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right daytime driving lamp is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left daytime driv‐
ing lamp
or
Right daytime
driving lamp
b
Malfunction
The exterior lighting is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicles with trailer tow hitch: a fuse may have blown.
X Check the fuses (Y page 333).
X If necessary, replace the blown fuse. Observe the warning notes
as you do so.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
b
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
b
Switch off lights
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The light sensor is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
Lights (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
i Display messages about LEDs:
This display message will only appear if all LEDs have failed.
Z
247
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
248
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
Left cornering
(Y page 114).
light or Right cor‐
or
nering light
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand dipped-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
Left dipped beam or
(Y page 114).
Right dipped beam
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
Trailer left tail
lamp or Trailer
right tail lamp
b
Trailer left indi‐
cator or Trailer
right indicator
b
Trailer brake lamp
The left or right-hand trailer tail lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself.
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand trailer turn signal lamp is faulty.
Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself.
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The trailer brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself.
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
Rear left indicator
(Y page 114).
or Rear right indi‐
or
cator
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
Front left indica‐
tor or Front right
indicator
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is
faulty.
Left mirror indica‐ X
Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
tor or Right mir‐
(Y page 114).
ror indicator
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
Third brake lamp
b
Left-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp or
Right-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp
b
Left main beam or
Right main beam
b
Left fog lamp or
Right fog lamp
b
Rear fog lamp
The third brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand high beam is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left-hand or right-hand front foglamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The rear foglamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
249
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
250
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The front left or front right parking lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Front left parking
lamp or Front
right parking lamp
b
Reversing light
b
Rear left side
marker lamp or
Rear right side
marker lamp
b
Left daytime driv‐
ing lamp or Right
daytime driving
lamp
b
Intell. Light Sys‐
tem inoperative
b
Malfunction See
Owner's Manual
The reversing lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The rear left or right side marker lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand daytime driving lamp is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to change the bulb yourself
(Y page 114).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The Intelligent Light System is faulty. The lights remain available
without the Intelligent Light System.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The exterior lighting is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicles with trailer tow hitch: a fuse may have blown.
X Check the fuses (Y page 333).
X If necessary, replace the blown fuse. Observe the warning notes
as you do so.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
b
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The light sensor is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
Switch off lights
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist inoperative
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
X Clean the windscreen.
Rvisibility
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is available again if:
Rthe
dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
system detects that the camera is fully operational again.
The Adaptive Main-beam Assist available again message
is displayed.
Rthe
Engine (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Top up
coolant
The coolant level is too low.
X Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes when doing so
(Y page 303).
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
?
The coolant is too hot.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the
engine. Otherwise, there is a risk of engine damage.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
Stop vehicle Sw.
eng. Off
Z
251
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
252
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The poly-V-belt may have torn.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Open the bonnet.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the
engine. Otherwise, there is a risk of engine damage.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
?
The fan motor is faulty.
X If the coolant temperature is less than 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving on
mountain roads and stop/start driving.
#
The battery is not being charged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes:
Rfaulty
alternator
poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Open the bonnet.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
Rtorn
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
4
The engine oil level has dropped to a critical level.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the oil level (Y page 302).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 303).
X Have the engine checked for leaks if the engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
Check eng. oil
level
8
Reserve fuel level
C
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated when the fuel level
drops into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
There is only a very small amount of fuel in the fuel tank.
The auxiliary heating cannot be operated.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station without fail.
¸
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the engine air filter is dirty and must
be replaced.
Replace air cleaner X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
!
Vehicles with a diesel engine: there is water in the fuel filter. The
water must be drained off.
Clean the fuel fil‐ X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ter
Z
253
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
254
Display messages
Engine (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The coolant level is too low.
X Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes before doing
so (Y page 303).
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Top up coolant See
Owner's Manual
?
Coolant Stop vehi‐
cle Switch engine
off
The coolant is too hot.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the
engine. Otherwise, there is a risk of engine damage.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
The poly-V-belt may have torn.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Open the bonnet.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the
engine. Otherwise, there is a risk of engine damage.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
?
The fan motor is faulty.
X If the coolant temperature is less than 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving on
mountain roads and stop/start driving.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The battery is not being charged.
A warning tone also sounds.
Possible causes are:
Ra
faulty alternator
torn poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Open the bonnet.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
Ra
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! Do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
4
Check eng. oil
lev. when next
refuelling
8
Reserve fuel level
C
The engine oil level has dropped to a critical level.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the oil level (Y page 302).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 303).
X Have the engine checked for leaks if the engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated when the fuel level
drops into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
There is only a very small amount of fuel in the fuel tank.
The auxiliary heating cannot be operated.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station without fail.
¸
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the engine air filter is dirty and must
be replaced.
Replace air cleaner X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
!
Vehicles with a diesel engine: there is water in the fuel filter. The
water must be drained off.
Clean the fuel fil‐ X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ter
Z
255
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
256
Display messages
Driving systems (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
HOLD
Off
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle is skidding.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 177).
The HOLD function is deactivated. When the brake pedal is firmly
depressed, an activation condition is not fulfilled.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the activation conditions for the HOLD function
(Y page 177).
Cruise ctrl. / LIM
inoperative
Cruise control and SPEEDTRONIC are malfunctioning.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise control
- - - km/h
A condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You have tried to store a speed below 30 km/h, for example.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control
(Y page 162).
120 km/h
120 km/h
Only for certain countries: the maximum speed has been exceeded.
X Drive slower.
Driving systems (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
À
Based on specific criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has determined that
the driver is tired or paying less attention. A warning tone also
sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
Attention Assist:
Drowsiness detec‐
ted
À
Attention Assist
inoperative
During long journeys, take regular breaks in good time so you get
enough rest.
ATTENTION ASSIST has failed.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Speed Limit Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Speed Limit Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
Speed Limit Assist is operational again and the display message
disappears if:
Rvisibility
Rthe
dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
system detects that the camera is fully operational again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Rthe
X
Clean the windscreen.
Speed Limit Assist: Speed Limit Assist is only available in certain countries.
Unavailable in
X Drive on.
this country
Speed Limit Assist is available again when you drive in a country
in which its use is approved.
Speed Limit Assist
inoperative
Speed Limit Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
HOLD
Off
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle is skidding.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 177).
The HOLD function is deactivated. When the brake pedal is firmly
depressed, an activation condition is not fulfilled.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the activation conditions for the HOLD function
(Y page 177).
Radar sensor
deactivated autom.
See Owner's Manual
Vehicles with a navigation system: the vehicle is close to a radio
telescope facility and is therefore prohibited from transmitting any
radar signals. The radar sensor system has switched off automatically (Y page 363).
DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 164) is deactivated automatically if it is
activated. A warning tone also sounds.
Blind Spot Assist (Y page 190) or Active Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 194) is deactivated automatically if it is activated. The
yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist PLUS) (Y page 66) and PRE-SAFE® Brake
(Y page 71) are then also not available.
X Drive on.
Once you have moved far enough away from the radio telescope,
the above functions are available again.
Z
257
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
258
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Vehicles with Becker® MAP PILOT: if the Becker® MAP PILOT is
not connected, the radar sensor system is deactivated automatically.
BAS PLUS, DISTRONIC PLUS, Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind
Spot Assist and PRE-SAFE® Brake are not available.
X
Connect the Becker® MAP PILOT, see the separate operating
instructions.
Radar sensor
deactivated See
Owner's Manual
The radar sensor system is deactivated.
X Check whether or not the radar sensor system may be activated
(Y page 363).
X Switch on the radar sensor system (Y page 226).
Lane Keeping
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual or
Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist cur‐
rently unavailable
See Owner's Manual
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is deactivated
and temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
Rthere are no lane markings for a longer period.
Rthe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, for example by dirt
or snow.
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is operational
again and the display message disappears if:
Rvisibility
Rthe
dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
system detects that the camera is fully operational again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Rthe
X
Lane Keeping
Assist inoperative
or Active Lane
Keeping Assist
inoperative
Clean the windscreen.
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Blind Spot Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual or Active
Blind Spot Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative if:
Ryou
have established the electrical connection between the
trailer and your vehicle.
Rthe sensors are dirty.
Rits function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
Rthe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature
range.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X When towing a trailer, confirm the display message with a.
When driving without a trailer:
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is operational again
and the display message disappears if:
Rthe dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
Rthe system detects that the sensors are fully available again.
Rthe radar sensor system is back within the operating temperature range.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Clean the sensors (Y page 309).
Restart the engine.
Blind Spot Assist
inoperative or
Active Blind Spot
Assist inoperative
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is faulty.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking Guidance
inoperative
Parking Guidance is malfunctioning (Y page 183).
X Restart the engine.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
259
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
260
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Parking Guidance
cancelled
Parking Guidance has been deactivated because:
Rthe
vehicle is skidding.
sensors are dirty.
Ra malfunction has occurred.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate Parking Guidance later (Y page 183).
Rthe
If the parking space symbol does not appear in the multifunction
display at speeds below 30 km/h:
X Clean the sensors (Y page 309).
X Restart the engine.
If the parking space symbol still does not appear in the multifunction display at speeds below 30 km/h:
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking Guidance has been deactivated because you are no longer
following the recommended path.
X Park again and, while doing so, observe the display messages
in the multifunction display.
Parking Guidance
finished
The vehicle is parked. A warning tone also sounds.
The display message disappears automatically.
DISTRONIC PLUS
off
DISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated (Y page 164). If it was
deactivated automatically, a warning tone also sounds.
DISTRONIC PLUS
available again
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 164).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
DISTRONIC PLUS
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated and is temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
DISTRONIC PLUS cover in the radiator grille is dirty.
sensors in the bumpers are dirty.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
Rits function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range.
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again and the display message
disappears if:
Rthe
Rthe
dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
system detects that the sensors are fully available again.
Rthe system is within the operating temperature range.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Rthe
Clean the DISTRONIC PLUS cover in the radiator grille
(Y page 309).
X Clean the bumpers (Y page 309).
X Restart the engine.
X
DISTRONIC PLUS
inoperative
DISTRONIC PLUS is faulty. BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
DISTRONIC PLUS
suspended
You have depressed the accelerator pedal. DISTRONIC PLUS is no
longer controlling the speed of the vehicle.
X Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS
--- km/h
An activation condition for DISTRONIC PLUS is not fulfilled.
X Check the activation conditions for DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 164).
DISTRONIC PLUS and
SPEEDTRONIC
inoperative
DISTRONIC PLUS and SPEEDTRONIC are faulty. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise control and
SPEEDTRONIC
inoperative
Cruise control and SPEEDTRONIC are malfunctioning.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
261
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
262
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Cruise control
--- km/h
A condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You have tried to store a speed below 30 km/h, for example.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control
(Y page 162).
120 km/h
Maximum speed
exceeded
Only for certain countries: the maximum speed has been exceeded.
In addition, the multifunction display shows 120 km/h.
X Drive slower.
Tyres (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
Check
tyres
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant
loss in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, change the wheel
(Y page 344).
X Check the tyre pressures and, if necessary, set to the correct
tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre
pressure is correct (Y page 340).
Check tyres
Restart system
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 340).
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyres (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
Tyre pressure
Check tyres
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant
loss in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, change the wheel
(Y page 344).
X Check the tyre pressures and, if necessary, set to the correct
tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre
pressure is correct (Y page 340).
Check tyre pres‐
sures
then restart Run
Flat Indicator
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 340).
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre pressures
will be displayed
after a few
minutes of driving
The tyre pressure monitor is measuring the tyre pressure.
X Drive on.
The tyre pressures appear in the multifunction display after you
have been driving for a few minutes.
Tyre press. monitor The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
inoperative
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative
No wheel sensors
The wheels fitted do not have a suitable tyre pressure sensor. The
tyre pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Fit wheels with suitable tyre pressure sensors.
The tyre pressure monitor is activated automatically after driving for a few minutes.
Z
263
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
264
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Check
tyre(s)
Caution,
tyre defect
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Correct the tyre pressure (Y page 342).
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 344).
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 344).
Rectify
tyre pressure
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity. If necessary,
correct the tyre pressure (Y page 342).
Wheel sensor(s)
missing
There is no signal from the tyre pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tyre is not displayed in the
multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tyre pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. monitor Due to a source of radio interference, no signals can be received
currently unavail‐ from the wheel sensors. The tyre pressure monitor is temporarily
malfunctioning.
able
X Drive on.
The tyre pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
problem has been solved.
Display messages
h
Tyre pressure Cau‐
tion, tyre malf.
h
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 344).
G Risk of accident
Tyre pressure
Check tyre(s)
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 344).
X Check the tyre pressure. If necessary, correct the tyre pressure
(Y page 342).
h
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity. If necessary,
correct the tyre pressure (Y page 342).
Please correct
tyre pressure
Vehicle (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To start engine,
shift to P or N
You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in
position R or D.
X Shift the transmission to position P or N.
P
Select Park (P)
You have switched off the engine with the Start/Stop button and
opened the driver's door.
You wanted to lock the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
or
You have switched off the engine with the Start/Stop button and
opened the driver's door with the transmission in position N.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
Z
265
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
266
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
With the Hold function activated, you have either:
Ropened
the driver's door and released the seat belt or
off the engine or
Ropened the bonnet
A tone may also sound at regular intervals. The tone becomes
louder if you attempt to lock the vehicle.
You cannot start the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
You can restart the engine.
Rswitched
N
M
The boot lid is open.
X Close the boot lid.
G Risk of accident
Vehicles with an anti-theft alarm system: the bonnet is open. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Close the bonnet.
C
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors.
_
The driver's or front-passenger seat backrest is not engaged. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Push the backrest back until it engages.
Front left seat
backr. not locked
or Front right
seat backr. not
locked
Check trailer
hitch lock
G Risk of accident
Vehicles with a retractable trailer coupling:
The trailer tow hitch is not correctly engaged.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Allow the trailer tow hitch ball coupling to engage in the end
position (Y page 201).
Display messages
Pwr. steering
malfunc.
Top up
washer fluid
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The power steering assistance is faulty. You will need to use more
force to steer.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
X Top up the washer fluid (Y page 304).
Vehicle (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To start engine,
shift to either P
or N
You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in
position R or D.
X Shift the transmission to position P or N.
P
Select Park (P)
You have switched off the engine with the Start/Stop button and
opened the driver's door.
You wanted to lock the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
or
You have switched off the engine with the Start/Stop button and
opened the driver's door with the transmission in position N.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
While the HOLD function or DISTRONIC PLUS is active, you have:
Ropened
the driver's door and released the seat belt or
off the engine or
Ropened the bonnet
A tone may also sound at regular intervals. The tone becomes
louder if you attempt to lock the vehicle.
You cannot start the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
You can restart the engine.
Rswitched
Z
267
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
268
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
N
M
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The boot lid is open.
Close the boot lid.
X
G Risk of accident
The bonnet is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Close the bonnet.
If the active bonnet (pedestrian protection) has been triggered:
X
X
Reset the bonnet (Y page 300).
Close the bonnet.
Active bonnet
malfunction See
Owner's Manual
The active bonnet (pedestrian protection) is not active due to a
malfunction.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
C
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors.
_
The driver's or front-passenger seat backrest is not engaged. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Push the backrest back until it engages.
Front left seat
backrest not locked
or Front right
seat backrest not
locked
j
Check trailer
hitch lock
G Risk of accident
The trailer tow hitch is not correctly engaged.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Allow the trailer tow hitch ball coupling to engage in the end
position (Y page 201).
Display messages
D
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
Power steering mal‐ The power steering assistance is faulty.
You will need to use more force to steer.
function See Own‐
er's Manual
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
&
inoperative Bat‐
tery low
&
inoperative Refuel
vehicle
&
inoperative See
Owner's Man.
Telephone No
Service
The on-board voltage is too low. The auxiliary heating has switched
itself off or cannot be switched on (Y page 128).
X Drive for a longer distance.
The battery is being charged. The auxiliary heating is operational
again as soon as the on-board electrical system voltage is sufficient.
The fuel level in the fuel tank is too low. The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on (Y page 128).
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
The auxiliary heating has a temporary malfunction or is faulty.
X When the vehicle is on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down, make up to four attempts to switch on the auxiliary heating, waiting several minutes between each attempt
(Y page 128).
X If the auxiliary heating does not switch on, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
Your vehicle is outside the network provider's transmitter/
receiver range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol
appears in the multifunction display.
¥
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
Top up washer fluid X
Top up the washer fluid (Y page 304).
Z
269
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
270
Display messages
Key (4-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Key does not
belong to vehicle
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
+
The key needs to be replaced.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Replace key
+
Change battery
Key not detected
(Red display message)
The batteries of the KEYLESS-GO key are discharged.
X Change the batteries (Y page 80).
The KEYLESS-GO key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle
centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Locate the KEYLESS-GO key.
The KEYLESS-GO key is not detected while the engine is running
because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
Key not detected
(White display message)
The KEYLESS-GO key cannot be detected at present.
X Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
If the KEYLESS-GO key is still not detected:
Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
X Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
X
+
Key still in vehi‐
cle
The KEYLESS-GO key has been detected inside the vehicle during
locking.
X Remove the KEYLESS-GO key from the vehicle.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
KEYLESS-GO is temporarily malfunctioning or is defective. A warning tone also sounds.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired
position.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Insert key
Close doors
to lock veh.
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors and lock the vehicle again.
Key (12-button multifunction steering wheel)
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
Key does not
belong to vehicle
Â
Replace key
Â
Change key batter‐
ies
Â
Key not detected
(Red display message)
The key needs to be replaced.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The batteries of the KEYLESS-GO key are discharged.
X Change the batteries (Y page 80).
The KEYLESS-GO key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle
centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Locate the KEYLESS-GO key.
The KEYLESS-GO key is not detected while the engine is running
because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
Z
271
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
272
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
The KEYLESS-GO key cannot be detected at present.
X Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
Key not detected
(White display message)
If the KEYLESS-GO key is still not detected:
Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
X Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
X
Â
Key still in vehi‐
cle
Â
Remove starting
button, then
insert key
Â
Close doors to
lock vehicle
The KEYLESS-GO key has been detected inside the vehicle during
locking.
X Remove the KEYLESS-GO key from the vehicle.
KEYLESS-GO is temporarily malfunctioning or is defective. A warning tone also sounds.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired
position.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors and lock the vehicle again.
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Seat belt
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
7
Only for certain countries: the red seat belt
warning lamp lights up
for six seconds after
the engine starts.
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger
to fasten their seat belts.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 51).
7
G Risk of injury
Only for certain coun- The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
tries: the red seat belt
warning lamp lights up X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 51).
The warning tone ceases.
after the engine starts.
In addition, a warning
tone sounds for up to
six seconds.
7
G Risk of injury
The red seat belt warn- The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
ing lamp lights up after
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 51).
the engine starts, as
The warning lamp goes out.
soon as the driver's or
the front-passenger
G Risk of injury
door is closed.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out.
Z
273
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
274
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
7
G Risk of injury
The red seat belt warn- The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt. At
ing lamp flashes and an the same time, you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly
intermittent audible
driven faster than 25 km/h.
warning sounds.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 51).
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
G Risk of injury
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. At the same time,
you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster
than 25 km/h.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
Safety systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
J
G Risk of accident
The red brake system There is insufficient brake fluid in the fluid reservoir.
warning lamp comes on
while the engine is run- X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
ning. A warning tone
under any circumstances.
also sounds.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the error.
!
G Risk of accident
The yellow ABS warning ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) has been deactivated due to a fault.
lamp is lit while the
For this reason, BAS (Brake Assist), BAS PLUS, ESP® (Electronic
engine is running.
Stability Program), PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP® trailer
stabilisation are also deactivated, for example.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If the ABS control unit is faulty, there is also a possibility that other
systems, such as the navigation system or the automatic transmission, will not be available.
Z
275
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
276
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
G Risk of accident
The yellow ABS warning
ABS is temporarily unavailable. Therefore, BAS, BAS PLUS, ESP®,
lamp is lit while the
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), PRE-SAFE®,
engine is running.
PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive
brake lights and ESP® trailer stabilisation, for example, are also
deactivated.
Self diagnosis is not yet complete.
or
For example, the on-board voltage may be insufficient.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
!
The yellow ABS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running. A
warning tone also
sounds.
G Risk of accident
EBD is faulty. Therefore, ABS, BAS, BAS PLUS, ESP®, PRE-SAFE®,
PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist, the adaptive
brake lights and ESP® trailer stabilisation, for example, are not
available either.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Problem
J֌!
The red brake warning
lamp, the yellow ESP®
and ESP® OFF warning
lamps and the yellow
ABS warning lamp are
lit while the engine is
running.
÷
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ABS and ESP® are malfunctioning. Therefore, BAS, BAS PLUS,
EBD, PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start
assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP® trailer stabilisation, for
example, are not available either due to a malfunction.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
The yellow ESP® warn- ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of
ing lamp flashes while skidding or at least one wheel has started to spin.
the vehicle is in motion.
Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when
pulling away.
X Release the accelerator pedal while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Vehicles with a 12-button multifunction steering wheel only: do
not deactivate ESP®.
For exceptions: (Y page 67).
å
G Risk of accident
Vehicles with a 12-butESP® and ESP® trailer stabilisation are deactivated. ESP® will not
ton multifunction steerstabilise the vehicle if it starts to skid or if a wheel starts to spin.
ing wheel only:
X Reactivate ESP®.
The yellow ESP® OFF
Exceptions: (Y page 67).
warning lamp is lit while
X
Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
the engine is running.
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X
Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
277
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
278
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Problem
M
AMG vehicles only:
The yellow SPORT handling mode warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
SPORT handling mode is activated. ESP® only stabilises the vehicle in extreme situations. ESP® intervention may not be able to
provide sufficient assistance in such situations and the vehicle
may start to skid.
X
Reactivate ESP®.
For exceptions: (Y page 67).
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ESP®, BAS, BAS PLUS, PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD
function, hill start assist, the adaptive brake lights and ESP® trailer
stabilisation are not available due to a malfunction. ESP® will not
stabilise the vehicle if it starts to skid or if a wheel starts to spin.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Problem
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function, hill start assist and
ESP® trailer stabilisation are temporarily not available.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
ESP® is temporarily unavailable. ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle
if it starts to skid or if a wheel starts to spin.
Self diagnosis is not yet complete.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
J
You are driving with the parking brake applied.
The red brake system X Release the parking brake.
warning lamp comes on
The warning lamp goes out and the warning tone ceases.
while the vehicle is
moving. A warning tone
also sounds.
6
The red SRS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
G Risk of injury
The restraint systems are malfunctioning. The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of
an accident, not be triggered at all.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
279
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
280
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
There may be a fault, for example:
The yellow engine diag- Rin the engine management
nostics warning lamp
Rin the fuel injection system
lights up while the
Rin the exhaust system
engine is running.
Rin the ignition system (for vehicles with petrol engines)
Rin the fuel system
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may
be running in emergency mode.
X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the fuel tank has been run dry
(Y page 157).
X Start the engine three to four times after refuelling.
If the yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp goes out, emergency running mode is cancelled. The vehicle need not be
checked.
8
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
The yellow reserve fuel Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated when the fuel level
warning lamp lights up drops into the reserve range.
while the engine is run- X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
ning.
?
The red coolant warning lamp lights up while
the engine is running
and the coolant temperature gauge is at the
start of the scale.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is
faulty.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a
risk of engine damage if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running.
The coolant level is too low.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator
may be blocked or the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Let the engine and coolant cool down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant (Y page 303).
Observe the warning notes as you do so.
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X If the coolant temperature is less than 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving on
mountain roads and stop-start traffic.
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running. A warning tone
also sounds.
The coolant temperature has exceeded 120 †. The airflow to the
engine radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be too
low.
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine.
X Let the engine and coolant cool down.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant (Y page 303).
Observe the warning notes as you do so.
X If you have to top up the coolant frequently, have the engine
cooling system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by frozen slush.
X If the coolant temperature is less than 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving on
mountain roads and stop-start traffic.
Z
281
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
282
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Driving systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
G Risk of accident
The red distance warn- The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed
ing lamp lights up while selected.
the vehicle is in motion.
X Increase the distance.
·
G Risk of accident
The red distance warn- The warning is issued if you approach a stationary vehicle or a
ing lamp lights up while vehicle driving ahead of you at too high a speed.
the vehicle is in motion.
X Be prepared to brake immediately.
A warning tone also
X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to
sounds.
brake or take evasive action.
More information about DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 164) and
PRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 71).
Tyres
Problem
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp is on.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at
least one of the tyres.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Check the tyre pressure. If necessary, correct the tyre pressure
(Y page 342).
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 344).
283
284
284
284
289
Stowing and features
Useful information ............................
Loading guidelines ............................
Stowage areas ..................................
Features .............................................
284
Stowage areas
Useful information
Stowing and features
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
Loading guidelines
G WARNING
Secure and position the load as described in
the loading guidelines.
Otherwise, vehicle occupants could
be injured by the load being thrown around in
the event of sharp braking, a sudden change
in direction or an accident.
You will find further information in the "Securing a load" section.
Even if you follow all the loading guidelines,
the load will increase the risk of injury in the
event of an accident.
G WARNING
Keep the boot lid closed while the vehicle is
in operation. Otherwise, you could be poisoned by exhaust fumes entering the vehicle.
The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle are dependent on the distribution of the
load within the vehicle. For this reason, you
should observe the following notes when
transporting a load:
Rwhen transporting a load, never exceed the
maximum permissible gross vehicle weight
or the permissible axle loads for the vehicle
(including occupants).
Rposition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the boot as possible.
Rthe load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the seat backrests.
Ralways place the load against the rear or
front seat backrests. Make sure that the
seat backrests are securely locked into
place.
Ralways place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
Rsecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant lashing material. pad sharp
edges for protection.
i Load restraints are available at any qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Stowage areas
Stowage compartments
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The stowage compartments must be closed
when items are stored in them. Luggage nets
are not designed to secure heavy items of
luggage.
You or other vehicle occupants could be
injured by objects being thrown around if you:
Rbrake sharply
Rchange direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
Sharp-edged and fragile objects must not be
placed in the luggage net.
Do not place hard objects in the map pockets.
Objects must not protrude from the map
pockets.
Stowage areas
Glove compartment
i The glove compartment can be ventilated
(Y page 133).
Stowage compartment in the centre console
X
To open: pull handle : and open glove
compartment flap ;.
X To close: fold glove compartment flap ;
upwards until it engages.
X
The glove compartment can only be locked
and unlocked using the emergency key element.
To lock: insert the emergency key element
into the lock and turn it 90° clockwise to
position 2.
X To unlock: insert the emergency key element into the lock and turn it 90° anticlockwise to position 1.
To open: slide cover : back.
Stowage compartment/telephone compartment under the armrest
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment, a
USB port and an AUX IN connection or a
Media Interface are installed in the stowage compartment. A Media Interface is a
universal interface for portable audio
equipment, e.g. for an iPod® or USB device
(see the separate Audio or COMAND APS
operating instructions).
X
X
To open: press left-hand button ; or righthand button :.
The stowage compartment opens.
Luggage nets
G WARNING
Only place lightweight objects in the luggage
net. Do not use it to transport heavy, sharpedged or fragile objects. The luggage net canZ
Stowing and features
Front stowage compartments
285
286
Stowage areas
moves forward slightly, when necessary, in
order to avoid contact.
not secure the objects sufficiently in the event
of an accident.
Stowing and features
Luggage nets are located in the frontpassenger footwell and on the left-hand side
of the boot.
Through-loading facility in the rear
bench seat
Important safety notes
Vehicles without memory function: if necessary, move the driver's or frontpassenger seat forwards.
X Open the boot.
X Pull right-hand or left-hand rear seat backrest release handle :.
The corresponding rear seat backrest is
released.
X
G WARNING
Do not carry heavy or hard objects inside the
vehicle or in the boot unless they are secured.
Otherwise, you and other vehicle occupants
could be injured by objects being thrown
around the vehicle in the event of sharp braking, a sudden change in direction or an accident.
G WARNING
Always drive with the boot lid closed. Exhaust
fumes could otherwise enter the vehicle interior.
The left-hand and right-hand rear seat backrests can be folded down separately to
increase the boot capacity.
X
X
Fold rear seat backrest ; forwards.
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
Folding back the seat backrest
Folding the seat backrest forwards
X
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
i Vehicles with memory function: when you
fold one or both parts of the rear seat backrest forwards, the respective front seat
become trapped when folding the rear seat
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.
Stowage areas
Fold rear seat backrest : back until it
engages.
G WARNING
Make sure that the rear seat backrest is correctly engaged. Otherwise, vehicle occupants
could be injured by objects being thrown
around if you:
Rbrake sharply
Rchange direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
If the rear seat backrest is not engaged, this
will be shown in the multifunction display in
the instrument cluster.
i You should always engage the rear seat
backrests if you do not need the throughloading feature. This will prevent unauthorised access to the boot from the vehicle
interior.
X
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
Securing a load
Lashing eyelets
G WARNING
Distribute the load on the lashing eyelets
evenly.
Otherwise, vehicle occupants could be
injured by objects being thrown around if you:
Rdo not route lashing materials across sharp
edges or corners.
sharp edges for protection.
There are four lashing eyelets in the boot.
Rpad
Vehicle with through-loading feature in the rear
bench seat
: Lashing eyelets
Bag hook
G WARNING
Only hang light loads on the bag holders. Do
not use them to transport heavy, sharp-edged
or fragile objects. When braking sharply,
changing direction quickly or in the event of
an accident, the bag hooks will not secure the
items sufficiently. This could result in injury to
yourself or others.
! The bag hook can bear a maximum load
of 5 kg. Do not use it to secure a load.
Rbrake
sharply
direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
Please observe the loading guidelines.
Rchange
Observe the following notes on securing
loads:
Rsecure
the load using the lashing eyelets.
not use elastic straps or nets to secure
a load, as these are only intended as an
anti-slip protection for light loads.
Rdo
: Bag hook
Z
Stowing and features
X
287
Stowage areas
288
Stowage well under the boot floor
Stowing and features
The TIREFIT kit, the vehicle tool kit, etc. are
located in the stowage compartment.
The roof load raises the vehicle's centre of
gravity, thereby affecting vehicle handling.
You must always observe the maximum roof
load of 100 kg. Always adapt your driving style
to the prevailing road, traffic and weather
conditions and drive with particular care if the
roof is laden.
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
X
To open: pull handle : upwards.
only use roof carriers that have been tested
and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
This helps to prevent damage to the vehicle.
Position the load on the roof carrier in such
a way that the vehicle will not sustain damage even when it is in motion.
Depending on the vehicle equipment,
ensure that when the roof carrier is fitted
you can:
Ropen
Ropen
the panorama sliding sunroof fully
the boot lid fully
Attaching the roof carrier
X
Hook handle : into rain trough ;.
! Remove the handle again before closing
the boot lid and snap it in tightly to prevent
the handle flap from protruding. Otherwise,
you could damage the handle.
Roof carrier
Important safety notes
G WARNING
An incorrectly secured roof carrier, ski rack or
load could become detached from the vehicle. These objects might then be thrown
around and could injure you or others or
cause an accident. Follow the roof carrier/ski
rack manufacturer's installation instructions
and special instructions for use.
Vehicles with a steel roof
Features
289
Stowing and features
Cup holder in the front-compartment
centre console
Vehicles with a panorama sliding sunroof
Open covers : carefully in the direction of
the arrow.
X Fold covers : upwards.
X Only secure the roof carrier to the anchorage points under covers :.
X Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
X
: Cup holders
; Cover
X
To open: slide cover ; back.
Removing and fitting the cup holder
Removing
Features
Cup holders
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Keep the cup holder closed while the vehicle
is in motion. Otherwise, vehicle occupants
could be injured by objects being thrown
around if you:
Rbrake sharply
Rchange direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
Only use the cup holders for containers of a
suitable size and which have lids. Otherwise,
the drinks could spill.
Cup holders should not be used for hot drinks.
Otherwise, you may scald yourself.
Pry groove ; away carefully on the frontpassenger side using a suitable tool until
lug = becomes visible.
X Pull the cup holder upwards slightly, to the
stop.
X Pry groove : away carefully on the driver's
side using a suitable tool. At the same time,
pull the cup holder upwards slightly, to the
stop.
X Pry groove on driver's side : and frontpassenger side ; away alternately while
lifting the cup holder upwards until it can
be removed.
X
Z
Features
290
Stowing and features
Fitting
: Mirror light
Insert left-hand and right-hand grooves ;
of the cup holder into lateral springs =.
Insert the cup holder so that the wedge of
the upper section of cup holder : faces
forwards.
X Press the cup holder downwards until it
engages on the front-passenger side.
X
Cup holder in the rear stowage box
; Bracket
= Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
? Vanity mirror
A Mirror cover
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover
A has been folded up.
Glare from the side
Fold down the sun visor.
Pull the sun visor out of retainer ;.
X Swing the sun visor to the side.
X
X
Ashtray
X
To open: slide cover : forwards.
Ashtray in the front-compartment
centre console
i You can remove the ashtray insert and
Sun visors
Sun visor overview
G WARNING
Keep the mirrors in the sun visors covered
while driving. You could otherwise be dazzled,
which may impair your view of traffic conditions and as a result could cause an accident.
use the resulting compartment for stowage.
! The stowage space under the ashtray is
not heat resistant. Before placing lit cigarettes in the ashtray, make sure that the
ashtray is properly engaged. Otherwise, the
stowage space could be damaged.
Features
291
Cigarette lighter
G WARNING
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X To remove the insert: hold insert = by
the ribbing at the sides and lift it up ; and
out.
X To refit the insert: press insert = into the
holder until it engages.
X To close: press cover : briefly at the
front.
The cover moves back.
X
Ashtray in the rear-compartment centre
console
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X To close: press cover : briefly at the
front.
The cover moves back.
X
12 V sockets
Points to observe before use
To open: pull cover ; out by its top edge.
X To remove the insert: press release button = and lift the insert up and out.
X To fit the insert: fit insert : from above
into the holder and press down into the
holder until it engages.
X
The sockets can be used for accessories, e.g.
lamps or mobile phone chargers with a maximum current draw of 180 W (15 A).
If you use the sockets for long periods when
the engine is switched off, the battery may
discharge.
i You can also use the sockets when the
ignition is switched off. An emergency cutout ensures that the on-board voltage does
not drop too low. If the on-board voltage is
too low, the power to the sockets is autoZ
Stowing and features
Only hold the hot cigarette lighter by its knob.
Otherwise, you might burn yourself.
Make sure that children travelling in the vehicle are not able to injure themselves on the
hot cigarette lighter or cause a fire with it.
Features
292
matically cut. This ensures that there is sufficient power to start the engine.
Stowing and features
Socket in the front-compartment centre
console
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X To close: press cover : briefly at the
front.
The cover moves back.
X
Socket in the rear-compartment centre
console
A socket is fitted in the centre console in the
rear compartment in vehicles with an ashtray
and a cigarette lighter.
Mobile phone
Important notes
G WARNING
Observe the legal requirements of the country
in which you are currently driving regarding
operating mobile communications equipment
in a vehicle.
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in
motion, you must only do so if the traffic situation permits. Otherwise, you could be distracted from the traffic conditions, cause an
accident and injure yourself and others.
Two-way radios and fax equipment used without low-reflection exterior aerials can interfere with the vehicle's electronics and thereby
jeopardise the operating safety of the vehicle
and your safety. Therefore, you must only use
this equipment if it is correctly connected to
a separate reflection-free exterior aerial.
G WARNING
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and the
health of others. Using an exterior aerial takes
into account current scientific discussions
relating to the possible health risk posed by
electromagnetic fields.
Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of an
approved exterior aerial. This ensures:
Roptimal
mobile phone reception quality in
the vehicle
Rmutual influences between the vehicle
electronics and mobile phones are minimised
An exterior aerial has the following advantages:
Pull cover ; out by its top edge.
X Lift up the cover of socket :.
X
Rit conducts the electromagnetic fields gen-
erated by a wireless device to the exterior.
field strength in the vehicle interior is
lower than in a vehicle that does not have
an exterior aerial.
Rthe
Features
that may be fitted to your vehicle; in some
cases, these are country-specific.
i Even if your vehicle is equppied with convenience telephony, you can connect a
Bluetooth®-capable mobile phone with
Audio 20 or COMAND Online via the Bluetooth® interface.
More information on suitable mobile phones,
mobile phone brackets and on connecting
Bluetooth®-capable mobile phones with
Audio 20 or COMAND Online can be obtained:
Rat
your Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
the Internet at http://www.mercedesbenz.com/connect
Ron
Operating the mobile phone
You can operate the telephone using the
6 and ~ buttons on the luxury multifunction steering wheel. You can operate
other mobile phone functions via the onboard computer (Y page 219).
When you take the key out of the ignition lock,
the mobile phone stays on but you can no
longer use the hands-free system.
If you are making a call and you would like to
take the key out of the ignition lock, first
remove the mobile phone from the bracket.
Otherwise, the call will be ended.
i When a mobile phone bracket is used that
is connected to the mobile phone via Bluetooth®: if you want to continue a call in
"Private mode", you have to perform the
necessary steps on the mobile phone (see
the separate mobile phone operating
instructions).
i The functions and services available when
you use the phone depend on your mobile
phone model and service provider.
Inserting the mobile phone
Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 285).
X Place the mobile phone bracket into the
pre-installed bracket (see the separate
mobile phone bracket installation instructions).
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket (see the separate mobile
phone bracket installation instructions).
X
You can fold the pre-installed bracket up to
improve access to the stowage space
beneath it. Depending on the vehicle's equipment, there is a USB connection and an AUXIN connection/Media Interface fitted in the
stowage compartment (Y page 285).
If the mobile phone is inserted in the mobile
phone bracket, you can speak to the person
you are calling using the hands-free system.
i On some mobile phone brackets, first you
have to connect the mobile phone via Bluetooth® with a mobile phone bracket (see
the separate operating instructions for the
mobile phone bracket).
On these mobile phone brackets, the
mobile phone does not have to be inserted
into the bracket for you to be able to use
the telephone functions. In this case, the
charging function and aerial function are
not available.
To fold the bracket up: press button :.
X To fold the bracket down: press the
bracket down and allow it to engage.
X
Z
Stowing and features
i There are various mobile phone brackets
293
294
Features
Garage door opener
Important safety notes
The HomeLink® garage door opener integrated in the rear-view mirror allows you to operate up to three different door and gate systems.
Stowing and features
i The garage door opener is only available
for certain countries. Observe the legal
requirements in each country.
The HomeLink® garage door opener is
compatible with most European garage and
gate opener drives. More information on
HomeLink® and/or compatible products is
available from:
Rany Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
Rthe HomeLink® hotline
(0) 08000 466 354 65 (free of charge) or
+49 (0) 6838 907 277 (charges apply)
Ron the Internet at:
http://www.homelink.com
Programming the integrated garage
door opener in the rear-view mirror
Programming
G WARNING
Only press the transmitter button on the integrated garage door opener if there are no persons or objects present within the sweep of
the garage door. Persons could otherwise be
injured as the door moves.
Garage door remote control A is not part of
this integrated garage door opener.
i To achieve the best results, insert new
batteries in garage door remote control
A before programming.
Before programming for the first time, clear
the memory of the integrated garage door
opener (Y page 296).
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press and hold one of transmitter buttons ; to ? on the integrated garage door
opener.
After a short time, indicator lamp : starts
flashing yellow.
i Indicator lamp : flashes yellow immediately the first time that the transmitter button is programmed. If this transmitter button has already been programmed, indicator lamp : only starts flashing yellow after
10 seconds have elapsed.
X
Release the transmitter button.
Point transmitter button B of garage door
remote control A towards the transmitter
buttons on the rear-view mirror at a distance of 5 to 20 cm.
i The required distance between garage
door remote control A and the integrated
door opener depends on the garage door
drive system. You might require several
attempts. You should test every position for
at least 25 seconds before trying another
position.
X
X
Press and hold transmitter button B on
garage door remote control A until indicator lamp : lights up green.
The programming has been successful if
indicator lamp : lights up or flashes
green.
X Release transmitter button ;, = or ? on
the integrated garage door opener and the
transmitter button on garage door remote
control B.
X
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
If indicator lamp : lights up red:
X
Repeat the programming procedure for the
transmitter buttons. When doing so, vary
the distance between the garage door drive
remote control and the rear-view mirror.
i If the indicator lamp flashes green after
successful programming, the garage door
system is using a rolling code. After programming, you must synchronise the
garage door opener integrated in the rearview mirror with the receiver of the garage
door system.
Synchronising the rolling code
Your vehicle must be within reach of the
garage or gate opener drive. Make sure that
neither your vehicle nor any persons/objects
are present within the sweep of the door or
gate.
Observe the safety notes when performing
the rolling code synchronisation.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the programming button of the door
or gate drive (see the door or gate drive
operating instructions, e.g. under "Programming of additional remote controls").
i Usually, you now have 30 seconds to initiate the next step.
X
Press the previously programmed button of
the integrated HomeLink® garage door
opener repeatedly until the door starts to
move.
The rolling code synchronisation is then
complete.
Problems when programming
If you have problems when programming the
integrated garage door opener, please note
the following:
Rcheck
the transmitter frequency of garage
door remote control A (this can usually be
found on the rear of the remote control).
Rchange the batteries in garage door remote
control A. This increases the likelihood
that garage door remote control A will
send a strong and precise signal to the
integrated remote control in the rear-view
mirror.
Rwhen programming, hold garage door
remote control A at different distances
and angles from the transmitter button that
you are programming. Try various angles at
a distance of between 5 and 30 cm or the
same angle but varying distances.
Rif there is another remote control for the
same garage door drive, perform the programming steps again using this remote
control. Before performing these steps,
make sure that new batteries have been
fitted in the garage door drive remote control.
Rnote that some remote controls transmit
only for a limited period (the indicator lamp
on the remote control goes out). Press the
button on the remote control again before
transmission ends.
Ralign the aerial cable of the garage door
opener unit. This can improve signal reception/transmission.
Opening or closing the garage door
Once programmed, the integrated garage
door opener will assume the function of the
garage door system's remote control. Please
also read the operating instructions for the
garage door system.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press overhead control panel transmitter
button ;, = or ? that you have programmed to operate the garage door.
Garage door system with a fixed code: indicator lamp : lights up green.
Garage door system with a rolling code:
indicator lamp : flashes green.
i The transmitter will transmit a signal for
as long as the transmitter button is
pressed. The transmission is halted after a
maximum of 10 seconds, and indicator
Z
295
Stowing and features
Features
Features
296
lamp : flashes yellow. Press the transmitter button again, if necessary.
Clearing the memory of the integrated
garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press transmitter buttons ; and ?.
The indicator lamp lights up yellow.
X Press and hold transmitter buttons ;
and ? until the indicator lamp turns green.
Stowing and features
X
i Make sure that you clear the memory of
the integrated garage door opener before
selling the vehicle.
Features
297
Frequencies for the garage door opener
The radio type approval number and the frequency range for the garage door opener can be
found on the Internet at: http://www.mercedes-benz.de/betriebsanleitung.
Floormat on the driver's side
G WARNING
Stowing and features
Make sure that there is sufficient clearance
around the pedals when floormats are used,
and that the floormats are properly secured.
The floormats must be correctly secured at all
times using retainers and press-studs.
Before you drive off, check the floormats and
secure if necessary. A floormat which is not
properly secured can slip and, thereby, interfere with the movement of the pedals.
Do not place floormats on top of one another.
Slide the seat backwards.
To fit: place the floormat in the footwell.
X Press studs : onto retainers ;.
X
X
To remove: pull the floormat off retainers ;.
X Remove the floormat.
X
Retrofitted anti-glare film
Anti-glare film retrofitted to the inside of the
windows can interfere with radio/mobile
phone reception. This is particularly the case
for conductive or metallic-coated films. Information about anti-glare film can be obtained
from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Z
298
299
300
300
305
306
Maintenance and care
Useful information ............................
Engine compartment ........................
Maintenance ......................................
Care ....................................................
300
Engine compartment
Useful information
! Do not try to press down the raised bonnet at the back. Otherwise, the bonnet
could be damaged.
Maintenance and care
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
Engine compartment
Bonnet
Active bonnet (pedestrian protection)
Operating principle
i The active bonnet is only available in certain countries.
The active bonnet can reduce the risk of injury
to pedestrians in certain accident situations.
Raising the active bonnet increases the clearance to hard components, such as the engine.
Even if the active bonnet has been triggered,
you can still continue driving and have it reset
at a qualified specialist workshop. If you pull
the bonnet release lever, you must reset the
bonnet before driving on.
G WARNING
If you pull the bonnet release lever and then
neglect to reset the bonnet, it will not lock at
the front when closed. The bonnet can then
open when the vehicle is in motion and
obscure your field of vision. If you pull the
bonnet release lever, you must reset the bonnet before driving on.
Resetting
G WARNING
There is a risk of injury if the bonnet is open,
even if the engine is not running.
Some engine components can become very
hot.
To avoid the risk of burns, only touch those
components described in the Owner's Manual
and observe the relevant safety notes.
X
If active bonnet : has been triggered, it is
raised at the back by about 50 mm. Then,
lids ; no longer rest on housings =.
You can reset a triggered active bonnet yourself.
Open the bonnet (Y page 301).
Lift up the bonnet in centre A with both
hands until the two lids of bonnet lifter ;
no longer move.
If you push the lids back, you will notice a
resistance.
X Release bonnet :.
X
Engine compartment
If you cannot close bonnet : or the L
symbol appears in the multifunction display,
repeat the steps.
G WARNING
If the bonnet can still not be engaged properly
or the L symbol appears in the multifunction display, do not continue driving. The bonnet can then open when the vehicle is in
motion and obscure your field of vision. Consult a qualified specialist workshop. Otherwise, you may cause an accident and injure
yourself and others.
Opening the bonnet
G WARNING
Do not pull the release lever while the vehicle
is in motion. If you do so, the bonnet may open
up and block your view.
G WARNING
There is a risk of injury if the bonnet is open,
even if the engine is not running.
Some engine components can become very
hot.
To avoid the risk of burns, only touch those
components described in the Owner's Manual
and observe the relevant safety notes.
G WARNING
The radiator fan between the radiator and the
engine can start automatically, even if the key
has been removed from the ignition lock. For
this reason, you must not reach into the fan
rotation area. You could otherwise be injured.
Vehicles with a petrol engine: The electronic ignition system uses high voltage. For
this reason, you must never touch ignition
system components (ignition coil, ignition
cables, spark plug connectors or test socket)
while:
Rthe
engine is running
engine is being started
Rthe ignition is switched on and the engine
is being cranked by hand
You could otherwise suffer an electric shock
and be seriously or even fatally injured.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: The electronic injection control uses high voltage. For
this reason, you must never touch injection
system components while:
Rthe
Rthe
engine is running
engine is being started
Rthe ignition is switched on
You could otherwise suffer an electric shock
and be seriously or even fatally injured.
Rthe
X
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
G WARNING
The windscreen wipers and wiper linkage
could be set in motion.
When the bonnet is open, you or others could
be injured by the wiper linkage.
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off. Remove the key or make sure
that no ignition position has been selected
with KEYLESS-GO. All indicator lamps must be
off in the instrument panel.
Z
Maintenance and care
Check whether the lids of bonnet lifter ;
are resting on housings = (arrow).
X The lids of bonnet lifter ; are resting
on the housings: close bonnet :
(Y page 302).
or
X The lids of bonnet lifter ; are not resting on the housings: first lift up bonnet : on left-hand side ? and then on
right-hand side B. Lift up bonnet : until
the respective lid of bonnet lifter ; no longer moves.
The lids of bonnet lifter ; must rest on
housings = (arrow).
X Close bonnet :(Y page 302).
X
301
Engine compartment
302
Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a
height of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Open it again and close
it with a little more force.
X
Maintenance and care
Engine oil
X
Pull release lever : on the bonnet.
The bonnet is released.
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
not folded away from the windscreen. Otherwise, you could damage the windscreen
wipers or the bonnet.
Notes on the oil level
Depending on driving style, the vehicle consumes a maximum of 0.8 l oil per 1000 km.
The oil consumption may be higher than this
when the vehicle is new or if you frequently
drive at high engine speeds.
Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may
be installed at a different location.
When checking the oil level:
Rpark
the vehicle on a level surface.
engine should be switched off for
approximately five minutes if the engine is
at normal operating temperature.
Rthe
X
Reach into the gap, pull bonnet catch handle ; up and lift the bonnet.
If you lift the bonnet by approximately
40 cm, the bonnet is opened and held open
automatically by the gas-filled strut.
Closing the bonnet
G WARNING
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
as you close the bonnet.
Example: vehicles with a petrol engine
Engine compartment
303
Turn cap : anti-clockwise and remove it.
X Top up with the amount of oil required.
X
Fill carefully to the maximum mark on the oil
dipstick.
i Depending on the engine, the difference
between the minimum mark and the maximum mark is approximately 1.5 – 2 litres.
Example: vehicles with a diesel engine
Pull oil dipstick : out of the oil dipstick
tube.
X Wipe off oil dipstick :.
X Slowly slide oil dipstick : into the guide
tube to the stop, and take it out again.
The oil level is correct if the level is between
MIN mark = and MAX mark ;.
X Top up the oil if necessary.
X
Adding engine oil
H Environmental note
When topping up the oil, take care not to spill
any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is
harmful to the environment.
G WARNING
If engine oil comes into contact with hot
engine parts, it may ignite and you could burn
yourself. Do not spill any engine oil on hot
engine parts.
above the "max" mark on the dipstick, too
much oil has been added. This can lead to
damage to the engine or the catalytic converter. Have excess oil siphoned off.
For further information on engine oil, see
(Y page 355).
X Replace cap : on the filler neck and
tighten clockwise.
Ensure that the cap locks into place
securely.
Checking and adding other service
products
Checking the coolant level
Only check the coolant level when the vehicle
is on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down.
X Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 137) in
the ignition lock.
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button twice (Y page 137).
X Check the coolant temperature display in
the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The cooling system is pressurised. Therefore,
only unscrew the cap once the engine has
cooled down. The coolant temperature gauge
must display less than 70 † . Otherwise, you
could be scalded if hot coolant escapes.
Example: engine oil cap
Z
Maintenance and care
! Do not add too much oil. If the oil level is
Engine compartment
304
RMB-Freigabe
(e.g. MB-Freigabe 371.0)
(e.g. MB-Approval 371.0)
Other labels and recommendations that
make reference to quality level or a specification according to an MB Sheet no. (e.g.
MB 371.0) are not necessarily approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
You can obtain further information from
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Maintenance and care
RMB-Approval
Slowly turn cap : half a turn anti-clockwise and allow excess pressure to escape.
X Turn cap : further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar
= in the filler neck when cold, there is
enough coolant in coolant expansion
tank ;.
If the coolant level is approximately 1.5 cm
above marker bar = in the filler neck when
warm, there is enough coolant in coolant
expansion tank ;.
X If necessary, top up with coolant that has
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
X
G WARNING
Windscreen washer fluid is highly flammable.
Fire, naked flames and smoking are prohibited when handling washer fluid concentrate.
! Only use washer fluid concentrate which
is suitable for plastic lamp lenses. Unsuitable washer fluid concentrate could damage the plastic lamp lenses of the headlamps.
! Do not use distilled or de-ionised water in
the washer fluid reservoir. Otherwise, the
level sensor may be damaged.
i Add windscreen washer concentrate, e.g.
MB SummerFit, to the washer fluid all year
round.
For further information on coolant, see
(Y page 356).
Windscreen washer system and headlamp cleaning system
The washer fluid reservoir is used for both the
windscreen washer system and the headlamp
cleaning system.
i Components and service products must
be matched. Mercedes-Benz recommends
that you use products tested and approved
by Mercedes-Benz. They are listed in this
Mercedes-Benz Owner's Manual in the
appropriate section.
You can identify service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on the container:
Example: washer fluid reservoir
Mix the windscreen washer fluid in a container beforehand.
X At temperatures above freezing: fill the
washer fluid reservoir with a mix of water
and windscreen washer concentrate (e.g.
MB SummerFit).
X At temperatures below freezing: fill the
washer fluid reservoir with a mix of water
X
Maintenance
Maintenance
ASSYST PLUS service interval display
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
X
or
X
Subtract the battery disconnection periods
from the service date shown on the display
after reconnecting the battery.
i The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not show any information on the
engine oil level. Observe the notes on the
engine oil level (Y page 302).
Service messages
Information on the type of service and service
intervals (see separate Service Booklet).
You can obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you when the next service is due.
The multifunction display shows a service
message for a few seconds, e.g.:
Next service A due in .. days
Service A due
Service A overdue by ... days
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major
service. A number or another letter may be
displayed after the letter. This figure indicates
any necessary additional maintenance work
to be performed.
If you report this displayed information to a
qualified specialist workshop, for example a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, they can
inform you of the costs the service will incur.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not take into account any periods of
time during which the battery is disconnected.
Note down the service due date displayed
in the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
Hiding a service message
4-button multifunction steering wheel:
press C.
X 12-button multifunction steering
wheel: press % or a.
X
Displaying service messages
X
Switch the ignition on.
4-button multifunction steering wheel
X Use V to select the Service menu.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
12-button multifunction steering wheel
X Press the = or ; button to select the
Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
ASSYST PLUS submenu and confirm by
pressing the a button.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
Please bear the following in mind
Resetting the ASSYST PLUS service interval display
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
Z
Maintenance and care
and windscreen washer concentrate (e.g.
MB WinterFit). Adapt the mixing ratio to the
outside temperatures.
X To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
X Top up with the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
305
306
Care
ASSYST PLUS service interval display after
the service work has been carried out.
You can obtain further information, e.g.
regarding service work, from a MercedesBenz Service Centre or directly from
Mercedes-Benz.
Maintenance and care
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval dis-
play has been inadvertently reset, this setting can be corrected at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Have service work carried out as described
in the Service Booklet. This may otherwise
lead to increased wear and damage to the
major assemblies or the vehicle.
Driving abroad
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network
is also available in other countries. The
Service Hotline's current telephone numbers
for use when you are abroad are to be found
in the "Mercedes-Benz Service24h" section
of the Service Booklet.
Care
Notes on care
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining the quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any
of the following:
Rdry,
rough or hard cloths
Rabrasive cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective
films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice
scraper. You could otherwise scratch or
damage the surfaces and protective film.
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Care of the exterior
Automatic car wash
G WARNING
Braking efficiency is reduced after washing
the vehicle. This could cause an accident. For
this reason, following a car wash, drive with
particular care until the brakes are dry.
G WARNING
The vehicle is braked when the HOLD function
or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Therefore,
deactivate the HOLD function and DISTRONIC
PLUS before the vehicle is washed in an automatic car wash.
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
If the vehicle is very dirty, pre-wash it before
cleaning it in an automatic car wash.
! Make sure that the automatic transmis-
sion is in position N when washing your
vehicle in a tow-through car wash. The vehicle could be damaged if the transmission is
in another position.
! Make sure that:
Care
closed completely.
Rthe blower for the ventilation/heating is
switched off (OFF button is depressed).
Rthe windscreen wiper switch is at position 0.
The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off
wax from the windscreen and the wiper
blades. This will prevent smears and reduce
wiping noises caused by residue on the windscreen.
High-pressure cleaning equipment
G WARNING
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) to clean your
vehicle, in particular the tyres. You could otherwise damage the tyres and cause an accident.
! Always maintain a distance of at least
30 cm between the vehicle and the highpressure cleaner nozzle. Information about
the correct distance is available from the
equipment manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtyres
Rdoor
gaps, roof gaps, joints etc.
components
Rbattery
Rconnectors
Rlights
Rseals
Rtrim elements
Rventilation slots
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
Relectrical
Cleaning the wheels
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked up.
Cleaning the paintwork
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected
by corrosion and damage caused by inadequate care cannot always be completely
repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
X Remove impurities immediately, where
possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse
off the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resin,
oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently
with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or
lighter fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic
plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Z
Maintenance and care
Rthe side windows and sliding sunroof are
307
308
Care
Care and treatment of matt paintwork
If your vehicle has a clear matt finish, observe
the following instructions in order to avoid
damage to the paintwork due to incorrect
care.
These notes also apply to light alloy wheels
with a clear matt finish.
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away
from the windscreen when vertical. Otherwise, you will damage the bonnet.
wheels. Polishing makes the paintwork
shiny.
Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning
agent that is recommended and approved
by Mercedes-Benz.
! The following may cause the paint to
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
Maintenance and care
the instrument cluster have gone off. The
windscreen wipers could otherwise move and
injure you.
become shiny and thus reduce the matt
effect:
RVigorous
rubbing with unsuitable materials.
RFrequent use of car washes.
RWashing the vehicle in direct sunlight.
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or pol-
ishing products, or gloss preserver, e.g.
wax. These products are only suitable for
high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles
with matt finish leads to considerable surface damage (shiny, spotted areas).
Always have paintwork repairs performed
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
i The vehicle should preferably be washed
by hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo
and plenty of water.
i Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of recommended and
approved Mercedes-Benz care products.
Cleaning the windows
G WARNING
Switch off the windscreen wipers and remove
the key from the ignition lock before cleaning
the windscreen or the wiper blades. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start/Stop
button repeatedly until all indicator lamps in
X
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows.
Do not touch the insides of the windows
with hard objects, e.g. an ice scraper or
ring. There is otherwise a risk of damaging
the windows.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This
can lead to corrosion damage and damage
to electronic components.
Cleaning the wiper blades
G WARNING
Switch off the windscreen wipers and remove
the key from the ignition lock before cleaning
the windscreen or the wiper blades. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start/Stop
button repeatedly until all indicator lamps in
the instrument cluster have gone off. The
windscreen wipers could otherwise move and
injure you.
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away
from the windscreen when vertical. Otherwise, you will damage the bonnet.
! Do not pull on the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and
do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the
Care
graphite coating could be damaged. This
could cause wiper noise.
Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Clean the wiper blades carefully using a
damp cloth.
X Fold the windscreen wipers back again
before switching on the ignition.
309
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pressure cleaner, make sure that you keep a
distance of at least 30 cm between the
vehicle and the high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct distance
is available from the equipment manufacturer.
X
Cleaning the reversing camera
back. The windscreen could be damaged if
the wiper arm hits against it suddenly.
Cleaning the exterior lighting
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior
lighting using a wet sponge and a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car
shampoo or cleaning cloths.
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the exterior lighting.
X
Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean
camera lens :.
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the reversing camera with a highpressure cleaner.
Cleaning the sensors
Cleaning the exhaust tail pipes
Impurities combined with the effects of road
grit and corrosive environmental factors may
cause flash rust to form on the surface. You
can restore the original shine of the exhaust
tail pipe by cleaning it regularly, especially in
winter and after washing.
! Do not clean the exhaust tail pipes with
alkaline-based cleaning agents, such as
wheel cleaner.
X
X
Clean sensors : of the driving systems
with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
Clean the exhaust tail pipes with a chrome
care product tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning the trailer tow hitch
The ball coupling must be cleaned if it
becomes dirty or corroded.
Z
Maintenance and care
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
Care
310
Remove any rust using a wire brush.
X Remove dirt with a clean, lint-free cloth or
a brush.
X
! For cleaning, do not use any of the following:
Ralcohol-based
thinner or petrol
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface
when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.
Rabrasive
! Do not clean the ball coupling with a high-
Maintenance and care
pressure cleaner. Do not use solvents.
Cleaning the plastic trim
G WARNING
After cleaning, lightly oil or grease ball coupling :.
X Check that the vehicle's trailer tow hitch is
working properly.
X
! Observe the note on care provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
i Maintenance of the ball coupling and
When cleaning the steering wheel boss and
dashboard, do not use cockpit sprays or
cleaning agents containing solvents. Cleaning
agents containing solvents cause the surface
to become porous, and as a result plastic
parts may break away and be thrown around
the interior when an airbag is deployed, which
may result in severe injuries.
! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces:
trailer tow hitch can also be performed at
a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rscented
oil bottles or similar items
You could otherwise damage the plastic.
H Environmental note
Dispose of oily and greasy cloths in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Interior care
Cleaning the display
Before cleaning the display, make sure that
it is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a commercially-available microfibre cloth and TFT/
LCD display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry microfibre cloth.
X
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent
or sunscreen to come in contact with the
plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality
look of the surfaces.
Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change colour temporarily. Wait until the surface is dry again.
X
Care
Cleaning wooden trim and trim pieces
i Note that regular care is essential to
Wipe the wooden trim and trim pieces with
a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfibre
cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning the seat belts
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
ensure that the appearance and comfort of
the covers is retained over time.
X
Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seatbelts
at temperatures above 80 † or by exposing
them to direct sunlight.
Cleaning the seat covers
! Do not use microfibre cloths to clean gen-
uine leather, artificial leather or
Alcantara® covers. If used often, these can
damage the cover.
! Observe the following when cleaning:
Rclean
genuine leather covers carefully
with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth. Make sure that
the leather does not become soaked. It
may otherwise become rough and
cracked. Only use leather care agents
that have been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. You can obtain these
from a qualified specialist workshop, e.g.
a Mercedes-Benz Service centre.
Rclean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
Rclean cloth covers with a microfibre cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid). Rub
carefully and always wipe entire seat sections to avoid leaving visible lines. Leave
the seat to dry afterwards. Cleaning
results depend on the type of dirt and
how long it has been there.
Rclean Alcantara® covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure you wipe entire seat
sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
Z
Maintenance and care
X
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of
damaging the surface.
311
312
313
314
314
316
325
329
330
333
Breakdown assistance
Useful information ............................
Where will I find...? ...........................
Flat tyre .............................................
Battery ...............................................
Jump-starting ....................................
Towing and tow-starting ..................
Electrical fuses .................................
Where will I find...?
314
Useful information
Setting up the warning triangle
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
Breakdown assistance
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
X
X
Where will I find...?
Fold feet = down and out to the side.
Pull side reflectors ; upwards to form a
triangle and lock them at the top using
upper press-stud :.
Warning triangle
Removing the warning triangle
The warning triangle is secured on the inside
of the boot lid.
X Open the boot lid.
X
Press warning triangle holder : up in the
direction of the arrow, open it and remove
the warning triangle.
First-aid kit
Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the
first-aid kit is located either in an open stowage space or behind the left-hand side trim
panel.
X Open the boot lid.
Example: first-aid kit behind the side trim panel
To open the cover: turn rotary knob : in
the direction of the arrow and fold down
cover ;.
X Remove the first-aid kit.
X
Where will I find...?
315
Vehicle tool kit
The vehicle tool kit can be found in the stowage well under the boot floor.
i Vehicles without a spare wheel are not
Example: first-aid kit in an open stowage space
X
Remove first-aid kit :.
i Check the expiry date on the first-aid kit
X
at least once a year. Replace the contents
if necessary, and replace missing contents.
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: lift up the
boot floor (Y page 288).
Fire extinguisher
The fire extinguisher is located underneath
the front of the driver's seat.
: Tyre sealant filler bottle
; Tyre inflation compressor
= Towing eye
? Folding wheel chock
A Wheel wrench
Pull tab : upwards.
X Remove fire extinguisher ;.
X
i Have the fire extinguisher refilled after
each use and checked every one or two
years. It may otherwise fail in an emergency.
Observe the legal requirements in all countries concerned.
B Jack
C One pair of gloves (behind jack)
X
Vehicles with a spare
wheel/"Minispare" emergency spare
wheel: lift up the boot floor (Y page 288).
Breakdown assistance
equipped with the tools needed to change
a wheel when they leave the factory, e.g. a
jack or wheel wrench. Country-specific differences are possible. Some tools for
changing a wheel are specific to the vehicle. To obtain tools approved for your vehicle, visit a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
316
Flat tyre
To remove the spare wheel or
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel:
remove vehicle tool kit tray :.
X Turn stowage well ; anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Remove the spare wheel or "Minispare"
emergency spare wheel =.
X
: Vehicle tool kit tray
Breakdown assistance
; Stowage well
= Spare wheel/"Minispare" emergency
spare wheel
The vehicle tool kit contains:
RFoldable
wheel chock
RFuse allocation chart
RJack
ROne pair of gloves
RWheel wrench
RTowing eye
Spare wheel/"Minispare" emergency
spare wheel
For further information on changing a wheel
and fitting the spare wheel, see
(Y page 321).
Flat tyre
Preparing the vehicle
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
Ra
TIREFIT kit
emergency spare wheel
RMOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat characteristics) (Y page 324)
Ran
i Vehicle preparation is not necessary on
vehicles with MOExtended tyres.
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory.
It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
properties, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit
can be obtained from a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
The spare wheel or "Minispare" emergency
spare wheel can be found in the stowage well
under the boot floor.
X Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 288).
Stop the vehicle as far away as possible
from traffic on solid, non-slippery and level
ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Firmly depress the parking brake.
X Bring the front wheels into the straightahead position.
X
Vehicles with manual transmission:
engage first or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
move the selector lever to P.
X
X
Switch off the engine.
Flat tyre
All occupants must get out of the vehicle.
Make sure that they are not endangered as
they do so.
X Make sure that no one is near the danger
area whilst a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the
wheel change should, for example, stand
behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
X Place the warning triangle (Y page 314) a
suitable distance away. Observe legal
requirements.
X
TIREFIT kit
Using the TIREFIT kit
You can use the TIREFIT kit to seal small
punctures, particularly those in the tyre tread.
You can use TIREFIT at outside temperatures
down to -20 †.
G WARNING
In the following situations, your safety is at
particular risk as tyre sealant is unable to provide sufficient breakdown assistance:
Rthere
are cuts or punctures in the tyre
greater than 4 mm.
Rthe wheel rim is damaged.
Ryou have driven at very low tyre pressures
or on a flat tyre.
Do not drive any further. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Do not remove any foreign objects which
have penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or
nails.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle, the accompanying "max. 80 km/h" sticker and the
tyre inflation compressor from the stowage
well underneath the boot floor
(Y page 315).
X
Affix part : of the sticker within the driver's field of vision.
X Affix part ; of the sticker near the valve
on the wheel with the defective tyre.
X
G WARNING
TIREFIT must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes or clothing.
RIf TIREFIT comes into contact with your
eyes or skin, immediately rinse thoroughly
with clean water.
RChange out of clothing which has come into
contact with TIREFIT immediately.
RIf an allergic reaction occurs, consult a doctor immediately.
Keep TIREFIT away from children.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the
driver's door.
The on-board electronics have status 0,
which is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 137).
X
317
Flat tyre
318
RIf
TIREFIT is swallowed, immediately rinse
your mouth out thoroughly and drink plenty
of water.
RDo not induce vomiting. Consult a doctor
immediately.
RDo not inhale TIREFIT fumes.
i If TIREFIT leaks out, allow it to dry. It can
Breakdown assistance
then be removed like a layer of film.
If you get TIREFIT on your clothing, have it
cleaned as soon as possible with perchloroethylene.
Your vehicle is provided with one of two different TIREFIT kits:
RVersion
1: the tyre inflation compressor
and the tyre filler bottle both have their own
fixed hoses.
RVersion 2: the tyre inflation compressor
and the tyre filler bottle do not come with
a fixed hose. This is in the housing of the
tyre inflation compressor.
TIREFIT kit version 1
Remove the cap from valve C on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose D onto valve C.
X
Insert plug ? into the cigarette lighter
socket (Y page 291) or into a 12 V socket
in your vehicle (Y page 291).
X Turn the key to position 1 (Y page 137) in
the ignition lock.
X Press on/off switch = on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated.
i First, TIREFIT is pumped into the tyre. The
pressure can briefly rise to approximately
500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
X
X
Allow the tyre inflation compressor to run
for five minutes. The tyre should then have
attained a pressure of at least 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi).
! Do not operate the tyre inflation comPull plug ? with the cable and hose A out
of the housing.
X Screw hose A onto flange B of tyre sealant bottle :.
X Insert tyre sealant bottle : head downwards into recess ; of the tyre inflation
compressor.
X
pressor for longer than six minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
been achieved after five minutes, see
(Y page 320).
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
not been achieved after five minutes, see
(Y page 319).
Flat tyre
Press on/off switch ? on the tyre inflation
compressor to ON.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated.
i First, TIREFIT is pumped into the tyre. The
pressure can briefly rise to approximately
500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
X
X
With the sealing rings in front, slide the yellow cap A of the tyre sealant bottle : into
the mounting of the tyre inflation compressor ;, until the cap engages.
X Remove filler hose B and plug = from the
bottom section of the tyre inflation compressor housing.
X Slide the yellow filler hose connector into
the mounting on yellow cap A of tyre sealant bottle : until the plug engages.
Make sure that both teeth engage.
X
Allow the tyre inflation compressor to run
for five minutes. The tyre should then have
attained a pressure of at least 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi).
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than six minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
If, after five minutes, a pressure of 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi) has been achieved, see
(Y page 320).
If, after five minutes, a pressure of 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi) has not been achieved, see
(Y page 319).
Tyre pressure of at least 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi) not reached
Remove the cap from valve C on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose D onto valve.
X Insert plug = into the socket of the cigarette lighter (Y page 291) or into a 12 V
power socket in your vehicle (Y page 291).
X Turn the key to position 1 (Y page 137) in
the ignition lock.
X
If, after five minutes, a pressure of 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi) has not been achieved:
X Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
X Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
X Very slowly drive forwards or reverse
approximately 10 m.
X Pump up the tyre again.
G WARNING
If after five minutes a pressure of 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi) cannot be achieved, the tyre
is too severely damaged.
Do not drive any further. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
Z
Breakdown assistance
TIREFIT kit version 2
319
Flat tyre
320
the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose. In particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Correct the tyre pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/20 psi) (for the values,
see the fuel filler flap).
X
To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the tyre inflation compressor.
Tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi) is reached
X
Breakdown assistance
X
Switch off the tyre inflation compressor.
Unscrew the filler hose from the valve of
the faulty tyre.
! After use, excess TIREFIT may run out of
the filler hose. This may cause stains.
Therefore, place the filler hose in the plastic
bag which contained the TIREFIT kit.
Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Pull away immediately.
X
G WARNING
Do not exceed the maximum speed of
80 km/h.
The "max. 80 km/h" label must be affixed in
the driver's field of vision.
The vehicle's handling characteristics may be
affected.
X
Example: TIREFIT kit, version 2
X
To reduce the tyre pressure: press pressure release button : next to pressure
gauge ;.
TIREFIT kit version 1: take the tyre sealant bottle out of the tyre inflation compressor recess.
X TIREFIT kit version 1: unscrew the hose
from the tyre inflation compressor to the
flange of the tyre sealant bottle.
X
Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with
the tyre inflation compressor.
G WARNING
If the tyre pressure is less than 130 kPa
(1.3 bar/20 psi), the tyre is too severely damaged. Do not drive any further. Consult a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular,
work relevant to safety or on safety-related
systems must be carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop.
TIREFIT kit version 2
TIREFIT kit version 2: to remove the tyre
sealant bottle from the tyre inflation compressor, push the locking mechanisms on
the yellow cap together.
X TIREFIT kit version 2: pull the tyre sealant
bottle out of the tyre inflation compressor.
X
Flat tyre
Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Drive to the nearest workshop and have the
tyre changed there.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle and the filler
hose replaced as soon as possible at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
X
H Environmental note
Have the used tyre sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
X
Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced every
four years at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
G WARNING
Have the emergency spare wheel/spare
wheel replaced with a new wheel as soon as
possible at a qualified specialist workshop
which has the necessary specialist knowledge
and tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
i Vehicles without an emergency spare
wheel/spare wheel are not equipped with
wheel-changing tools at the factory. For
more information on which tools are
required to perform a wheel change on your
vehicle, e.g. wheel chock, wheel wrench or
centring pin, consult a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Prepare the vehicle as described
(Y page 316).
X If a trailer is coupled to the vehicle, uncouple it.
X Remove the following items (depending on
the vehicle's equipment) from the stowage
well under the boot floor:
Rthe emergency spare wheel or spare
wheel
Rthe folding wheel chock
Rthe wheel wrench
Rthe jack
X
Changing a wheel and fitting the spare
wheel
Preparing the vehicle
G WARNING
The wheel and tyre size of the emergency
spare wheel/spare wheel may differ to that of
the damaged wheel. When using an emergency spare wheel/spare wheel the handling
characteristics of the vehicle may change.
Adapt your style of driving accordingly.
Never operate the vehicle with more than one
emergency spare wheel/spare wheel that differs in size.
Only use an emergency spare wheel/spare
wheel of a differing size briefly and do not
switch off ESP®.
When using an emergency spare wheel you
must not exceed the maximum speed of
80 km/h.
X
Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
Securing the vehicle to prevent it from
rolling away
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock,
it can be found in the vehicle tool kit
(Y page 315).
The folding wheel chock is an additional
securing measure to prevent the vehicle from
rolling away, for example when changing a
wheel.
Z
Breakdown assistance
The filler hose remains attached to the tyre
sealant bottle.
321
Flat tyre
322
Raising the vehicle
Fold both plates upwards :.
Fold out lower plate ;.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
the openings in base plate =.
X
Breakdown assistance
X
G WARNING
The jack is intended only for lifting the vehicle
briefly for wheel changes.
The vehicle must be placed on stands if you
intend to work under it.
Make sure that the jack is placed on a firm,
non-slip, level surface. Do not use wooden
blocks or similar objects as a jack underlay.
The vehicle could otherwise slip off the jack
and seriously injure you.
Do not start the engine at any time while the
wheel is being changed.
Do not lie under the vehicle when it is being
supported by the jack. If you do not raise the
vehicle as described, it could slip off the jack
(e.g. if the engine is started or a door or the
boot lid is opened or closed) and seriously
injure you.
G WARNING
If you fail to position the jack correctly, the
vehicle may:
Rslip
Securing the vehicle on level ground
X
On level ground: place chocks or other
suitable items under the front and rear of
the wheel that is diagonally opposite the
wheel you wish to change.
Securing the vehicle on slight downhill gradients
X
On downhill gradients: place chocks or
other suitable items in front of the wheels
of the front and rear axle.
off the jack
you or others
Rbe damaged.
Therefore, make sure that the jack is positioned correctly in the respective jacking
points. Before positioning the jack, remove
any dirt that may have collected in the jacking
points. Please note that you must position the
jack in the opening of the jacking point.
Rinjure
Flat tyre
X
Using wheel wrench :, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
The jacking points for the jack are located
behind the wheel housings of the front wheels
and in front of the wheel housings of the rear
wheels (arrows).
323
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned directly under the jacking point.
X Turn crank ? clockwise until jack = sits
completely on jacking point ; and the
base of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn crank ? until the tyre is raised a maximum of 3 cm from the ground.
X
Removing a wheel
X
Unscrew the wheel bolts.
The threads of the wheel bolts and wheel
hubs could otherwise be damaged when
the bolts are tightened.
X
Remove the wheel.
Fitting a new wheel
G WARNING
Replace damaged or corroded wheel bolts.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. This could
cause the bolts to loosen in the wheel hub.
G WARNING
X
Position jack = at jacking point ;.
If a wheel hub thread is damaged, you must
not drive the vehicle any further. Consult a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre or Service 24h for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the
respective wheel. Other wheel bolts could
work loose or damage the brake system.
Z
Breakdown assistance
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt.
Flat tyre
324
Do not tighten the wheel bolts completely
while the vehicle is still jacked up. The vehicle
could topple off the jack.
X
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
G WARNING
Have the tightening torque checked immediately after a wheel is changed. The wheels
could work loose if they are not tightened to
a torque of 130 Nm.
X
Turn the jack back to its initial position and
store it together with the rest of the vehicle
tool kit in the stowage well under the boot
floor.
X
Transport the faulty wheel in the boot.
Breakdown assistance
or
X
X
Slide the emergency spare wheel/spare
wheel onto the wheel hub and push it on.
X
Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.
Lowering the vehicle
Turn the crank of the jack anti-clockwise
until the vehicle is once again standing
firmly on the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X
X
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated
(: to A ). The tightening torque must be
130 Nm.
Depending on the size of the wheel, you
may also be able to secure the faulty wheel
in the spare wheel well. In this case, you
will have to remove the stowage tray from
the spare wheel well and stow it securely
in the boot.
i When you are driving with the emergency
spare wheel fitted, the tyre pressure loss
warning system cannot function reliably.
Only restart the tyre pressure loss warning
system when the defective wheel has been
replaced with a new wheel.
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat characteristics) allow you to continue driving the
vehicle even when one or more tyres lose all
air pressure.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with the activated tyre pressure loss
warning system or with the tyre pressure
monitor.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode depends on the
load in the vehicle. It is 80 km if the vehicle
is partially laden and 30 km if fully laden.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode is counted from
the moment the tyre pressure loss warning
appears in the multifunction display.
Battery
G WARNING
The handling characteristics of your vehicle
deteriorate in run-flat mode, for example:
Rwhen
cornering
braking
Rwhen accelerating rapidly
Adapt your driving style accordingly and avoid
sudden changes in direction and sudden
acceleration, as well as driving over obstacles
(i.e. kerbs, potholes), and driving off-road.
This is particularly the case when the vehicle
is heavily laden.
The maximum permissible distance that can
be driven in run-flat mode depends to a large
extent on the loads placed on the vehicle. It
can be shorter due to high speeds, a heavy
load, sudden changes in direction, the road
surface condition, outside temperature, etc.,
or further if you drive carefully and conservatively.
Do not continue to drive in run-flat mode if:
Rwhen
Ryou
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
Rthe
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tyre.
After driving in run-flat mode, you must have
the wheel(s) checked for damage at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry
out the work required. The faulty tyre must be
replaced in every case.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rthere
i When replacing one or all tyres, make
sure that you only use tyres marked
MOExtended and of the specified size for
the vehicle.
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory.
It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
properties, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit
can be obtained from a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Battery
Important safety notes
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be
sufficiently charged.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a
lengthy period.
Only replace a battery with a battery that has
been recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre if
you wish to leave your vehicle parked up for
a long period of time.
G WARNING
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
Risk of explosion
Fire, naked flames and
smoking are prohibited
when handling the battery.
Avoid creating sparks.
Battery acid is caustic.
Avoid contact with the skin,
eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective
clothing, in particular
gloves, an apron and a face
mask.
Immediately rinse acid
splashes off with clean
Z
Breakdown assistance
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
325
326
Battery
water. Consult a doctor if
necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
Breakdown assistance
Observe this Owner's Manual.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is against the law to dispose of them with the household rubbish. They must be
collected separately and
recycled in an environmentally responsible manner.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre, or to a special collection point for old batteries.
G WARNING
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which have
been tested and approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz. These batteries provide
increased impact protection to prevent vehicle occupants from suffering acid burns
should the battery be damaged in the event
of an accident.
To prevent acid burns, observe the following
safety notes when handling batteries:
Rdo
not lean over the battery.
Rdo not place any metal objects on a battery.
Otherwise, you could cause a short circuit
and the battery's gas mixture could ignite.
Rmake sure that you do not create an electrostatic charge, e.g. by wearing synthetic
clothing or as a result of friction on fabrics.
Therefore, you should not pull or slide the
battery over carpets or other synthetic
materials.
Rnever touch the battery first. To discharge
a possible electrostatic charge, step out of
the vehicle first and touch the bodywork.
Rdo not wipe the battery using a cloth. The
battery may explode as a result of electrostatic charge or due to flying sparks.
! Switch off the engine and remove the key
before disconnecting the terminal clamps
from the battery. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, make sure that the ignition is
switched off. Check that all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster are off. You
may otherwise destroy electronic components, such as the alternator.
i When you park the vehicle, remove the
key if you do not require any electrical consumers. The vehicle will then use very little
energy, thus conserving battery power.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you do not
carry out work on batteries yourself, e.g.
removing or charging. Have this work performed at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g.
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Installation location of the battery
Your vehicle is equipped with a battery in the
engine compartment. It is fitted in front of the
front bulkhead on the right-hand side of the
vehicle when viewed in the direction of travel.
Battery
Apply the parking brake firmly and on vehicles with automatic transmission, shift the
transmission to position P.
X Switch off all electrical consumers (e.g.
radio, blower, etc.).
X Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 137) in
the ignition lock and remove it, or, on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, make sure that the
ignition has been switched off
(Y page 137). All indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster must be off.
327
X
Open the bonnet (Y page 301).
: Battery
; Positive terminal
= Negative terminal
? Breather hose
Loosen the negative terminal clamp on the
battery and remove it.
X Remove the cover from the positive terminal clamp.
X Loosen the positive terminal clamp on the
battery and remove it.
X Remove breather hose ? from the side of
the battery.
X
Release clamps ; on filter box : using a
suitable object, such as a screwdriver.
X Remove filter box :.
X
i Information on disconnecting the battery
(Y page 327).
Disconnecting the battery
! Always disconnect the battery in
the order described below. Never swap the
terminal clamps. You may otherwise damage the vehicle electronics.
In vehicles with automatic transmission,
the transmission is locked in position P
after disconnecting the battery. The vehicle
is secured against rolling away. You can
then no longer move the vehicle.
Removing/fitting the battery
To remove: disconnect the battery
(Y page 327).
X Loosen the bolt which holds the battery in
place.
X Remove the battery.
X To fit: follow the steps described in "To
remove" in reverse order.
X
Reconnecting the battery
! Always connect the battery in the order
described below. Never swap the terminal
clamps. You may otherwise damage the
vehicle electronics.
Switch off all electrical consumers (e.g.
radio, blower, etc.).
X Connect the positive terminal clamp and
secure the cover.
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
X
Battery
328
Connect the negative terminal clamp.
X Put the filter box back in place, then clip in
and close the retaining clamps.
X Close the bonnet.
! Only use battery chargers with a maxi-
i If the power supply has been interrupted,
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment (Y page 329).
X Open the bonnet (Y page 301).
X Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order
as when connecting the donor battery in
the jump-starting procedure
(Y page 329).
X
e.g. if the battery has been reconnected,
you must carry out the following tasks:
Rset the clock; see the separate operating
instructions.
the function for automatically folding the exterior mirrors in/out by folding
the mirrors out once (Y page 104).
Breakdown assistance
Rreset
mum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jumpstart connection point.
X
Charging the battery
G WARNING
Only charge the battery in a well-ventilated
area. As the battery is being charged, gases
can escape and generate minor explosions.
This could injure you and other persons or
cause damage to the paintwork or acid corrosion on the vehicle.
You can obtain information about battery
chargers which allow the battery to be
charged while still installed from a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
G WARNING
There is a risk of acid burns during the charging process due to the gases which escape
from the battery. Do not lean over the battery
during the charging process.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the
skin, eyes or clothing.
! Only charge the installed battery with a
battery charger which has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. These battery
chargers allow the battery to be charged
while still installed.
Read the battery charger's operating
instructions before charging the battery.
Jump-starting
329
Jump-starting
G WARNING
There is a risk of acid burns when jump-starting a vehicle due to the gases which escape from
the battery. Do not lean over the battery while the engine is being jump-started.
G WARNING
! Avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may dam-
age the catalytic converter13 and create a risk of fire.
Do not use a rapid-charging device to start the engine.
Make sure the jump leads are not damaged.
Make sure the jump leads are not touching any other metal objects when they are connected
to the battery.
If your vehicle's battery is discharged, the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle
or from a second battery using jump leads.
Observe the following points:
X The battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible,
jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
X Only jump-start the vehicle when the engine is cold and the catalytic converter system has
cooled down14 .
X Do not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
X Jump-starting may only be performed from batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
X Only use jump leads which have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps.
X Make sure that the jump leads cannot come into contact with parts, such as the pulley or
the fan. These parts move when the engine is started and while it is running.
X If the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected
for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little.
i Jump leads and further information about jump-starting can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, for example.
Make sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Apply the parking brake firmly.
X Manual transmission: engage neutral.
X Automatic transmission: move the selector lever to P.
X Switch off all electrical consumers (e.g. radio, blower, etc.).
X Open the bonnet (Y page 301).
X
X
13 Only
14 Only
vehicles with a petrol engine.
vehicles with a petrol engine.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Gases escaping from the battery during jump-starting may cause minor explosions. Avoid creating sparks. Keep naked flames away from the battery, and do not smoke.
Comply with safety precautions when handling batteries. You will find these under "Battery" in
the index.
Breakdown assistance
330
Towing and tow-starting
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jumpstarting device.
X Slide cover : of positive terminal ; in the direction of the arrow.
X Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B
using the jump lead, beginning with your own battery.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
X Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using
the jump lead, connecting the jump lead to donor battery B first.
X Start the engine.
X Allow the engine to run for a few minutes before disconnecting the jump lead.
X First, remove the jump lead from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from positive
terminal ; and positive terminal =, each time disconnecting from the contacts on your
own vehicle first.
X After removing the jump lead, close cover : on positive terminal ;.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre. The jump-starting procedure is not a standard operating state; therefore, have the
battery checked.
Towing and tow-starting
Important safety notes
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant countries when towing and tow-starting.
G WARNING
If you tow the vehicle, you must use a rigid
towing bar if:
Rthe
engine is not running.
is a brake system malfunction.
Rthere is a malfunction in the power supply
or the vehicle's electrical system.
The power assistance for the steering and the
brake force booster do not work when the
engine is not running. You will need more
force to steer and brake, you may have to
depress the brake pedal with maximum force.
Rthere
Towing and tow-starting
G WARNING
The vehicle is braked when the HOLD function
or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Therefore,
deactivate HOLD and DISTRONIC PLUS if the
vehicle is to be towed.
It is better to have the vehicle transported
than to have it towed.
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum
of 50 km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must
not be exceeded.
For towing distances over 50 km, the entire
vehicle must be lifted up and transported.
! Only secure the tow rope or towing bar to
the towing eyes. The vehicle may otherwise
be damaged.
! Do not use the towing eye for recovery,
as this could damage the vehicle. If in
doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane.
! Pull away smoothly when towing away or
tow-starting a vehicle. If the tractive power
is too high, the vehicles could be damaged.
! On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use the
Vehicles with automatic transmission:
release the selector lever lock manually to
move it out of position P (Y page 152).
i Before the vehicle is towed, switch off the
automatic locking feature (Y page 84). You
could otherwise be locked out when pushing or towing the vehicle.
Deactivate tow-away protection
(Y page 73) before the vehicle is towed.
Fitting/removing the towing eye
Fitting the towing eye
Vehicles with a trailer tow hitch: if you intend
to use the vehicle for towing, fold out the ball
coupling and connect the towbar to it
(Y page 201).
X Remove the towing eye from the vehicle
tool kit (Y page 315).
G WARNING
The exhaust tail pipe may be hot. You could
burn yourself if you touch the tail pipe. Be
particularly careful when removing the rear
cover.
The mountings for the removable towing eyes
are located in the bumpers. They are at the
front and at the rear, under the covers.
key instead of the Start/Stop button. Turn
the key to position 2 in the ignition lock and
shift the automatic transmission to N.
Then, turn the key back to 0 and leave it in
the ignition lock.
When towing a vehicle with an automatic
transmission, the transmission must be in
position N.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Rcannot
turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2
Rcannot shift the transmission to position
N on vehicles with automatic transmission
Z
Breakdown assistance
Before towing away, make sure that the steering can be moved and is not locked.
If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle.
331
Towing and tow-starting
332
Take cover : off the opening.
X Screw the towing eye in clockwise to the
stop and tighten it.
X
Removing the towing eye
X
Loosen the towing eye and unscrew it.
Attach cover : to the bumper and press
until it engages.
X Place the towing eye in the vehicle tool kit.
Breakdown assistance
X
Towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised
When towing your vehicle with the rear axle
raised, it is important that you observe the
safety instructions (Y page 330).
! The ignition must be switched off if you
are towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 111).
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X When leaving the vehicle, take the key or
the KEYLESS-GO key with you.
X
Towing the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
It is important that you observe the safety
instructions when towing away your vehicle
(Y page 330).
G WARNING
The power assistance for the steering and the
brake force booster do not work when the
engine is not running. You will then need
much more effort to brake and steer the vehicle. Adapt your style of driving accordingly.
Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 111).
i When towing with the hazard warning
lamps switched on, use the combination
switch as usual to signal a change of direction. In this case, only the turn signals for
the desired direction flash. When the combination switch is reset, the hazard warning
lamps start flashing again.
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to neutral.
or
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
shift the automatic transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the parking brake.
X
Transporting the vehicle
The towing eyes or trailer tow hitch can be
used to pull the vehicle onto a trailer or transporter if you wish to transport it.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to neutral.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Move the selector lever to N.
As soon as the vehicle is loaded:
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by
applying the parking brake.
X Vehicles with manual transmission:
shift to first gear or reverse gear.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
move the selector lever to P.
X
Electrical fuses
! Only lash the vehicle down by the wheels
or wheel rims, not by parts of the vehicle
such as axle or steering components. Otherwise, the vehicle could be damaged.
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
When tow-starting, it is important that you
observe the safety instructions (Y page 330)
and the legal requirements in each respective
country.
! Vehicles with automatic transmission
must not be tow-started. The transmission
may otherwise be damaged.
Before tow-starting the following conditions
must be fulfilled:
Rthe
battery is connected.
engine has cooled down.
Rthe catalytic converters have cooled down.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 111).
X Fit the towing eye (Y page 331).
X Secure the rigid towing bar or the towing
rope.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Depress the clutch pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift to neutral.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Tow-start the vehicle.
X Engage second gear.
X Release the clutch pedal slowly; do not
operate the accelerator pedal while doing
so.
The engine is started.
Rthe
Depress the clutch pedal and shift to neutral.
X Stop at a suitable place.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Remove the rigid towing bar or towing rope.
X Remove the towing eye (Y page 332).
X Switch off the hazard warning lamps.
X
Electrical fuses
Important safety notes
The fuses in your vehicle serve to close down
faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on the circuit and their functions stop
operating.
G WARNING
Only use fuses that have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which have the
correct fuse rating for the systems concerned. Do not attempt to repair or bridge
faulty fuses. Otherwise, a circuit overload
could cause a fire. Have the cause traced and
rectified at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognise by
the colour and value. The fuse ratings are listed in the fuse allocation chart. A MercedesBenz Service Centre will be happy to advise
you.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
! Only use fuses that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Otherwise, components or systems could be damaged.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X Secure the vehicle.
X
333
Electrical fuses
334
Park the vehicle and apply the parking
brake.
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Remove any existing moisture from the
fuse box using a dry cloth.
X Take lines ; from the guides.
X To open: open clamps :.
X Remove the fuse box cover forwards.
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
Before changing a fuse
X
Breakdown assistance
Rfuse box in the engine compartment on the
left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel
Rfuse box in the boot on the right-hand side
of the vehicle, when viewed in the direction
of travel
The fuse allocation chart is located in the
vehicle tool kit (Y page 315) in the stowage
compartment under the boot floor.
Fuse box in the engine compartment
X
fuse box when the cover is open.
To close: check whether the rubber seal is
lying correctly in the cover.
X Insert the cover at the rear of the fuse box
into the retainer.
X Fold down the cover and close clamps :.
X Secure lines ; in the guides.
X
! The cover must be fitted properly, other-
wise moisture or dirt could impair the function of the fuses.
X
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
turned off.
G WARNING
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
turned off and the key is pulled out of the ignition lock before you open the cover of the fuse
box. Otherwise, the windscreen wipers and
the wiper rods above the cover could be set
in motion. This could lead to you or others
being injured by the wiper rods.
X
X
Close the bonnet (Y page 302).
Fuse box in the boot
X
Open the boot lid (Y page 85).
X
To open: release cover : at the top and
open it downwards in the direction of the
arrow.
Open the bonnet (Y page 301).
335
336
336
336
337
339
344
345
Wheels and tyres
Useful information ............................
Important safety notes ....................
Operation ...........................................
Winter operation ...............................
Tyre pressure ....................................
Changing a wheel .............................
Wheel and tyre combinations ..........
336
Operation
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
vehicle as soon as possible to check the
wheels and tyres for damage. Hidden tyre
damage could also be causing the unusual
handling characteristics. If you find no
signs of damage, have the wheels and tyres
examined at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
RWhen parking your vehicle, make sure that
the tyres do not get deformed by the kerb
or other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive
over kerbs, speed humps or similar elevations, try to do so slowly and at an obtuse
angle. Otherwise, the tyres, particularly the
sidewalls, can get damaged.
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Tyres, wheels or accessories which have not
been approved by Mercedes-Benz for your
vehicle or are not used as they should be, can
impair driving safety. As a result, you could
cause an accident. Before purchasing and
using them, enquire about their suitability,
legal stipulations and factory recommendations at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted, nor is the use of
spacer plates or brake dust shields. This invalidates the General Operating Permit for the
vehicle.
i Further information about tyres and
wheels can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Operation
Notes on driving
RWhile
driving, pay attention to vibrations,
noises and unusual handling characteristics, e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that the wheels or tyres are damaged.
If you suspect that a tyre is defective,
reduce your speed immediately. Stop the
Notes on regularly inspecting wheels
and tyres
RRegularly
check the wheels and tyres of
your vehicle for damage (e.g. cuts, punctures, tears, bulges on tyres and deformation,
cracks or severe corrosion on wheels), at
least every 14 days, as well as after driving
off-road or on rough roads. Damaged
wheels can cause a loss of tyre pressure.
RRegularly check the tyre tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the whole
width of the tyre (Y page 337). If necessary, turn the front wheels to full lock in
order to inspect the inner side of the tyre
surface.
RAll wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not
fit anything onto the valve (such as tyre
pressure monitoring systems) other than
the standard valve cap or other valve caps
approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle.
RRegularly check the pressure of all the tyres
including the emergency spare wheel or the
spare wheel, particularly prior to long trips,
and correct the pressure as necessary
(Y page 339).
Winter operation
G WARNING
Bear in mind that:
Rtyre
grip decreases rapidly on wet roads
when the tread depth is less than 3 mm.
Thus, you should replace tyres that have
insufficient tread.
Rwinter tyres should be replaced when the
tread depth is 4 mm or less as they no longer provide adequate grip.
Rthe tread on a tyre may not wear evenly.
Thus, you should regularly check the tread
depth and the condition of the tread across
the entire width of all tyres. If necessary,
turn the front wheels to full lock in order to
inspect the tyre tread more easily.
Otherwise, you could lose control of the vehicle and cause an accident due to the reduced
grip of the tyres on the road.
Notes on selecting, fitting and replacing tyres
ROnly
fit tyres and wheels of the same type
and make.
ROnly fit tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RAfter fitting new tyres, run them in at moderate speeds for the first 100 km, as they
only reach their full performance after this
distance.
RDo not drive with tyres which have too little
tread depth, as this significantly reduces
the traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
RReplace the tyres after six years at the latest, regardless of wear. This also applies to
the emergency spare wheel/spare wheel.
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat characteristics) allow you to continue driving the
vehicle even when one or more tyres lose all
air pressure.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with the tyre pressure loss warning
system or with the tyre pressure monitor and
on wheels specifically tested by MercedesBenz.
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory.
It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with the TIREFIT
kit if you fit tyres that do not feature runflat properties, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT
kit can be obtained from a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
You will find notes on driving with a flat tyre
in the "Breakdown assistance" section
(Y page 324).
Winter operation
Please bear the following in mind
At the onset of winter, have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 344).
Driving with summer tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, summer tyres
lose elasticity and therefore traction and
braking power; change the tyres on your vehicle to M+S tyres. Using summer tyres at very
cold temperatures could cause tears to form,
thereby damaging the tyres permanently.
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility
for this type of damage.
M+S tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, use winter tyres
or all-season tyres. Both types of tyre are
identified by the M+S marking.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Tyre tread
337
Winter operation
338
Only winter tyres bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide the best possible grip in wintry road conditions. Only these tyres will allow driving
safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to
function optimally in winter, as these tyres
have been designed specifically for driving on
snow.
Use M+S tyres of the same make and tread
on all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Wheels and tyres
G WARNING
M+S tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced. They are no longer
suitable for winter use and can no longer provide sufficient grip. This could cause you to
lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tyres you have
fitted.
If you fit M+S tyres which have a lower maximum permissible speed than that of the vehicle, affix an appropriate warning sign in the
driver's field of vision. This can be obtained
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Under these circumstances, you should also
restrict the maximum speed of the vehicle
using permanent SPEEDTRONIC so that it
does not exceed the maximum permissible
speed for the M+S tyres (Y page 176).
When you have fitted the M+S tyres:
X
X
Check the tyre pressures (Y page 339).
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 340).
G WARNING
If you fit the spare wheel when driving with M
+S tyres, bear in mind that driving stability will
be impaired due to unstable cornering characteristics caused by the different tyres. You
should therefore adapt your driving style and
drive carefully.
Have the spare wheel replaced at the nearest
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular,
work relevant to safety or on safety-related
systems must be carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Snow chains
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that
have been specially approved for your vehicle
by Mercedes-Benz, or that are of a corresponding standard of quality.
If you intend to fit snow chains, please bear
the following points in mind:
Rit
is not permissible to attach snow chains
to all wheel-tyre combinations; see the
information under "Wheel/tyre combinations" in the "Wheels and tyres" section.
Rsnow chains must not be fitted to emergency spare wheels, e.g. a "Minispare"
emergency spare wheel.
Rfit snow chains only in pairs and only to the
rear wheels. Observe the manufacturer's
installation instructions.
! Vehicles with steel wheels: if you wish
to fit snow chains to steel wheels, make
sure that you remove the respective
wheels' hubcaps first. The hubcaps may
otherwise be damaged.
Do not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
i You may wish to deactivate ESP®
(Y page 67) when pulling away with snow
chains fitted. This way you can allow the
wheels to spin in a controlled manner, achieving an increased driving force (cutting
action).
Tyre pressure
339
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure specifications
Instead of the complete tyre size, the rim
diameter alone, for example R16, may be listed.
Rim diameter : is part of the tyre size and
can be found on the tyre sidewall.
G WARNING
Tyre pressure that is either too high or too low
has a negative effect on the vehicle's driving
safety, which could lead you to cause an accident. Therefore, you should regularly check
the pressure of all the tyres, particularly prior
to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary.
If a tyre size precedes a tyre pressure, the tyre
pressure information following is only valid
for that tyre size.
To test tyre pressure, use a suitable pressure
gauge. The outer appearance of a tyre does
not permit any reliable conclusion about the
tyre pressure.
G WARNING
Do not fit anything else to the tyre valve other
than the standard valve cap. In particular, retrofitted tyre pressure monitors which are
screwed on to the valve may overload it and
cause it to fail. Due to their design, the valve
Z
Wheels and tyres
You will find a table of tyre pressures for various operating conditions on the inside of
your vehicle's fuel filler flap.
Operation with emergency spare wheel:
The applicable value for the emergency spare
wheel is stated on the spare wheel and in the
technical data section.
Operation with a trailer: The applicable
value for the rear tyres is the maximum tyre
pressure value stated on the table inside the
fuel filler flap.
The table inside the fuel filler flap may state
tyre pressures for different load conditions.
These are defined in the table as different
numbers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The actual number of seats may vary –
for more information please refer to the vehicle's registration documents.
If no other data is stated, the tyre pressures
specified on the fuel filler flap apply for all
tyres approved for this vehicle.
340
Tyre pressure
is kept open continuously, which may lead to
air loss.
G WARNING
Should the tyre pressure drop repeatedly:
Rcheck
the tyre for foreign bodies.
Rcheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
sure that only a valve cap approved
by Mercedes-Benz is fitted on the tyre
valve.
Tyre pressures that are too low have a negative effect on vehicle safety, which could lead
you to cause an accident.
Wheels and tyres
Rmake
If possible, only correct tyre pressures when
the tyres are cold. The tyres are cold when
the vehicle has been parked for at least three
hours or has been driven less than 1.5 km.
Depending on the ambient temperature, the
speed you are driving at and the load on the
tyres, the tyre temperature and thus the tyre
pressure may change by approximately
10 kPa (0.1 bar/1.5 psi) per 10 †. Take this
into account when checking the pressure of
warm tyres and only correct it if it is too low
for the current operating conditions.
Driving with tyre pressure that is too high or
too low can:
Rshorten
the service life of the tyres
increased tyre damage
Rhave a negative effect on handling characteristics and thus the driving safety (e.g. by
causing aquaplaning)
Rcause
i The tyre pressure values given for low
loads are minimum values which offer you
good ride comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given
for higher loads. These are permissible and
will not adversely affect the running of the
vehicle.
H Environmental note
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
Tyre pressure loss warning system
Important safety notes
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure loss warning system monitors the set
tyre pressure using the rotational speed of
the wheels. This enables the system to detect
significant pressure loss in a tyre. If the speed
of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of
a loss of pressure, a corresponding warning
message will appear in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
The tyre pressure loss warning system does
not warn you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. The table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap will help you decide whether the tyre
pressures should be corrected.
The tyre pressure loss warning system does
not replace the need to regularly check your
vehicle's tyre pressures, since an even loss of
pressure on several tyres at the same time
cannot be detected by the tyre pressure loss
warning system.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object.
In the event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring
the vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Do
not make any sudden steering movements
when doing so.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
Rsnow
chains are fitted to your vehicle's
tyres.
Rroad conditions are wintry.
Ryou are driving on sand or gravel.
Ryou adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high
rates of acceleration).
Ryou are towing a very heavy or large trailer.
Ryou are driving with a heavy load (in the
vehicle or on the roof).
Tyre pressure
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tyre pressures of all four tyres.
Rchanged
or
If you wish to cancel the restart:
Rchanged
X
the tyre pressure
the wheels or tyres
Rfitted new wheels or tyres
X Before restarting, consult the table of tyre
pressures on the inside of the fuel filler flap
to ensure that the tyre pressure in all four
tyres is set correctly for the respective
operating conditions.
X Observe the notes in the section on tyre
pressures (Y page 339).
G WARNING
The tyre pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set the
correct tyre pressure.
If an incorrect tyre pressure is set, these
incorrect values will be monitored.
A tyre with insufficient pressure results in
vehicle instability when driving, thus increasing the risk of an accident.
Restarting using the 4-button multifunction steering wheel
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X Press the V button to select Tyre
pressure Menu: R.
X Press the C button.
The RFI active Restart: R message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the C button.
The Tyre press. OK? message appears in
the multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Press the W button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
Press the X button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Restarting using the 12-button multifunction steering wheel
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
Service menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message appears in the
multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. now OK? message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Yes.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tyre pressures of all four tyres.
X
or
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
or
Z
Wheels and tyres
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
if you have:
341
Tyre pressure
342
If the Tyre press. now OK? message
appears, use 9 or : to select Can‐
cel.
X Press the a button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
board computer. In this case, do not reduce
the tyre pressures.
X
Tyre pressure monitor
Wheels and tyres
Important safety notes
If a tyre pressure monitor system is fitted, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors fitted that
monitor the tyre pressures in all four tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor warns you when
the pressure drops in one or more of the
tyres. The tyre pressure monitor only functions if the correct sensors are fitted to all
wheels.
G WARNING
The tyre pressure monitor does not warn you
of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. The table
on the inside of the fuel filler flap will help you
decide whether the tyre pressures should be
corrected.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Do not
make any sudden steering movements when
doing so.
Information on tyre pressures is displayed in
the multifunction display. After a few minutes
of driving, the current tyre pressure of each
tyre is shown in the multifunction display.
i The tyre pressure values indicated by the
on-board computer may differ from those
measured at a filling station with a pressure
gauge. The tyre pressures shown by the onboard computer refer to those measured at
sea level. At high altitudes, the tyre pressure values indicated by a pressure gauge
are higher than those shown by the on-
i The operation of the tyre pressure monitor can be affected by interference from
radio transmitting equipment (e.g. radio
headphones, two-way radios) that may be
being operated in or near the vehicle.
Checking tyre pressure electronically
Make sure that the key is in position 2
(Y page 137) in the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Servicemenu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure for each wheel
will be displayed in the multifunction display.
X
If the vehicle has been parked for longer than
20 minutes, the Tyre pressures will be
displayed after a few minutes of
driving message appears.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
monitor automatically recognises new
wheels or new sensors. As long as a clear
allocation of the tyre pressure values to the
individual wheels is not possible, the Tyre
pressure monitor active display message is shown instead of the tyre pressure
display. The tyre pressures are already being
monitored.
i If a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
is fitted, the system may continue to show
the tyre pressure of the wheel that has
been removed for a few minutes. If this
occurs, note that the value displayed for
the position where the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel is fitted is not the same
as the spare wheel/emergency spare
wheel's current tyre pressure.
Tyre pressure
If the tyre pressure monitor detects a significant pressure loss on one or more tyres, a
warning message is shown in the multifunction display. A warning tone also sounds and
the tyre pressure warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster.
Each tyre that is affected by a significant loss
of pressure is highlighted in the pressure display.
If the Please correct tyre pressure
message appears in the multifunction display:
X Check the tyre pressure on all four wheels
and correct it if necessary.
i If the wheel positions on the vehicle are
interchanged, the tyre pressures may be
displayed for the wrong positions for a
short time. This is rectified after a few
minutes of driving, and the tyre pressures
are displayed for the correct positions.
Also observe the notes in the section on
tyre pressures (Y page 339).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Servicemenu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the current tyre pressure of the individual tyres or
the Tyre pressures will be dis‐
played after a few minutes of driv‐
ing message.
X Press the : button.
The Use current pressures as new
reference values message appears in
the multifunction display.
X
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Restarting the tyre pressure monitor
When you restart the tyre pressure monitor,
all existing warning messages are deleted and
the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses
the currently set tyre pressures as the reference values for monitoring. In most cases, the
tyre pressure monitor will automatically
detect the new reference values after you
have changed the tyre pressure.
i For an overview of the menus, see
(Y page 214).
If you wish to define the new reference values
manually:
X
Use the table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap to ensure that the tyre pressure is set
correctly in all four tyres for the current
operating conditions.
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. monitor restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tyre
pressures are within the specified range.
The new tyre pressures are then accepted
as reference values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Radio type approval for the tyre pressure monitor
In certain countries, a radio type approval for
the tyre pressure monitor may be required.
The radio type approval number for the tyre
pressure monitor can be found online at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Tyre pressure monitor warning messages
343
344
Changing a wheel
Changing a wheel
Flat tyre
The "Breakdown assistance" section
(Y page 316) contains information and notes
on how to deal with a flat tyre. It also provides
instructions on changing a wheel or fitting the
spare wheel or emergency spare wheel.
Interchanging the wheels
Wheels and tyres
G WARNING
Interchange the front and rear wheels only if
they have the same dimensions, for example
size, offset, etc.
After every wheel interchange/change, have
the tightening torque checked at a qualified
specialist workshop that has the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose. In particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
The wheels could work loose if they are not
tightened to a torque of 130 Nm.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use wheel bolts of the
correct size which have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ, depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear
pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres
typically wear more on the shoulders and the
rear tyres in the centre.
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, you can interchange the wheels
every 5000 km to 10,000 km depending on
the degree of tyre wear. Do not reverse the
direction of tyre rotation.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is interchanged. Check the tyre pressure and,
if necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system or the tyre pressure monitor.
! On vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure
monitor, electronic components are located in the wheel.
Tyre-fitting tools should not be applied in
the area of the valve, as this could damage
the electronic components.
Always have the tyres changed at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Direction of rotation
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of aquaplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is
observed.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
You may fit an emergency spare wheel/spare
wheel against the direction of rotation.
Observe the time restriction on use as well as
the speed limitation specified on the emergency spare wheel/spare wheel.
Storing wheels
Store wheels that are not being used in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place. Protect the
tyres against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
Cleaning the wheels
G WARNING
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) to clean your
vehicle, in particular the tyres. You could otherwise damage the tyres and cause an accident.
Wheel and tyre combinations
Please bear the following in mind
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz rec-
ommends that you only use tyres and
wheels which have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle.
These tyres have been specially adapted
for use with the control systems, such as
ABS or ESP®, and are marked as follows:
RMO
= Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tyres with run-flat characteristics)
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only certain AMG tyres)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres
may only be used on wheels that have been
specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tyres, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle
noise emissions or fuel consumption, may
otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tyre dimension variations could cause the tyres to
come into contact with the bodywork and
axle components. This could result in damage to the tyres or the vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage resulting from the use of tyres,
wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved.
Further information about tyres, wheels
and approved combinations can be
obtained from any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor
fit used tyres if you have no information
about their previous usage.
! Large wheels: the lower the section width
for a certain wheel size, the lower the ride
comfort is on poor road surfaces. Roll comfort and suspension comfort are reduced
and the risk of damage to the wheels and
tyres as a result of driving over obstacles
increases.
i You will find a table of tyre pressures on
the inside of your vehicle's fuel filler flap.
For further information on tyre pressure,
see (Y page 339).
i Notes on the vehicle equipment – always
fit the vehicle:
Rwith tyres of the same size on a given axle
(left/right)
the same type of tyres at a given
time (summer tyres, winter tyres,
MOExtended tyres)
Rwith
i Overview of abbreviations used in the following tyre tables:
RBA:
both axles
front axle
RRA: rear axle
RFA:
In the following table, the wheel/tyre combinations are allocated to the vehicle models
through variants, e.g. V1, V2 etc.:
V1 C 18015
V2 C 220 CDI15
V3 C 25015, C 250 CDI15
V4 C 35015
V5 C 63 AMG
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since
previous damage cannot always be detected on retreaded tyres. As a result,
Mercedes-Benz cannot guarantee vehicle
safety if retreaded tyres are fitted. Do not
15 BlueEFFICIENCY
Z
Wheels and tyres
Wheel and tyre combinations
345
346
Wheel and tyre combinations
Wheels and tyres
Tyres
Summer tyres
Light-alloy
wheels
V1
V2
V3
V4
V5
BA
195/60 R16 89 V16
6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 39
#
—
—
—
—
BA
205/55 R16 91 V16
7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 43
#
#
—
—
—
BA
205/55 R16 91 W16
7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 43
#
#
#
—
—
BA
225/50 R16 92 V16, 17
7.5 J x 16 H2 ET 53
#
#
—
—
—
BA
225/50 R16 92 W16
7.5 J x 16 H2 ET 53
#
#
#
—
—
BA
225/45 R17 91 W16
7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 47
#
#
#
#
—
BA
225/45 R17 91 W
MOExtended16, 18
7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 47
#
#
#
#
—
FA
RA
225/45 R17 91 W
245/40 R17 91 W19
7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 47
8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 58
#
#
#
#
—
FA
225/45 R17 91 W
MOExtended18
245/40 R17 91 W
MOExtended18, 19
7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 47
#
#
#
#
—
BA
225/40 R18 92 Y XL16, 20
7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 47
#
#
#
#
—
FA
RA
225/40 R18 92 Y XL20
245/35 R18 92 Y XL19, 20
7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 47
8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 58
#
#
#
#
—
FA
RA
225/40 R18 92 Y XL20
255/35 R18 94 Y XL19, 20, 21
7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 47
8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 54
#
#
#
#
—
FA
RA
225/40 R18 92 Y XL20
255/35 R18 94 Y XL19, 20, 21
8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50
8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 54
#
#
#
#
—
FA
RA
225/40 ZR18 92 Y XL20
255/35 ZR18 94 Y XL19, 20, 21
8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50
8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 54
#
#
#
#
—
RA
16 Not
8.5 J x 17 H2 ET 58
in combination with sports suspension code 486 or dynamic handling package code 483.
available from the factory.
18 MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an activated tyre pressure loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
19 Use of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
20 Observe notes on "large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
21 Additional measures necessary (hub caps on rear axle, code 776).
17 Not
Summer tyres
Light-alloy
wheels
V1
V2
V3
V4
V5
FA
RA
235/40 ZR18 95 Y XL
255/35 ZR18 94 Y XL19, 20
8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 45
9.0 J x 18 H2 ET 54
—
—
—
—
#
FA
RA
235/35 ZR19 XL20
255/30 ZR19 XL19, 20
8.0 J x 19 H2 ET 45
9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 54
—
—
—
—
#
Winter tyres
Light-alloy
wheels
V1
V2
V3
V4
V5
BA
195/60 R16 89 H M+Si
6.0 J x 16 H2 ET 39
#
—
—
—
—
BA
205/55 R1 6 91 H M+Si
7.0 J x 16 H2 ET 43
#
#
—
—
—
BA
225/50 R16 92 H M+Si17
7.5 J x 16 H2 ET 53
#
#
#
—
—
BA
225/45 R17 91 H M+Si
7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 47
#
#
#
#
—
BA
225/45 R17 91 H
M+SiMOExtended17, 18
7.5 J x 17 H2 ET 47
#
#
#
#
—
BA
225/40 R18 92 H XL
M+Si20
7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 47
#
#
#
#
—
BA
225/40 R18 92 V XL
M+Si20
8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 45
—
—
—
—
#
BA
225/40 R18 92 H XL
M+Si20
8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 50
#
#
#
#
—
BA
235/40 R18 95 V XL
M+Si19
8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 45
—
—
—
—
#
FA
RA
235/40 R18 95 V XL M+Si
255/35 R18 94 V XL
M+Si19, 20
8.0 J x 18 H2 ET 45
9.0 J x 18 H2 ET 54
—
—
—
—
#
19 Use
of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
notes on "large wheels" in the "Wheel/tyre combinations" section.
17 Not available from the factory.
18 MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an activated tyre pressure loss warning system or tyre pressure monitor.
20 Observe
Z
347
Wheels and tyres
Wheel and tyre combinations
348
Wheel and tyre combinations
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel19
Tyres
Wheels
V1
V2
V3
V4
V5
T 125/90 R16 98 M
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
3.5 B x 16 H2 ET 20
#
#
#
—
—
T 125/80 R17 99 M
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
3.5 B x 17 H2 ET 20
#
#
#
#
—
T 125/70 R18 99 M
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
3.5 B x 18 H2 ET 20
—
—
—
—
#
Your vehicle may be equipped with TIREFIT or a "Minispare" emergency spare wheel, depending on the country, the engine and the wheels fitted.
Wheels and tyres
i The specified tyre pressure is printed in yellow on the emergency spare wheel.
19 Use
of snow chains is not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
349
350
350
350
351
352
353
357
360
361
363
Technical data
Useful information ............................
Notes on the technical data .............
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts .........
Vehicle electronics ...........................
Vehicle identification plates ............
Service products and capacities .....
Vehicle data ......................................
Boot lid opening dimensions ...........
Trailer tow hitch ................................
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview) .....................................
350
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
Useful information
i This Owner's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment
available to your vehicle at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Countryspecific deviations are possible. Please
note that your vehicle may not be equipped
with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Please read the information on qualified
specialist workshops (Y page 26).
Notes on the technical data
Technical data
i The technical data was determined in
accordance with EC Directives. All data
applies to the vehicle's standard equipment. Therefore, the data may differ for
vehicles with optional equipment. You can
obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
You can find technical data on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com
approved parts may invalidate the vehicle's
general operating permit. This is the case if:
Rthey cause a change of the vehicle type
from that for which the vehicle's general
operating permit was granted.
Rother road users could be endangered.
Rthe emission or noise levels are adversely
affected.
G WARNING
Driving safety may be impaired if nonapproved parts, tyres and wheels or safetyrelevant accessories are used.
This could lead to malfunctions in safety-relevant systems, e.g. the brake system. This
could cause you to lose control of your vehicle
and cause an accident.
For this reason, Mercedes-Benz recommends
that you use genuine Mercedes-Benz parts or
parts of equal quality. Only use tyres, wheels
and accessories that have been specifically
approved for your vehicle.
! Airbags and seat belt tensioners, as well
as control units and sensors for these
restraint systems may be installed in the
following areas of your vehicle:
Rdoors
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories which have
been specifically approved for your vehicle for
their reliability, safety and suitability. Despite
ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is
unable to evaluate other parts. MercedesBenz therefore accepts no responsibility for
the use of such parts in Mercedes-Benz vehicles, even if they have been independently or
officially approved.
In Germany and some other countries, certain
parts are only officially approved for installation or modification if they comply with legal
requirements. All genuine Mercedes-Benz
parts meet this requirement. The use of non-
Rdoor
pillars
sills
Rseats
Rdashboard
Rinstrument cluster
Rcentre console
Do not install accessories such as audio
systems in these areas. Do not carry out
repairs or welding. You could impair the
operating efficiency of the restraint systems.
Have aftermarket accessories installed at
a qualified specialist workshop. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose.
Rdoor
Vehicle electronics
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same warranty applies as for new parts.
Always specify the vehicle identification number (VIN) (Y page 352) and the engine number (Y page 353) when ordering genuine
Mercedes-Benz parts.
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
If your vehicle has fittings for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply or aerial
connections intended for use with the basic
wiring. Be sure to observe the manufacturer's
additional instructions when installing the fittings.
! Have aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equipment installed at a qualified
specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose.
The transmission output at the aerial base
must not exceed the maximum values below.
Waveband
Maximum transmission output
(PEAK)
Short wave
(f < 54 MHz)
100 W
4 m waveband
30 W
2 m waveband
50 W
G WARNING
Only have work on the engine electronics and
related components carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose. In particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. Otherwise, the vehicle's
roadworthiness could be affected.
! Only have maintenance work on the
engine electronics and its associated parts,
such as control units, sensors and connector leads, carried out at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre. Vehicle components may otherwise wear more quickly and the vehicle's
operating permit may be invalidated.
Technical data
H Environmental note
351
Trunked radio/Tetra 35 W
70 cm waveband
35 W
GSM 900/AMPS
10 W
GSM 1800
10 W
UMTS
10 W
The following aerial positions may be used if
RF transmitters have been properly installed:
Retrofitting of two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters)
Use the Technical Specification
ISO/TS 2160922 implementation regulation
when retrofitting RF (radio frequency) transmitters.
22 ISO/TS
21609 – Technical Specification for Road Vehicles (EMC) guidelines for installation of aftermarket
radio frequency transmitting equipment.
Z
352
Vehicle identification plates
bands: trunked radio/Tetra, 70 cm waveband, GSM 900/AMPS, GSM 1800 and
UMTS.
Legal provisions for fittings must be
observed.
RF transmitters with a maximum transmission output of 100 mW (PEAK) may be used
in the vehicle without restrictions.
! The operating permit may be invalidated
if the instructions for installation and use of
RF transmitters are not observed, e.g.
approved wavebands, maximum output
and aerial positions on the vehicle.
: Front roof area23
; Rear roof area
Technical data
= Rear wing24
? Boot lid
G WARNING
Vehicle identification plates
Incorrect retrofitting of RF transmitters can
cause the vehicle electronics to malfunction.
The vehicle's operating safety and thus your
own safety are impaired.
Have aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equipment installed at a qualified specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose.
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN) and
paint code number
G WARNING
Incorrect retrofitting of RF transmitters can
lead to increased electromagnetic radiation in
the vehicle interior. Using an exterior aerial
takes into account current scientific discussions relating to the possible health hazards
that may result from electromagnetic fields.
Have aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equipment installed at a qualified specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose.
X
Open the right-hand door.
You will see vehicle identification plate :.
Deviations with respect to aerial locations,
output and frequencies must be approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
There is no restriction for aerial positions in
the outer area of the vehicle for these wave23 Vehicles
with a panorama sliding sunroof: this area is not permitted.
installation position: on the side which faces the centre of the road.
24 Recommended
Service products and capacities
353
Slide the right-hand front seat to its rearmost position.
X Fold floor covering : upwards.
You will see vehicle identification number
(VIN) ;.
X
Engine number
; Vehicle manufacturer
= EU type approval number
Service products and capacities
? Vehicle identification number (VIN)
Important safety notes
A Maximum permissible gross vehicle
B
C
D
E
weight
Gross combination mass
Maximum permissible front axle load
Maximum permissible rear axle load
Paint code
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
In addition to being stamped on the vehicle
identification plate, the vehicle identification
number (VIN) is also stamped onto the vehicle
body.
It is located on the floor in front of the righthand front seat.
Service products include the following:
Rfuels
(e.g. petrol, diesel)
Rlubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
Rcoolant
Rbrake
fluid
Rwindscreen
washer fluid
Vehicle components and their respective
lubricants must match. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use products that have
been tested and specially approved by
Mercedes-Benz. These products are listed in
this Mercedes-Benz Owner's Manual in the
relevant section.
You can recognise service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscription on the containers:
RMB-Freigabe (e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations that
relate to a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet number (such
as MB 229.5) have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
You can obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
G WARNING
When handling, storing and disposing of any
service products, please observe the relevant
Z
Technical data
Vehicle identification plate (example)
: Vehicle identification plate
The engine number is stamped into the crankcase. More information can be obtained from
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
354
Service products and capacities
regulations, as you could otherwise endanger
yourself and others.
Keep service products away from children.
To protect your health, do not allow service
products to come into contact with your eyes
or open wounds. See a doctor immediately if
any service product is swallowed.
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuel
Approximately 14 l
Reserve fuel in all other
models
Approximately 8 l
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not use diesel to refuel
vehicles with a petrol engine. Even small
amounts of the wrong fuel result in damage
to the fuel system and the engine.
For further information on refuelling and on
fuels, see (Y page 152).
Notes on fuel consumption
Important safety notes
The vehicle will use more fuel than usual in
the following situations:
G WARNING
Technical data
Reserve fuel in AMG vehicles
Fuel is highly flammable. Fire, naked flames
and smoking are therefore prohibited when
handling fuels.
Switch off the engine and the auxiliary heating
before refuelling.
Rat
G WARNING
i Only for certain countries: you can find
Do not come into contact with fuels.
It is hazardous to your health if your skin
comes into direct contact with fuels or you
breathe in fuel vapours.
Tank capacity
Total capacity
C 18025
C 25025
C 220 CDI25
C 250 CDI25
59 l
Total capacity
C 35025
AMG vehicles
66 l
25 BlueEFFICIENCY.
very low outside temperatures
urban traffic
Rfor short journeys
Rwhen towing a trailer
Rin mountainous terrain
Rin
the current consumption and emission values of your vehicle in the COC documents
(EU CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY). These
documents are delivered with your vehicle.
The consumption figures are in each case
based on the currently applicable version.
Rfor vehicles up to the EURO 4 standard
in accordance with EU Directive
RL 80 / 1268 / EWG
Rfor vehicles complying with the EURO 5
standard or higher in accordance with
Regulation (EC) Nr. 715 / 2007
Deviations from these values may occur
under normal operating conditions.
! Do not use any fuel additives, as they can
cause malfunctions and engine damage.
Service products and capacities
CO2 (carbon dioxide) is the gas which scientists believe to be principally responsible for
global warming (the greenhouse effect). Your
vehicle's CO2 emissions are directly related
to fuel consumption and therefore depend on:
Refficient use of the fuel by the engine
Rdriving style
Rother non-technical factors, such as environmental influences or road conditions
You can minimise your vehicle's CO2 emissions by driving carefully and having it serviced regularly.
Engine oil
Please bear the following in mind
The quality of engine oils is decisive for the
function and service life of an engine. After
extensive tests, Mercedes-Benz approves
engine oils which correspond to the current
technical standard.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz approved
engine oils may be used in Mercedes-Benz
engines.
Further information on tested and approved
engine oils can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. MercedesBenz recommends that you have the oil
change carried out at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre. Mercedes-Benz approval is
indicated on the oil container by the inscription "MB Approval" and the corresponding
designation, e.g. MB Approval 229.51.
The table shows which engine oils have been
approved for your vehicle.
Petrol engines
MB Approval
18026
C
C 25026
229.3, 229.5,
229.51
C 35026
229.3, 229.5
C 63 AMG27
229.5
Diesel engines
MB Approval
Vehicles with a diesel particle filter
C 220 CDI26
C 250 CDI26
228.51,
229.31, 229.51
You can call up an overview of approved
engine oils on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com by entering the designation, e.g. 229.5.
i If the engine oils listed in the table are not
available, you may add a maximum of 1.0 l
of the following engine oils, once only, until
the next oil change:
with a petrol engine28: MB
Approval 229.1 or ACEA A3
Rvehicles with a diesel engine: MB
Approval 229.1 or ACEA C3
Rvehicles
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change
including the oil filter.
26 BlueEFFICIENCY.
27 Restriction:
28 Restriction:
only SAE 0W-40/SAE 5W-40 engine oils may be used.
only SAE 0W-40/SAE 5W-40 engine oils may be used for AMG vehicles.
Z
Technical data
H Environmental note
355
356
Service products and capacities
Vehicle model
Capacity including
oil filter
C
C 25029
5.5 l
C 220 CDI29
C 250 CDI29
C 35029
6.5 l
C 63 AMG30
8.5 l
18029
Additives
! Do not use additives in engine oil. This
could damage the engine.
Technical data
Engine oil viscosity
Viscosity describes the flow characteristics
of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity,
this means that it is thick; a low viscosity
means that it is thin.
Engine oil selection is based on the respective
outside temperatures and in accordance with
the SAE classification (viscosity). The table
below shows you which SAE classifications
are to be used. The low-temperature properties of engine oils can be significantly
impaired during operation due to, for example, ageing or soot and fuel accretion. It is
therefore strongly recommended to observe
regular oil changes using an approved engine
oil with the appropriate SAE classification.
Brake fluid
G WARNING
The brake fluid constantly absorbs moisture
from the air; this lowers its boiling point.
If the boiling point of the brake fluid is too low,
vapour pockets may form in the brake system
when the brakes are applied hard (e.g. when
driving downhill). This would impair braking
efficiency.
You should have the brake fluid renewed at
regular intervals. The brake fluid change intervals can be found in the Service Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz. Information about approved brake fluids can be obtained from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
i There is usually a notice in the engine
compartment to remind you when the next
brake fluid change is due.
Coolant
Important safety notes
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It performs the
following tasks:
Ranti-corrosion
protection
protection
Rraising the boiling point
Rantifreeze
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled with a coolant mixture that ensures
adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
with the desired antifreeze protection. The
engine could otherwise be damaged.
Further information on coolants and on filling can be found in the Mercedes-Benz
Specifications for Service Products, MB
Approval 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at
29 BlueEFFICIENCY.
30 Including
external oil cooler.
Vehicle data
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Otherwise, the cooling system will not be
sufficiently protected from corrosion, and
the boiling point will be too low.
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in
the correct concentration, the boiling point of
the coolant will be around 130 †.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should:
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine
cooling system against freezing down to
around -37 †.
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection
down to -45 † ); otherwise, heat will not be
dissipated as effectively.
If the vehicle has lost coolant, top it up with
equal amounts of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. Mercedes-Benz recommends an antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor
which has been approved for Mercedes-Benz.
! The engine cooling system is filled with
coolant that must be renewed after 15
years, or after 250,000 km at the latest.
Vehicle data
Vehicle data, C 180 BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle width without exterior mirrors
1770 mm
Vehicle height31
1406 mm
Wheelbase
2760 mm
Vehicle weight32
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC Directive), manual transmission
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC Directive), automatic transmission
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 352).
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4590 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
1997 mm
31 The
values specified may differ from the actual values, depending on the tyres, load, optional equipment
and the state of the suspension.
32 Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Z
Technical data
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com. You can
also consult a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
357
Technical data
358
Vehicle data
Vehicle data, C 250 BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle data, C 350 BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4590 mm
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4590 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
1997 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
1997 mm
Vehicle width without exterior mirrors
1770 mm
Vehicle width without exterior mirrors
1770 mm
Vehicle height33
1406 mm
Vehicle height35
1406 mm
Wheelbase
2760 mm
Wheelbase
2760 mm
Vehicle weight34
Vehicle weight36
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC directive)
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC directive)
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 352).
33 The
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 352).
values specified may differ from the actual values, depending on the tyres, load, optional equipment
and the state of the suspension.
34 Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
35 The values specified may differ from the actual values, depending on the tyres, load, optional equipment
and the state of the suspension.
36 Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
Vehicle data
Vehicle data, C 220 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4702 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
1997 mm
Vehicle width without exterior mirrors
1770 mm
Vehicle height37
1433 mm
Wheelbase
2765 mm
Vehicle weights
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC directive)
1730 kg
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 352).
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4590 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
1997 mm
Vehicle width without exterior mirrors
1770 mm
Vehicle height38
1406 mm
Wheelbase
2760 mm
Vehicle weight39
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC Directive), manual transmission
Technical data
Vehicle data, C 63 AMG
359
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC Directive), automatic transmission
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Z
360
Boot lid opening dimensions
Vehicle weight
Vehicle weight39
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Technical data
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 352).
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Vehicle data, C 250 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 352).
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4590 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
1997 mm
Vehicle width without exterior mirrors
1770 mm
Vehicle height40
1406 mm
Wheelbase
2760 mm
Boot lid opening dimensions
Vehicle weight41
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC Directive), manual transmission
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC Directive), automatic transmission
39 Missing
: Opening height
:
1654 – 1669 mm
i The values specified may differ from the
actual values, depending on the tyres, load,
optional equipment and the state of the
suspension.
values were not available at the time of going to print.
values specified may differ from the actual values, depending on the tyres, load, optional equipment
and the state of the suspension.
38 The values specified may differ from the actual values, depending on the tyres, load, optional equipment
and the state of the suspension.
40 The values specified may differ from the actual values, depending on the tyres, load, optional equipment
and the state of the suspension.
41 Missing values were not available at the time of going to print.
37 The
Trailer tow hitch
361
Trailer tow hitch
Mounting dimensions
G WARNING
Only have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted at a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular,
work relevant to safety or on safety-related
systems must be carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop.
! If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
Anchorage points for the trailer tow hitch (vehicles
without the AMG sports package)
: Anchorage points
; Overhang dimension
= Rear axle centre line
Technical data
changes to the cooling system may be necessary, depending on the vehicle type.
If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
observe the anchorage points on the chassis frame.
Z
362
Trailer tow hitch
Anchorage points for the trailer tow hitch (vehicles
with AMG sports package)
: Anchorage points
Technical data
; Overhang dimension
= Rear axle centre line
For trailer tow hitches fitted at the factory, the
overhang dimension is 1,151.3 mm (vehicles
without the AMG sports package) or
1,178.8 mm (vehicles with the AMG sports
package).
Trailer loads
All models42
Permissible trailer load,
unbraked
750 kg
Permissible trailer load,
braked43
1800 kg
Maximum drawbar
noseweight44
42 The
75 kg
C 63 AMG cannot be used to tow a trailer.
a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 12% from a standstill.
44 The drawbar noseweight is not included in the trailer load.
43 At
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
363
Permissible rear axle load when towing a trailer
Coupé
Manual transmission
Automatic transmission
C 18045
1115 kg
1140 kg
C 25045
–
1140 kg
C 35045
–
1160 kg
C 220 CDI45
1150 kg
1150 kg
C 250 CDI45
1175 kg
1180 kg
The 24 GHz radar sensor system requires separate approval for each country. When you are
driving in a country in which the radar sensor system is not approved, you must deactivate
the system using the on-board computer (Y page 226). The current country overview can be
obtained from a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicles with a navigation system: the radar sensor system is deactivated automatically
near radio telescope facilities.
The currently active systems are automatically deactivated:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 164)
Spot Assist (Y page 190)
RActive Blind Spot Assist(Y page 194)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 50)
A display message appears in the multifunction display to tell you that the radar sensor system
is being switched off (Y page 257).
BAS PLUS (Y page 66) is then also unavailable.
If the deactivation does not occur automatically, you must deactivate the radar sensor system
using the on-board computer (Y page 226).
Vehicles without navigation and vehicles for Australia: you must deactivate the radar
sensor system using the on-board computer when you are near a radio telescope facility
(Y page 226).
RBlind
Country
Radio telescope
facilities
Geographical latitude and
longitude
Distance to be
maintained
from the facility
Egypt
–
–
–
Andorra
–
–
–
45 BlueEFFICIENCY.
Z
Technical data
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
Technical data
364
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
Country
Radio telescope
facilities
Geographical latitude and
longitude
Distance to be
maintained
from the facility
Australia
Parkes
32°59'59" S,148°15'44" E
10 km
Narrabri
30°18'52" S,149°32'56" E
10 km
Canberra
35°23'54" S,148°58'40" E
3 km
Western Australia
26°37'13"S,117°30'40" E
10 km
Bahrain
–
–
–
Belgium
–
–
–
Bosnia-Herzegovina
–
–
–
Bulgaria
–
–
–
Denmark
–
–
–
Germany
Effelsberg
50°31'32" N, 06°53'00" E
6.5 km
Estonia
–
–
–
Finland
Metsähovi
60°13'04" N, 24°23'37" E
7 km
Tuorla
60°24'56" N, 22°26'31" E
5 km
Plateau de Bure
44°38'01" N, 05°54'26" E
35 km
Floirac
44°50'10" N, 00°31'37" W
35 km
Gibraltar
–
–
–
Greece
–
–
–
Cambridge
52°09'59" N, 00°02'20" E
9 km
Darnhall
53°09'22" N, 02°32'03" W
5 km
Jodrell Bank
53°14'10" N, 02°18'26" W
9 km
Knockin
52°47'24" N, 02°59'45" W
5 km
Pickmere
53°17'18" N, 02°26'38" W
5 km
Ireland
–
–
–
Iceland
–
–
–
Medicina
44°31'14" N,11°38'49" E
20 km
Noto
36°52'34" N, 14°59'21" E
8 km
Sardinia
39°29'50" N, 09°14'40" E
15 km
France
United Kingdom
Italy
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
Radio telescope
facilities
Geographical latitude and
longitude
Distance to be
maintained
from the facility
Yemen
–
–
–
Jordan
–
–
–
Canada
–
–
–
Qatar
–
–
–
Croatia
–
–
–
Kuwait
–
–
–
Latvia
Ventspils
57°33'12" N, 21°51'17" E
8.5 km
Lebanon
–
–
–
Lithuania
–
–
–
Luxembourg
–
–
–
Malaysia
–
–
–
Malta
–
–
–
Macedonia
–
–
–
Mexico
–
–
–
Mongolia
–
–
–
New Zealand
–
–
–
Netherlands
–
–
–
Norway
–
–
–
Oman
–
–
–
Austria
–
–
–
Pakistan
–
–
–
Kraków-Fort Skała
50°03'18" N, 19°49'36" E
1 km
Toruń-Piwnice
52°54'48" N, 18°33'30" E
1 km
Portugal
–
–
–
Romania
–
–
–
Dimitrov
56°26'00" N, 37°27'00" E
35 km
Kalyazin
57°13'22" N, 37°54'01" E
35 km
Pushchino
54°49'00" N, 37°40'00" E
35 km
Poland
Russia
Technical data
Country
365
Z
366
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
Country
Radio telescope
facilities
Geographical latitude and
longitude
Distance to be
maintained
from the facility
Zelenchukskaya
43°49'53" N, 41°35'32" E
35 km
–
–
–
Sweden
Onsala
57°23'45" N, 11°55'35" E
12 km
Switzerland
Bleien
47°20'26" N, 08°06'44" E
3 km
Singapore
–
–
–
Slovakia
–
–
–
Slovenia
–
–
–
Yebes
40°31'27" N, 03°05'22" W
15 km
Robledo
40°25'38" N, 04°14'57" W
7 km
South Africa
–
–
–
Syria
–
–
–
Czech Republic
–
–
–
Turkey
–
–
–
Ukraine
–
–
–
Hungary
Penc
47°47'22" N, 19°16'53" E
2 km
USA
–
–
–
United Arab Emirates
–
–
–
Cyprus
–
–
–
Saudi Arabia
Technical data
Spain
367
368